Quarterlytics / Financial Services / Banks - Regional / First Western Financial, Inc.

First Western Financial, Inc.

myfw · NASDAQ Financial Services
Claim this profile
Ticker myfw
Exchange NASDAQ
Sector Financial Services
Industry Banks - Regional
Employees 321
← All annual reports
FY2020 Annual Report · First Western Financial, Inc.
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
2020
Annual Report

Cover Art:

William Stockman, Drift (detail), 2008, oil on canvas
First Western Art Collection

To Our Shareholders: 

There aren’t many companies that are able to say that 2020 was the best year in their history, but in the case of First 
Western Financial, it’s absolutely true. As the COVID-19 pandemic emerged, we were ideally positioned to capitalize on 
the operating environment that it created.  

From a defensive standpoint, given our conservatively underwritten loan portfolio and minimal exposure to the industries 
most impacted by the pandemic, we have maintained exceptional credit quality throughout this crisis. From an offensive 
standpoint, our mortgage business capitalized on the refinancing boom to have an incredibly productive year, while we 
made exceptional progress on our efforts to expand our roster of commercial clients, due in part to the highly efficient 
process we put in place to help business customers access funding through the Paycheck Protection Program. As a result, 
we generated significant revenue growth while keeping expenses well controlled, resulting in our net income and earnings 
per share more than tripling over the prior year.  

Despite dealing with the challenges presented by the pandemic, we were able to continue delivering on the vision that 
we communicated at the time of our IPO in 2018 – a unique wealth manager built on a private bank platform that was 
emerging from a period of capital constraint and would realize strong operating leverage as we grew our balance sheet 
through both organic growth and acquisitions. 

The clearest progress can be seen in the growth of our commercial banking platform, which is creating a sustainable path 
to  higher  earnings  and  returns  over  the  long  term.  Our  commercial  banking  initiative  was  accelerated  with  a  branch 
purchase  and  assumption  transaction  that  we  completed  with  Simmons  Bank  in  May  2020.  This  highly  accretive 
transaction  enabled  us  to  add  an  attractive  mix  of  commercial  clients  and  experienced  commercial  banking  talent, 
including our new President of Commercial Banking.  

With our expanded commercial banking team, we have seen a substantial increase in loan production and a significant 
shift in the mix of our loan portfolio away from residential mortgage loans. At the end of 2020, residential mortgage loans 
had declined to 29.7% of total loans from 40.2% a year earlier. The growth of our commercial client roster has also resulted 
in significant inflows of transaction deposits, which helped  drive a substantial reduction in our cost of deposits during 
2020. We believe that the success we are having with our commercial banking initiative – and the more diversified loan 
portfolio and lower-cost deposit base that we are building – is significantly enhancing the value of our franchise. 

As we look forward, we believe we are very well positioned to continue executing on our growth strategies. During 2020, 
our  strong  financial  performance  resulted  in  our  tangible  common  equity  increasing  by  more  than  $26  million.  For  a 
company of our size, this equates to a significant capital raise, but without the dilutive impact to existing shareholders. 
The strong capital base that we have provides the support for our continued organic and acquisitive growth. 

As we continue executing on the initiatives that we believe will build long-term franchise value – adding more commercial 
clients, growing our balance sheet, increasing our sources of fee income, and realizing more operating leverage – we are 
confident that our consistent progress will make First Western a high performing institution and create significant value 
for our shareholders in the future. 

Sincerely, 

Scott C. Wylie 
Chairman, President & CEO 

 
 
 
UNITED STATES 
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION 
Washington, D.C. 20549 

FORM 10-K 

☒ 

☐ 

ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934  

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2020 
OR 
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 FOR 
THE TRANSITION PERIOD FROM_____ TO _____  

Commission File Number 001-38595 

First Western Financial, Inc. 

(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its Charter) 

 Colorado 
( State or other jurisdiction of 
incorporation or organization) 
1900 16th Street, Suite 1200 
Denver, CO 
(Address of principal executive offices) 

37-1442266 
(I.R.S. Employer 
Identification No.) 

80202 
(Zip Code) 

Registrant’s telephone number, including area code: 303.531.8100 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act: 

Title of each class 
Common Stock, no par value 

Trading Symbol 
MYFW 

Name of each exchange on which registered 
The Nasdaq Stock Market LLC 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None  

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. YES ☐ NO ☒  

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Act. YES ☐ NO ☒  

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant: (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such 
shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. YES ☒ NO ☐ 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically every Interactive Data File required to be submitted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during 
the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit such files). YES ☒ NO ☐ 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, a smaller reporting company, or an emerging growth company. See the definitions 
of  "large accelerated filer," "accelerated filer," "smaller reporting company," and "emerging growth company" in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. 

Large accelerated filer 
Non-accelerated filer 

  ☐ 
  ☐ 

   Accelerated filer 
   Smaller reporting company 
   Emerging growth company 

  ☒ 
  ☒ 
  ☒ 

If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards 
provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act. ☒ 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has filed a report on and attestation to its management’s assessment of the effectiveness of its internal control over financial reporting under Section 404(b) 
of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (15 U.S.C. 7262(b)) by the registered public accounting firm that prepared or issued its audit report.  ☐ 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act). YES ☐ NO  ☒  

As of June 30, 2020, the last day of the registrant’s most recently completed second quarter, the aggregate market value of the common stock held by non-affiliates of the Registrant, based on the closing 
price of the Registrant’s common stock on the NASDAQ Global Select Market, was approximately $89.5 million. 

The number of shares of the registrant’s common stock outstanding as of March 8, 2021 was 7,957,900. 

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE 

Portions of the registrant’s Definitive Proxy Statement relating to its 2021 Annual Meeting of Stockholders are incorporated by reference into Part III of this Form 10-K to the extent stated herein. Such 
Definitive Proxy Statement will be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission within 120 days after the end of the registrant’s fiscal year ended December 31, 2020. 

 
  
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
   
   
 
  
 
 
 
 
FIRST WESTERN FINANCIAL, INC. 

TABLE OF CONTENTS 

Table of Contents 

Business  
Risk Factors  

PART I  
Item 1. 
Item 1A.  
Item 1B.  Unresolved Staff Comments  
Item 2. 
Item 3. 
Item 4. 

Properties 
Legal Proceedings  
Mine Safety Disclosures  

PART II 
Item 5. 

Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Shareholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of 
Equity Securities  
Selected Financial Data  
Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations  

Item 6. 
Item 7. 
Item 7A.   Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk  
Financial Statements and Supplementary Data  
Item 8. 
Changes in and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure  
Item 9. 
Item 9A.  
Controls and Procedures 
Item 9B.  Other Information  

PART III 
Item 10. 
Item 11. 
Item 12. 

Item 13. 
Item 14. 

PART IV 
Item 15. 
Item 16. 

Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance  
Executive Compensation  
Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder 
Matters  
Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence  
Principal Accounting Fees and Services  

Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules  
Form 10-K Summary  
Signatures 

Page 

5 
30 
55 
55 
56 
56 

56 
57 
63 
90 
92 
93 
93 
93 

94 
94 

94 
94 
94 

95 
97 
97 

Important Notice about Information in this Annual Report 

Unless we state otherwise or the context otherwise requires, references in this Annual Report on Form 10-K to 
"we,"  "our,"  "us,"  "the  Company"  and  "First  Western"  refer  to  First  Western  Financial,  Inc.  and  its  consolidated 
subsidiaries, including First Western Trust Bank, which we sometimes refer to as "the Bank" or "our Bank." 

The information contained in this Annual Report on Form 10-K is accurate only as of the date of this Annual 

Report on Form 10-K and as of the dates specified herein. 

 
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
 
  
  
 
  
 
  
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
CAUTIONARY NOTE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS 

This  Annual  Report  on  Form  10-K  contains  forward-looking  statements.  These  forward-looking  statements 
reflect our current views with respect to, among other things, future events and our financial performance. These statements 
are often, but not always, made through the use of words or phrases such as "may," "should," "could," "predict," "potential," 
"believe," "will likely result," "expect," "continue," "will," "anticipate," "seek," "estimate," "intend," "plan," "projection," 
"would" and "outlook," or the negative version of those words or other comparable words or phrases of a future or forward-
looking nature. These forward-looking statements are not historical facts, and are based on current expectations, estimates 
and projections about our industry, management’s beliefs and certain assumptions made by management, many of which, 
by  their  nature,  are  inherently  uncertain  and  beyond  our  control,  particularly  with  regard  to  developments  related  to 
COVID-19.  Accordingly,  we  caution  you  that  any  such  forward-looking  statements  are  not  guarantees  of  future 
performance and are subject to risks, assumptions and uncertainties that are difficult to predict. Although we believe that 
the expectations reflected in these forward-looking statements are reasonable as of the date made, actual results may prove 
to  be  materially  different  from  the  results  expressed  or  implied  by  the  forward-looking  statements.  When  considering 
forward-looking statements, you should keep in mind the risk factors and other cautionary statements described in "Item 
1A – Risk Factors" of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. 

There are or will be important factors that could cause our actual results to differ materially from those indicated 

in these forward-looking statements, including, but not limited to, the following: 

  The impact of the COVID-19 pandemic and actions taken by governmental authorities in response to the 

pandemic; 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

geographic concentration in Colorado, Arizona, Wyoming and California; 

changes in the economy affecting real estate values and liquidity; 

our ability to continue to originate residential real estate loans and sell such loans; 

risks specific to commercial loans and borrowers; 

claims and litigation pertaining to our fiduciary responsibilities; 

competition for investment managers and professionals and our ability to retain our associates; 

fluctuation in the value of our investment securities; 

the terminable nature of our investment management contracts; 

changes to the level or type of investment activity by our clients; 

investment performance, in either relative or absolute terms; 

changes in interest rates; 

the adequacy of our allowance for loan losses; 

  weak economic conditions and global trade; 

 

 

 

legislative changes or the adoption of tax reform policies; 

external business disruptors in the financial services industry; 

liquidity risks; 

3 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

our ability to maintain a strong core deposit base or other low-cost funding sources; 

continued positive interaction with and financial health of our referral sources; 

retaining our largest trust clients; 

our ability to achieve our strategic objectives; 

competition from other banks, financial institutions and wealth and investment management firms; 

our ability to implement our internal growth strategy and manage the risks associated with our anticipated 
growth; 

the acquisition of other banks and financial services companies and integration risks and other unknown risks 
associated with acquisitions; 

the accuracy of estimates and assumptions; 

our  ability  to  protect  against  and  manage  fraudulent  activity,  breaches  of  our  information  security,  and 
cybersecurity attacks; 

our reliance on communications, information, operating and financial control systems technology and related 
services from third-party service providers; 

technological change; 

our ability to attract and retain clients; 

unforeseen or catastrophic events, including the emergence of a pandemic, terrorist attacks, extreme weather 
events or other natural disasters; 

new lines of business or new products and services; 

regulation of the financial services industry; 

legal and regulatory proceedings, investigations and inquiries, fines and sanctions; 

limited trading volume and liquidity in the market for our common stock; 

fluctuations in the market price of our common stock; 

potential  impairment  of  goodwill  recorded  on  our  balance  sheet  and  possible  requirements  to  recognize 
significant charges to earnings due to impairment of intangible assets;  

actual or anticipated issuances or sales of our common stock or preferred stock in the future; 

the initiation and continuation of securities analysts coverage of the Company; 

future issuances of debt securities; 

our ability to manage our existing and future indebtedness; 

available cash flows from the Bank; and 

4 

 

other factors that are discussed in "Part I – Item 1A - Risk Factors." 

The foregoing factors should not be construed as exhaustive. If one or more events related to these or other risks 
or uncertainties materialize, or if our underlying assumptions prove to be incorrect, actual results may differ materially 
from what we anticipate. Accordingly, you should not place undue reliance on any such forward-looking statements. Any 
forward-looking  statement speaks only as of the date  on  which  it is  made, and  we do not undertake any obligation to 
publicly update or review any forward-looking statement, whether as a result of new information, future developments or 
otherwise. New factors emerge from time to time, and it is not possible for us to predict which will arise. In addition, we 
cannot assess the impact of each factor on our business or the extent to which any factor, or combination of factors, may 
cause actual results to differ materially from those contained in any forward-looking statements. 

PART I 

Item 1: Business 

Our Company 

First Western Financial, Inc. is a financial holding company headquartered in Denver, Colorado. We provide a 
fully integrated suite of wealth management services on our private trust bank platform, which includes a comprehensive 
selection  of  deposit,  loan,  trust,  wealth  planning  and  investment  management  products  and  services.  We  believe  our 
integrated business model distinguishes us from other banks and non-bank financial services companies in the markets in 
which we operate. As of December 31, 2020, we provided fiduciary and advisory services on $6.26 billion of trust and 
investment management assets (referred to as "AUM"), and we had total assets of $1.97 billion, total loans of $1.53 billion, 
total deposits of $1.62 billion and total shareholders’ equity of $155.0 million. 

Our mission is to be the best private bank for the Western wealth management client. We believe that the "Western 
wealth management client" shares our entrepreneurial spirit and values our sophisticated, high-touch integrated financial 
services that are tailored to meet their specific needs. Our target clients include successful entrepreneurs, professionals and 
other high net worth individuals or families, along with their businesses and philanthropic organizations. We offer our 
services through a branded network of boutique private trust bank offices, loan production offices, and trust offices, which 
we believe are strategically located in affluent and high-growth  markets in fifteen locations across Colorado, Arizona, 
Wyoming and California. 

We generate a significant portion of our revenues from non-interest income, which we produce from our trust, 
investment management and other advisory services as well as through the origination and sale of mortgage loans. The 
balance of our revenue is generated from net interest income, which we derive from our traditional banking products and 
services. For the year ended December 31, 2020, non-interest income was $51.2 million, or 52.6% of gross revenue (which 
is our total income before non-interest expense, plus provision for loan losses), and net interest income was $46.1 million, 
or 47.4% of gross revenue. 

We  believe  that  we  have  developed  a  unique  approach  to  private  banking  to  best  serve  our  Western  wealth 

management clients primarily as a result of the combination of the following factors: 

  Offering sophisticated wealth management products and services, including traditional banking as well as 
trust, wealth planning, investment management and other related services often provided by larger financial 
institutions with the high-touch and personalized experience that is typically associated with community and 
trust banks; 

  Delivering services through our strategically located private trust bank offices, which we refer to internally 

as "profit centers"; and 

  Using our relationship-based team approach to become a "trusted advisor" to our clients by understanding 
their investment management, ultimate goals and banking needs and tailoring our products and services to 
meet those needs. 

5 

Our History and Growth 

We were founded in 2002 by our Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and President, Scott C. Wylie, and a group 
of local business leaders with the vision of building the best private bank for the Western wealth management client. Since 
opening our first profit center in Denver, Colorado in 2004, we have grown organically primarily by establishing fifteen 
offices, attracting new clients and expanding our relationships with existing clients, as well as through a series of strategic 
acquisitions of various trust, registered investment advisory and other financial services firms.  We completed an initial 
public offering of our common stock on July 23, 2018. Our common stock is listed on the NASDAQ Global Select Market 
under the symbol "MYFW." 

Balance Sheet Growth 

Since  December 31,  2017,  we  have  increased  gross  loans  from  $813.7  million  to  $1.53  billion  as  of 
December 31, 2020,  representing  a  compound  annual  growth  rate  ("CAGR")  of  23.5%  and  we  have  increased  total 
deposits from $816.1 million as of December 31, 2017 to $1.62 billion as of December 31, 2020, representing a CAGR of 
25.7%. 

Revenue, Expense & Pre-Tax, Pre-Provision Income Growth 

Since the year ended December 31, 2017, we have increased gross revenues from $55.2 million to $97.3 million 
for the year ended December 31, 2020, representing a CAGR of 20.8%, while total non-interest expense increased from 
$49.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2017 to $59.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2020, representing 
a CAGR of 6.4%. We calculate operating leverage as the ratio of gross revenue CAGR to the total non-interest expense 
CAGR.  For  the  year  ended  December  31,  2020,  this  327.2%  operating  leverage  has  resulted  in  improved  pre-tax, 
pre-provision income, which increased 5.5 times over the same time period. For 2020, gross revenues grew $32.9 million, 
or  51.2%,  while  non-interest  expense  grew  $5.8  million,  a  10.7%  increase,  resulting  in  a  2020  operating  leverage  of 
478.7%. We have demonstrated significant operating leverage by growing pre-tax, pre-provision income at a faster rate 
than expenses. Pre-tax, pre-provision income is not a generally accepted accounting principle ("GAAP") measure. The 
nearest GAAP measure is income before income tax, which was $33.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2020. See 
"GAAP Reconciliation and Management Explanation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures." Pre-tax, pre-provision income 
increased from $5.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2017 to $37.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2020, 
as indicated in the following chart.  

6 

 
 
 
Our Business Strategy 

We believe we have built a premier private trust bank in the Western United States that is focused on providing 
the best financial solutions to our clients. We are service-driven, solution-oriented and relationship-based. We accomplish 
this by continuing to execute on the following strategies: 

  Building Out Existing Markets.  Once we have established a presence in a particular geographic market that 
contains attractive high net worth household demographics, we then look to establish additional locations 
that are closely situated to sub-concentrations of affluent households and/or commercial activity (a "hub and 
spoke" market build-out, as we have commenced in Denver and Phoenix). We continue to seek out talent to 
hire as part of our strategy of building out existing markets and continue to be successful in hiring teams that 
help us accomplish this goal. We also seek to employ highly capable associates with local market experience 
and relationships.  

  Deepening Existing Client Relationships.  We deliver our services though our fifteen local boutique private 
trust bank offices, loan production offices, and trust offices. This allows us to use multi-discipline sales and 
client service teams, in-market, to ensure we are meeting each client’s comprehensive set of needs. These 
teams take the time to understand the complexities of our clients’ financial world through wealth planning 
solutions  and  create  the  financial  plan  that  helps  them  reach  their  goals.  This  profit  center-based  service 
model is a critical component of our future growth as we continue to develop our understanding of our clients’ 
evolving needs, allowing us to deepen, broaden and grow our existing relationships.  

  Generating Referrals for New Client Relationships.  We believe we have demonstrated a  successful sales 
and marketing capability, built around the personal and professional networks and centers of influence of our 
local profit center leadership. Our existing client base has historically provided a significant amount of new 
clients  through  referrals.  In  surveys,  our  clients  generally  rate  us  very  favorably  overall  in  areas  of 
professionalism, reliability, service-orientation, and trust. We have added wealth advisors in many of our 
profit centers as commissioned sales associates to enhance our acquisition of new clients.  

  Developing Client Relationships through our Product Groups.  Each profit center is designed to feel like a 
boutique private trust bank office and is staffed with business development and client service personnel. The 
profit centers work closely with our central product groups to customize our services to each client’s specific 
situation, without sacrificing the flexibility, expertise and authority to quickly meet complex client needs. 
Our central product groups are designed to support a significantly larger client and AUM base, providing an 
opportunity for significant operating leverage as we open additional profit centers. We have sales and service 
specialists in our product groups, such as Retirement Services and Mortgage Services, who are able to build 
relationships  within  their  area  of  expertise  and  provide  expertise  and  high  quality  service  that  creates  an 
opportunity for a broader relationship across our suite of products and services.  

  Expanding to New Markets.  We believe that our profit centers are  profitable and stable businesses  when 
mature. We also believe that our product group and support center teams have a high degree of operating 
leverage  (i.e., we  believe  that  increasing  the  number  of  profit  centers  would  not  require  a  proportionate 
increase  in  our  product  group  or  support  center  expenses).  Therefore,  a  key  strategy  of  ours  is  to  add 
incremental profit centers and grow them to maturity. We continue to seek out talent as part of our strategy 
of building out existing markets and continue to be successful in hiring teams that help us accomplish this 
goal. The trends in the financial services industry that make our business model successful in our existing 
geographic markets also exist in other locations in the Western United States. Our analysis indicates that 
there are hundreds of  markets and submarkets in the Western United States that could support our profit 
centers and fit our target demographics. As such, we intend to continue to explore new Western United States 
markets with favorable high net worth demographics and competitive landscapes.  

  Growing  our  Core  Deposit  Franchise.  The  strength  of  our  deposit  franchise  is  derived  from  the  long-
standing relationships we have with our clients and the strong ties we  have to the markets we serve. Our 
deposit footprint has provided, and we believe will continue to provide, primary support for our loan growth. 
A key part of our strategy is to continue to enhance our funding sources by continuing to build our private 
and commercial banking capabilities to keep building our base of attractively priced core deposits. 

7 

  Attracting Talent.  Our team of seasoned associates has been, and will continue to be, an important driver of 
our organic growth by further developing relationships with current and potential clients. We have a record 
of hiring experienced associates to enhance our organic growth, and sourcing and hiring talent will continue 
to be a core focus for us.  We have significant insider ownership, and, in 2021, the Board approved stock 
ownership  guidelines  to  further  align  management  and  shareholder  interests.  We  believe  that  our  client 
service model, financial strength, growth strategy and public company status will further enhance our ability 
to attract and retain this talent. 

  Developing  New  Products.  We  seek  to  be  the  primary  source  of  financial  products  and  services  for  our 
clients.  By  continuing  to  expand  our  product  offerings—either  by  internal  product  development  or 
establishing third-party relationships—we work to meet expanding client needs while further diversifying 
our revenue streams. This includes our recent efforts to upgrade our commercial banking capabilities, adding 
market expertise in certain business verticals. 

Our Service Model and Products 

We  deliver  a  broad  array  of  wealth  management  products  and  services  through  our  profit  centers  using  our 
proprietary ConnectView® approach, which looks holistically across a client’s current and projected financial situation. 
We believe providing financial solutions in one area (such as estate, retirement planning or lending) often impacts other 
areas  of  our  clients’  wealth  planning  (such  as  risk  or  balance  sheet  management),  which  provides  us  opportunities  to 
evaluate proposed solutions across multiple business lines and offer additional services to our clients. 

We have designed our business around having each profit center staffed with seasoned management. Typically, 
each profit center team is led by a president, who is a senior investment advisor or banker with strong client relationships 
and sales and leadership skills. The local team includes deposit, loan, trust, wealth planning, and related professionals, 
creating a strong interdisciplinary sales and service team. In addition to this service team, we added wealth advisors as a 
commissioned sales force to several profit centers to enhance our acquisition of new clients. 

We  provide  a  broad  array  of  products  and  services  through  our  boutique  private  trust  bank  offices,  largely 

comprised of the products and services described below. 

Lending 

General.  Through our relationship-oriented private bank lending approach, our strategy is to offer a broad range 
of customized consumer and commercial lending products for the personal investment and business needs of our clients. 
Our clients are typically well diversified and the purpose for their loan and liquidity needs often does not correlate to the 
collateral used to secure the loan. 

Our  commercial  lending  products  include  commercial  loans,  business  term  loans  and  lines  of  credit  to  a 
diversified mix of small and midsized businesses. We offer both owner occupied and non-owner occupied commercial 
real estate ("CRE") loans, as well as construction loans. 

Our consumer lending products include residential first mortgage loans, originated loans for our own portfolio, 
as  well  as  those  for  which  we  conduct  mortgage  banking  activities  whereby  we  originate  and  sell,  servicing-released, 
whole loans in the secondary market. Our mortgage banking loan sales activities are primarily directed at originating single 
family  mortgages,  which  generally  conform  to  Fannie  Mae  guidelines  and  are  delivered  to  the  investor  shortly  after 
funding. Additionally, we offer installment loans and lines of credit, typically to facilitate investment opportunities for 
consumer clients whose financial characteristics support the request. We also provide clients loans collateralized by cash 
and marketable securities. 

We employ experienced banking and business development teams who provide superior client service, value-add 

lending solutions and competitive pricing to market our lending products and services. 

8 

As of December 31, 2020, our loan portfolio contained a balanced and diverse mix of loans, as shown below:  

Our loan portfolio includes commercial and industrial loans, residential real estate loans, commercial real estate 
loans and other consumer loans. The principal risk associated with each category of loans we make is the creditworthiness 
of the borrower. Borrower creditworthiness is affected by general economic conditions and the attributes of the borrower 
and  the  borrower’s  market  or  industry.  We  underwrite  for  strong  cash  flow,  multiple  sources  of  repayment,  adequate 
collateral, borrower experience and backup guarantors. Attributes of the relevant business market or industry include the 
competitive environment, client and supplier availability, the threat of substitutes and barriers to entry and exit. 

1-4 Family Residential.  Our 1-4 family residential loan portfolio consists of loans and home equity lines of credit 
secured  by  1-4  family  residential  properties.  These  loans  typically  enable  borrowers  to  purchase  or  refinance  existing 
homes,  most of  which  serve  as the primary residence of the owner. In addition, some  borrowers secure a commercial 
purpose loan with 1-4 family residential properties. As of December 31, 2020, 1-4 family residential loans were $455.0 
million, or 29.7% of our total loan portfolio, consisting of $89.1 million and $366.0 million of fixed-rate and adjustable-
rate  loans,  respectively.  While  we  typically  originate  loans  with  adjustable  rates  and  maturities  up  to  30  years,  as  of 
December 31, 2020, the average term on our 1-4 family portfolio was 19.3 years with an average remaining term of 17.3 
years. Such loans typically remain outstanding for substantially shorter periods because borrowers often prepay their loans 
in full either upon sale of the property pledged as security or upon refinancing the original loan. 

Commercial loans secured by 1-4 family residential real estate are dependent on the strength of the local economy, 
and  local  residential  and  commercial  real  estate  markets.  Borrower  demand  for  adjustable-rate  compared  to  fixed-rate 
loans is a function of the level of interest rates, the expectations of changes in the level of interest rates, and the difference 
between the interest rates and loans fees offered for fixed-rate mortgage loans as compared to the interest-rates and loans 
fees for adjustable rate loans. 

9 

 
The loan fees, interest rates, and other provisions of mortgage loans are determined by us on the basis of our own 
pricing criteria and competitive market conditions. The loans are secured by the real estate, and appraisals are obtained to 
support the loan amount at origination. Loans collateralized by 1-4 family residential real estate generally are originated 
in  amounts  of  no  more  than  80%  of  appraised  value.  Generally,  our  loans  conform  to  Fannie  Mae  and  Freddie  Mac 
underwriting guidelines and conform to internal policies for debt-to-income or free cash flow levels. We retain a valid lien 
on real estate, obtain a title insurance policy that insures that the property is free from encumbrances and require hazard 
insurance. 

Our focus for mortgage lending is to originate high-quality loans to drive growth in our mortgage loan portfolio. 
Our mortgage strategy includes attracting new loan clients with our mortgage loan products and services, which we believe 
will provide an opportunity for our profit centers to bring in well-qualified prospects, and to cross-sell other products and 
services to clients. We believe that cross-selling enables us to generate additional revenues, increase client retention, and 
provide products that benefit our clients. We have developed a scalable platform, including loan processing, underwriting 
and closings, for both secondary sales and origination of 1-4 family residential mortgages maintained in our portfolio and 
believe we have significant opportunities to grow this business. 

Cash, Securities and Other.  Our cash, securities and other loan portfolio consists of consumer and commercial 
purpose loans that are primarily secured by securities managed and under custody with us, cash on deposit with us or life 
insurance policies. In addition, loans in this portfolio are collateralized with other sources of consumer collateral, which 
typically leaves an immaterial amount of the loan balance unsecured. As of December 31, 2020, loans secured with cash, 
marketable securities and other were $357.0 million, or 23.3% of our total loan portfolio. This segment of our portfolio is 
affected by a variety of local and national economic factors affecting borrowers’ employment prospects, income levels, 
and overall economic sentiment. PPP loans that are fully guaranteed by the SBA are classified within this line item. 

Commercial and Industrial (C&I).  We originate commercial and industrial loans, including working capital lines 
of credit, permanent working capital term loans, business asset loans, acquisition, expansion and development loans, and 
other loan products, primarily in our target markets. These loans are underwritten on the basis of the borrower’s ability to 
service the debt from income, with maturities tied to the underlying life of the collateral. We generally take a lien on all 
business  assets,  including,  among  other  things,  accounts  receivable,  inventory,  equipment,  available  real  estate,    and 
generally  obtain  a  personal  guaranty  of  the  principal(s).  Our  commercial  and  industrial  loans  generally  have  variable 
interest rates and terms that typically range from one to five years. Fixed-rate commercial and industrial loan maturities 
are  generally  short-term,  with  three  to  five-year  maturities,  including  periodic  interest  rate  resets.  As  of 
December 31, 2020, commercial and industrial loans were $146.0 million, or 9.5% of our total loan portfolio. The average 
maturity  on  our  commercial  and  industrial  portfolio  was  4.1  years  with  an  average  remaining  term  of  2.6  years.  This 
portfolio primarily consists of term loans and lines of credit which are mostly dependent on the strength of the industries 
of the related borrowers and the success of their businesses. 

Commercial  Real  Estate,  Owner  Occupied  and  Non-Owner  Occupied.    We  originate  commercial  loans 
collateralized by real estate. These loans may be collateralized by owner occupied or non-owner occupied real estate, as 
well as multi-family residential real estate. Commercial real estate lending typically involves higher loan principal amounts 
and the repayment is dependent, in large part, on sufficient income from the properties securing the loans to cover operating 
expenses and debt service. We require our commercial  real estate loans  to be secured by  well-managed property  with 
adequate margins and generally obtain a guaranty from responsible parties who have outside cash flows, experience and/or 
other assets. Our commercial real estate loans are generally secured by properties used for business purposes such as office 
buildings, industrial facilities and retail facilities. Loan amounts generally do not exceed 80% or 75% of the property’s 
appraised  value  for  owner  occupied  and  non-owner  occupied  respectively.  In  addition,  aggregate  debt  service  ratios, 
including the guarantor’s cash flow and the borrower’s other projects, are required by policy to have a minimum annual 
cash flow to debt service ratio of 2.0x. We require independent appraisals or evaluations from a list of approved appraisers 
on all loans secured by commercial real estate. As of December 31, 2020, owner occupied commercial real estate loans 
were $163.0 million, or  10.6% of our total  loan portfolio, and non-owner occupied commercial real estate loans  were 
$281.9 million, or 18.4% of our total loan portfolio. These loans are primarily dependent on the strength of the industries 
of the related borrowers and the success of their businesses. 

Construction and Development (C&D).  We originate loans to finance the construction of residential and non-
residential properties. Construction and development loans  are generally collateralized by  first liens on real estate and 
usually have floating interest rates. Our construction and development loans typically have maturities of up to two years 

10 

depending on factors such as the type and size of the development and the financial strength of the borrower/guarantor, 
and are typically structured with an interest only construction period. These loans are underwritten to either mature at the 
completion  of  construction,  or  transition  to  a  traditional  amortizing  commercial  real  estate  facility  with  the  terms  and 
characteristics  in  line  with  other  commercial  real  estate  loans  we  hold  in  our  portfolio.  As  of  December 31, 2020, 
construction and development loans were $131.1 million, or 8.5% of our total loan portfolio. 

Concentrations.  Most of our lending activity and credit exposure, including real estate collateral for many of our 
loans, are concentrated in Colorado, Arizona, Wyoming and California, as approximately 87.1% of the loans in our loan 
portfolio as of December 31, 2020 were made to borrowers who live in or conduct business in those states. Our commercial 
real estate loans are generally secured by first liens on real property. The remaining commercial and industrial loans are 
typically secured by general business assets, accounts receivable, inventory and/or the corporate guaranty of the borrower 
and personal guaranty of its principals. The geographic concentration subjects the loan portfolio to the general economic 
conditions  within  Colorado,  Arizona,  Wyoming  and  California.  The  risks  created  by  such  concentrations  have  been 
considered  by  management  in  the  determination  of  the  adequacy  of  the  allowance  for  loan  losses.  As  of 
December 31, 2020, management believes the allowance for loan losses is adequate to absorb probable losses in our loan 
portfolio. 

Sound risk management practices and appropriate levels of capital are essential elements of the commercial real 
estate lending program. Concentrations of commercial real estate exposures add a dimension of risk that compounds the 
risk  inherent  in  individual  loans.  Interagency  guidance  on  commercial  real  estate  concentrations  describe  sound  risk 
management practices which include board and management oversight, portfolio management, management information 
systems,  market analysis, portfolio stress testing and sensitivity analysis, credit underwriting standards, and credit risk 
review  functions.  Management  believes  it  has  implemented  these  practices  in  order  to  monitor  concentrations  in 
commercial real estate in our loan portfolio. 

Credit Policies and Procedures 

General.    Asset  quality  and  robust  underwriting  are  integral  to  our  strategy  and  credit  culture.  We  place  a 
considerable emphasis on effective risk management and preserving sound credit underwriting standards as we grow our 
loan portfolio. Underwriting considerations include collateral, defined sources of repayment, strength of guarantor(s) and 
opportunities to broaden the relationship with the client. Our credit policy requires key risks be identified and measured, 
documented and mitigated, to the extent possible, to seek to ensure the soundness of our loan portfolio. 

Loan  Underwriting  and  Approval.    Historically,  we  believe  we  have  made  sound,  high  quality  loans  while 
recognizing that lending money involves a degree of business risk. We have loan policies designed to assist us in managing 
this business risk. These policies provide a general framework for our loan origination, monitoring and funding activities, 
while  recognizing  that  not  all  risks  can  be  anticipated.  Our  board  of  directors  delegates  limited  lending  authority  to 
individuals  and  internal  loan  committees.  When  the  total  relationship  exceeds  an  individual’s  loan  authority,  a  higher 
authority  or  credit  committee  approval  is  required.  The  objective  of  our  approval  process  is  to  provide  a  disciplined, 
collaborative approach to larger credits while maintaining responsiveness to client needs. Loan decisions are documented 
as to the borrower’s business, purpose of the loan, evaluation of the repayment source and the associated risks, evaluation 
of collateral, covenants and monitoring requirements, and the risk rating rationale. 

Managing  credit  risk  is  an  enterprise-wide  process.  Our  strategy  for  credit  risk  management  includes  well-
defined,  central  credit  policies,  uniform  underwriting  criteria  and  ongoing  risk  monitoring  and  review  processes.  Our 
processes  emphasize  early  stage  review  of  loans,  regular  credit  evaluations  and  management  reviews  of  loans,  which 
supplement the ongoing and proactive credit monitoring and loan servicing provided by our bankers. Our Chief Credit 
Officer, together with our central underwriting, credit administration and loan operations teams, provides credit oversight. 
We periodically review all credit risk portfolios to ensure that the risk identification processes are functioning properly 
and that our credit standards are followed. In addition, a third-party loan review is performed to assist in the identification 
of problem assets and to confirm our internal risk rating of loans. 

Our loan policies include other underwriting guidelines for loans collateralized by real estate. These underwriting 
standards are designed to determine the maximum loan amount that a borrower has the capacity to repay based upon the 
type  of  collateral  securing  the  loan  and  the  borrower’s  income.  Such  loan  policies  include  maximum  amortization 
schedules and loan terms for each category of loans collateralized by liens on real estate. In  addition, our loan policies 

11 

provide guidelines for personal guarantees; an environmental review; loans to employees, executive officers and directors; 
problem loan identification; maintenance of an adequate allowance for loan losses; and other matters relating to lending 
practices. 

We believe that an important part of our assessment of client risk is the ongoing completion of periodic risk rating 
reviews. As part of these reviews, we seek to review the risk rating of each facility within a client relationship and may 
recommend  an  upgrade  or  downgrade  to  the  risk  rating.  We  categorize  loans  into  risk  categories  based  on  relevant 
information  about  the  ability  of  the  borrowers  to  service  their  debt  such  as:  current  financial  information,  historical 
payment experience, credit documentation, public  information, and current economic trends, among other factors. We 
analyze loans individually by classifying the loans as to credit risk on a quarterly basis. We attempt to identify potential 
problem loans early in an effort to seek aggressive resolution of these situations before the loans become a loss, record 
any necessary charge-offs promptly and maintain adequate allowance levels for probable incurred loan losses in the loan 
portfolio. In response to the COVID-19 pandemic, the Company performed increased reviews on clients that could be 
more impacted by shutdowns or other pandemic related issues. See our risk factors and Notes to the Consolidated Financial 
Statements for more on our response to the pandemic. 

Lending Limits.    Our lending activities are subject to a variety of lending limits imposed by state and federal 
regulation. The Bank is subject to a legal lending limit on loans to related borrowers based on the Bank’s capital level. 
The dollar amounts of the Bank’s lending limit increases or decreases as the Bank’s capital increases or decreases. The 
Bank  is  able  to  sell  participations  in  its  larger  loans  to  other  financial  institutions,  which  allows  it  to  manage  the  risk 
involved in these loans and to meet the lending needs of its clients requiring extensions of credit in excess of these limits. 

Deposits 

The strength of our deposit franchise is derived from the long-standing relationships we have with our clients and 
the  strong  ties  we  have  to  the  markets  we  serve.  Our  deposit  footprint  has  provided,  and  we  believe  will  continue  to 
provide, the primary support for our loan growth. A key part of our strategy is to continue to enhance our funding sources 
by continuing to build our private and commercial banking  capabilities to keep building our base of attractively priced 
core deposits. 

We  provide  a  broad  range  of  deposit  products  and  services,  including  demand  deposits,  interest-bearing 
transaction accounts, money market accounts, time and savings deposits, certificates of deposit and CDARS® reciprocal 
products.  We  also  offer  a  range  of  treasury  management  products  including  cash  manager  and  commercial  analysis 
accounts, electronic receivables  management,  remote deposit capture, cash vault services,  merchant services and other 
cash management services. Deposit flows are significantly influenced by general and local economic conditions, changes 
in prevailing interest rates, internal pricing decisions and competition. Our deposits are primarily obtained from depositors 
located in our geographic footprint, and we believe that we have attractive opportunities to capture additional deposits in 
our  markets. In order to attract and retain deposits,  we  rely on providing quality service, offering a  suite of retail and 
commercial products and services and introducing new products and services that meet our clients’ needs as they evolve. 

For liquidity purposes, the Bank occasionally uses brokered deposits. As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, we 

had brokered deposits of $20.7 million and $29.5 million, respectively.  

We have experienced banking and business development teams who we believe provide superior client service, 
creative  cash  management  solutions  and  competitive  pricing  to  market  our  depository  products  and  services.  As  of 
December 31, 2020, total deposits were $1.62 billion, an increase of $533.1 million, or 49.1%, compared to $1.09 billion 
as of December 31, 2019. 

12 

As  of  December 31, 2020,  our  deposit  portfolio  contained  a  balanced  and  diverse  mix  of  deposits,  as  shown 

below: 

Trust and Investment Management, Advisory 

We offer sophisticated wealth advisory and planning services including investment management, trusts and estate 
services, philanthropic services, insurance planning and retirement consulting. Our client relationships frequently include 
in-depth  financial  plans  which  are  based  on  our  proprietary  ConnectView®  approach,  and  sophisticated,  institutional 
quality  investment  management  that  is  driven  by  comprehensive  investment  policy  statements  and  access  to  industry-
leading  money  managers.  These  customized  documents—wealth  plans  and  investment  policy  statements—form  the 
roadmap for how we serve each client and monitor our progress in achieving their goals. 

We have experienced trust officers in several profit centers, plus expert trust and estate attorneys on our central 
product group team, to provide fiduciary services through our profit centers. These include traditional fiduciary, directed 
trusts, special needs trusts, and custody services. Most of our investment management business is conducted through the 
trust department in agency accounts where we are not serving as trustee. 

We also have experienced portfolio managers and business development teams in our profit centers who provide 
high-touch,  tailored  solutions  that  we  believe  further  exemplifies  our  superior  client  service.  These  local  teams  have 
personal and professional networks and relationships with centers of influence to market our wealth advisory products and 
services.  As  of  December 31, 2020,  total  AUM  was  $6.26 billion,  an  increase  of  $67.0 million,  or  1.1%,  compared  to 
$6.19 billion  as  of  December 31, 2019.  The  completion  of  the  sale  of  the  Los  Angeles-based  fixed  income  portfolio 
management team in 2020 resulted in a decrease of $330.6 million in Investment Agency balances. 

13 

 
As of December 31, 2020, we provided fiduciary and advisory services on $6.26 billion of trust and investment 

management assets, as shown below:  

Our investment management platform combines a broad range of asset and sub asset classes meeting the needs 
of  both  taxable  and  tax-free  private  client  accounts  as  well  as  trust  investment  services.  We  deliver  most  of  our 
discretionary money management by allocating client portfolios across a centrally controlled platform of select third-party 
managers in each asset and sub asset class, including separately  managed and comingled options, and with active and 
passive  management  strategies.  We  also  have  a  limited  number  of  proprietary  products  that  we  believe  further 
differentiates us from many of our competitors. 

We believe acting as an investment manager, and not just a manager of managers, has a number of critical benefits 
for our clients. These include the ability to have our money managers available to meet with clients and prospects, to tailor 
products  and  separately  managed  accounts  for  our  clients,  to  better  educate  and  inform  our  client-facing  portfolio 
managers, and to develop new solutions as market conditions and client needs change. By combining internal research and 
a dedicated team of accredited specialized advisors  like Chartered Financial  Analysts and Certified Financial Planners 
with our pairing of proprietary and third-party investment options, we create unique solutions tailored to the specific needs 
of each of our clients. 

Other Products 

In addition to the traditional loan, deposit and trust and investment management products and services, our profit 
centers are supported by a central team of specialized product experts in our "product groups," which include experienced 
professionals  in  commercial  banking,  investment  management,  wealth  planning,  risk  management/insurance,  personal 
trust, retirement planning and tax-advantaged products, and mortgage lending. We believe that the sophistication of our 
product groups rivals the offerings and expertise typically provided by larger financial institutions. Our product groups are 
led  and  staffed  with  highly  accredited  and  well  known  professionals,  each  with  significant  experience  in  their  fields. 
Beyond  traditional  banking,  trust  and  wealth  management  activities,  at  each  profit  center  we  provide  other  services 
including: 

  Mortgage  Lending.  Although  our  primary  objective  is  to  originate  loans  for  our  own  portfolio,  we  also 
conduct mortgage banking activities in which we originate and sell, servicing-released, whole loans in the 
secondary market. Typically, loans with a fixed interest rate of greater than 10 years are available-for-sale 
and  sold  on  the  secondary  market.  Our  mortgage  banking  loan  sales  activities  are  primarily  directed  at 

14 

 
originating single family mortgages that are priced and underwritten to conform to previously agreed criteria 
before  loan  funding  and  are  delivered  to  the  investor  shortly  after  funding.  The  level  of  future  loan 
originations,  loan  sales  and  loan  repayments  depends  on  overall  credit  availability,  the  interest  rate 
environment, the strength of the general economy, local real estate markets and the housing industry, and 
conditions in the secondary loan sale market. The amount of gain or loss on the sale of loans is primarily 
driven  by  market  conditions  and  changes  in  interest  rates,  as  well  as  our  pricing  and  asset  liability 
management strategies. As of December 31, 2020, we had mortgage loans held for sale of $161.8 million in 
residential mortgage loans we originated. For the year ended  December 31, 2020, we had net proceeds of 
$1.24 billion on mortgage loans that we originated and sold into the secondary market. 

  Treasury Management.  We offer a broad range of customized treasury management products and services 
for  commercial  accounts,  including  disbursement  and  payables  management,  liquidity  management  and 
online business banking services. Our profit center sales and service teams are supported by a central team 
of treasury management specialists and deposit operations professionals.  

  Risk Management/Insurance.  Through the wealth planning process, our profit center teams are supported by 
a central team of insurance planning experts, specializing in risk management services, estate tax law, trusts 
and tax planning. We offer customized solutions in the form of, among others, charitable giving tax strategies, 
deferred-compensation plans, irrevocable life insurance trusts, long-term care insurance, and executive key 
person insurance.  

  Retirement Services, including 401(k) Plan Consulting.  We have a team of retirement plan consultants who 
partner with businesses to sponsor retirement plans. We offer creative corporate retirement plan design and 
analysis solutions and fiduciary liability  management, providing tools such as corporate retirement plans, 
and ERISA regulation compliance, education and expertise. 

Our profit centers and product groups are also supported centrally by teams providing management services such 
technology  support,  marketing,  human  capital  and 
as  operations,  risk  management,  credit  administration, 
accounting/finance services, which we refer to as "support centers." Our associates in our support centers have significant 
experience  in  wealth  management,  investment  advisory,  and  commercial  banking,  including  areas  such  as  lending, 
underwriting,  credit  administration,  risk  management,  accounting/finance,  operations  and  information  technology.  We 
have structured our teams, services and product offerings to use technology to efficiently provide our clients with a high-
touch, solution-oriented experience, that we believe is scalable and provides operating leverage for future growth. 

To demonstrate how these three groups—profit centers, product groups and support centers—work together to 
deliver a highly competitive product offering through a team of local professionals, our investment management offering 
is an example: 

 

In each profit center, there are one or more portfolio managers that work as part of that local team’s sales 
and service delivery. These portfolio managers are typically Certified Financial Planners, and occasionally 
Chartered Financial Analysts, with experience in wealth planning and portfolio construction. They meet with 
clients  and  develop  an  overall  wealth  management  strategy,  specific  goals  and  objectives,  an  investment 
policy statement, and an implementation plan. They use our guided architecture, a diverse array of select 
third-party and proprietary investment products covering a broad range of asset classes as their source for 
portfolio  construction  options,  asset  allocation  and  products.  Sales  and  marketing  support  is  provided 
centrally but delivered locally. 

  Our investment platform is controlled by our central investment research group, which has a strong research 
focus and includes many associates who have Chartered Financial Analyst designations, with oversight by 
our Chief Investment Officer and our Investment Policy Committee.  

  Operational  support  for  these  profit  center  and  product  group  teams  is  provided  by  our  central  trust  and 

investment management support center team. 

15 

Investment Activities 

The primary objectives of our Bank portfolio investment policy are to provide a source of liquidity, to provide an 
appropriate return on funds invested, to manage interest rate risk, to meet pledging requirements and to meet regulatory 
capital requirements. As of December 31, 2020, the carrying value of our investment portfolio totaled $36.7 million, with 
an average yield of 1.9%. 

Our investment policy outlines investment type limitations, security mix parameters, authorization guidelines and 
risk management guidelines. The policy authorizes us to invest in a variety of investment securities, subject to various 
limitations.  Our  current  investment  portfolio  consists  of  obligations  of  the  U.S.  Treasury  and  other  U.S.  government 
agencies, corporate or sponsored entities, including mortgage-backed securities, collateralized mortgage obligations, sub-
debt bonds, and mutual funds. We participate in the Mortgage Partnership Finance ("MPF") Program and are required to 
maintain an investment in Federal Home Loan Bank of Topeka ("FHLB") stock, which investment is based on the level 
of  our  FHLB  borrowings.  Our  board of  directors  has  the  overall  responsibility  for  the  investment  portfolio,  including 
approval of our investment policy. Our Asset and Liability Committee ("ALCO") and management are responsible for 
implementation of the investment policy and monitoring of our investment performance. Our ALCO and management 
review the status of our investment portfolio at least ten times per year. 

Our Markets 

Our strategic market area is defined by metropolitan areas in the Western United States having strong long-term 
economic  growth  prospects,  a  significant  wealth  demographic  measured  by  growth  in  high  net  worth  households,  a 
dynamic commercial business landscape and the ability to sustain one or more of our profit centers. We target households 
with more than $1.0 million in liquid net worth and their related businesses and philanthropic interests. We believe that 
the complex and diverse financial needs of this market segment presents an opportunity to serve a broad array of client 
needs efficiently and cost effectively. 

Our  current  operating  markets  have  a  high  concentration  of  our  targeted  client  segment  and  are  expected  to 
experience high growth, providing opportunity for continued future organic growth through demographic and market share 
growth. 

We  seek  to  expand  our  presence  in  our  existing  markets  as  well  as  other  Western  markets  with  similar 
demographic  profiles.  With  improved  access  to  capital  as  a  result  of  our  initial  public  offering  in  2018,  we  expect  to 
proactively evaluate opportunities to accelerate our organic growth and acquire banks, investment management firms and 
related businesses, while also seeking to hire talented personnel. We believe consolidation in the financial services industry 
along with the industry’s movement towards automated and impersonal client service further presents the Company with 
a unique and significant opportunity. Our business model differentiates us from the industry, which we expect will enable 
us to increase our market share in existing markets and, on a strategic and opportunistic basis, expand our geographic 
footprint into new markets in the Western United States that share similar characteristics to our current markets. 

Enterprise Technology 

We continue to make investments in our information technology systems as we adapt to the changing technology, 
online and mobile, and other platform needs and wants of our clients. We believe that this investment is essential to our 
ability  to  offer  new  products  and  optimize  overall  client  experience,  provide  opportunities  for  future  growth  and 
acquisitions,  and  provide  a  control  structure  that  supports  our  operations.  We  leverage  the  experience  of  a  third-party 
service provider to provide managed information technology services, enhance our IT security, and deliver the technical 
expertise around network design and architecture required to operate effectively. The majority of our systems are hosted 
by third-party service providers. The scalability of this infrastructure supports our growth strategy. In addition, the tested 
capability of these vendors to switch over to replicated systems should allow us to recover our systems, provide redundancy 
and manage business continuity and resiliency effectively in case of a disaster event. 

Enterprise Risk Management 

We place significant emphasis on our holistic approach to integrated risk management that provides oversight, 
control,  and  discipline  to  support  strategic  initiative  and  business  objectives  and  to  promote  a  risk-aware  culture.  We 

16 

implemented the COSO 2017 ERM Framework in 2018 and utilize this framework to govern the process of anticipating, 
identifying,  assessing,  managing,  optimizing,  and  monitoring  risks  within  the  organization.  We  have  developed  an 
Enterprise Risk Management ("ERM") Committee that oversees our ERM program. This group contains key members of 
management including the Chief Executive Officer and the Chief Financial Officer. In order to carry out the ERM program, 
we have developed the following objectives to: 

 

 

 

 

 

Integrate ERM practices with our strategy setting process and performance management practices to realize 
benefits related to value; 

Improve the Company’s ability to identify risks and establish appropriate responses to reduce costs and limit 
losses;  

Identify operational gaps to reduce performance variability;  

Include business resiliency in strategy setting; 

Identify interrelated risks within First Western and establish an integrated response; and  

  Assess the positive and negative aspects of risk to address challenges and opportunities within our internal 

and external environment. 

We  routinely  monitor  and  measure  risk  throughout  the  organization  to  optimize  the  allocation  of  resources, 

preserve capital, and to ensure the attainment and/or protection of strategic goals and business objectives. 

Competition 

The financial services industry is highly competitive and we compete in a number of areas, including commercial 
and  consumer  banking,  residential  mortgages,  wealth  advisory,  investment  management,  trust,  and  insurance  among 
others.  We  compete  with  other  bank  and  nonbank  institutions  located  within  our  market  area,  along  with  competitors 
situated  regionally,  nationally  or  with  only  an  online  presence.  These  include  large  banks  and  other  financial 
intermediaries, such as consumer finance companies, brokerage firms, mortgage banking companies, business leasing and 
finance companies and insurance agencies, as well as major retailers, all actively engaged in providing various types of 
loans  and  other  financial  services.  We  also  face  growing  competition  from  online  businesses  with  few  or  no  physical 
locations, including online banks, lenders and consumer and commercial lending platforms as well as automated retirement 
and investment  services providers. Competition involves efforts to retain current clients, obtain new  loan, deposit and 
advisory  services  clients,  increase  the  scope  and  type  of  services  offered,  and  offer  competitive  interest  rates  paid  on 
deposits, charged on loans, or charged for advisory services. We believe our integrated and high-touch service offering, 
along with our sophisticated relationship-oriented approach sets us apart from our competitors. 

Human Capital 

As  of  December 31, 2020,  we  had  305  associates.  We  strive  to  recruit  and  retain  team-oriented,  respectful, 
problem solvers. We serve our internal team with the same approach we serve our clients, with an adaptive, entrepreneurial 
spirit. We take advantage of new opportunities, and encourage our team to explore new processes, products, and services 
to improve First Western. Associates are our trusted partner both within  their teams and with our clients as we build a 
partnership for generations to come. We provide extensive training to our associates in an effort to ensure that our clients 
receive superior service and that our risks are well managed. We offer a total rewards program which includes competitive 
compensation, incentives, and health benefits. None of our associates are represented by any collective bargaining unit or 
are parties to a collective bargaining agreement. We believe that our strong relationships with our associates are central to 
establishing the corporate culture we need to serve our clients and our communities well. 

Available Information 

The  Company  files  reports,  proxy  statements  and  other  information  with  the  Securities  and  Exchange 
Commission ("SEC") under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the "Exchange Act"). Electronic copies of 

17 

our SEC filings are available to the public at the SEC’s website at https://www.sec.gov. You may also obtain copies of our 
annual, quarterly and special reports, proxy statements and certain other information filed by the Company with the SEC, 
as well as amendments thereto, free of charge from the Company’s website, https://myfw.gcs-web.com/investor-relations. 
These documents are posted to our website after we have filed them with the SEC. Our corporate governance guidelines, 
including our code of business conduct and ethics applicable to all of our associates, officers and directors, as well as the 
charters  of  our  audit  committee,  compensation  committee  and  corporate  governance  and  nominating  committee  are 
available  at  https://myfw.gcs-web.com/investor-relations.  The  foregoing  information  is  also  available  in  print  to  any 
shareholder who requests it from the Company. Except as explicitly provided, information furnished by the Company and 
information on, or accessible through, the SEC’s or the Company’s website is not incorporated into this Annual Report on 
Form 10-K or our other securities filings and is not a part of them.  

Supervision and Regulation 

The U.S. banking industry is highly regulated under federal and state law. Banking laws, regulations, and policies 
affect the operations of the Company and its subsidiaries. Investors should understand that the primary objective of the 
U.S. bank regulatory regime is the protection of depositors, the Deposit Insurance Fund ("DIF"), and the banking system 
as a whole, not the protection of the Company’s shareholders. 

As a bank holding company, we are subject to inspection, examination, supervision, and regulation by the Board 
of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the "Federal Reserve"). The Bank, which is our subsidiary, is a Colorado-
chartered commercial bank and is not a member of the Federal Reserve System (a "state nonmember bank"). As such, the 
Bank is subject to regulation, supervision, and examination by both the Colorado Division of Banking (the  "CDB") and 
the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation ("FDIC"). In addition, we expect that any additional businesses that we may 
invest in or acquire will be regulated by various state and/or federal banking regulators. 

Banking statutes and regulations are subject to continual review and revision by Congress, state legislatures and 
federal  and  state  regulatory  agencies.  A  change  in  such  statutes  or  regulations,  including  changes  in  how  they  are 
interpreted or implemented, could have a material effect on our business. In addition to laws and regulations, state and 
federal bank regulatory agencies may issue policy statements, interpretive letters and similar written guidance pursuant to 
such laws and regulations, which are binding on us and our subsidiaries. 

Banking  statutes,  regulations  and  policies  could  restrict  our  ability  to  diversify  into  other  areas  of  financial 
services, acquire depository institutions, and make distributions or pay dividends on our equity securities. They may also 
require us to provide financial support to any bank that we control, maintain capital balances in excess of those desired by 
management, and pay higher deposit insurance premiums as a result of a general deterioration in the financial condition 
of the Bank or other depository institutions we control. 

The  description  below  summarizes  certain  elements  of  the  applicable  bank  regulatory  framework.  This 
description is not intended to describe all laws and regulations applicable to us and our subsidiaries. The description is 
qualified in its entirety by reference to the full text of the statutes, regulations, policies, interpretive letters and other written 
guidance that are described. 

Regulatory Capital 

The Company and the Bank are each required to comply with applicable capital adequacy standards established 
by the Federal Reserve and the FDIC. The current risk-based capital standards applicable to the Company and the Bank 
are based on the December 2010 final capital framework for strengthening international capital standards, known as Basel 
III,  of  the  Basel  Committee  on  Banking  Supervision,  or  Basel  Committee.  The  final  rules implementing  the  Basel 
Committee on Banking Supervision’s capital guidelines for U.S. banks ("Basel III Rules") has been fully phased in. The 
Basel  III  Rules  require  banks  and  bank  holding  companies,  including  the  Company  and  the  Bank,  to  maintain  four 
minimum capital standards: (1) a Tier 1 capital to adjusted total assets ratio, or leverage capital ratio, of at least 4.0%; (2) a 
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets ratio, or Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio, of at least 6.0%; (3) a total capital (Tier 1 plus 
Tier 2)  to  risk-weighted  assets  ratio,  or  total  risk-based  capital  ratio,  of  at  least  8.0%;  and  (4) a  common  equity  tier  1 
("CET1") capital to risk-weighted assets ratio, or CET1 risk-based capital ratio, of at least 4.5%.  

18 

The Basel III Capital Rules also call for bank holding companies and banks to maintain a "capital conservation 
buffer" on top of the minimum risk-based capital requirements. The buffer must be composed of CET1 capital. This buffer 
is intended to help to ensure that banking organizations conserve capital when it is most needed, allowing them to better 
weather periods of economic stress. The buffer is 2.5% of risk-weighted assets. 

The  Basel  III  Capital  Rules  also  attempt  to  improve  the  quality  of  capital  by  implementing  changes  to  the 
definition of capital. Among the most important changes are stricter eligibility criteria for regulatory capital instruments 
that disallow the inclusion of certain instruments, such as trust preferred securities (other than grandfathered trust preferred 
securities such as those issued by the Company), in Tier 1 capital going forward and new constraints on the inclusion of 
minority interests, mortgage-servicing assets, deferred tax assets and certain investments in the capital of unconsolidated 
financial institutions. In addition, the Basel III Capital Rules require that most regulatory capital deductions be made from 
CET1 capital. 

The  Federal Reserve and the FDIC  may also set higher capital requirements for individual institutions  whose 
circumstances warrant it. For example, institutions experiencing internal growth or making acquisitions are expected to 
maintain  strong  capital  positions  substantially  above  the  minimum  supervisory  levels,  without  significant  reliance  on 
intangible assets. At this time, the bank regulatory agencies are more inclined to impose higher capital requirements to 
meet well capitalized standards and future regulatory change could impose higher capital standards as a routine matter. 
The Company’s regulatory capital ratios and those of the Bank are in excess of the levels established for "well capitalized" 
institutions under the rules. 

The Basel III Capital Rules also set forth certain changes in the  methods of calculating  certain risk-weighted 
assets, which in turn affects the calculation of risk-based capital ratios. Under the Basel III Capital Rules, higher or more 
sensitive risk weights have been assigned to various categories of assets, including certain credit facilities that finance the 
acquisition,  development  or  construction  of  real  property,  certain  exposures  or  credits  that  are  90 days  past  due  or  on 
nonaccrual status, foreign exposures and certain corporate exposures. In addition, these rules include greater recognition 
of collateral and guarantees, and revised capital treatment for derivatives and repo-style transactions. 

The federal bank regulators have  modified certain aspects  of the Basel III Capital  Rules since the rules  were 
initially  published,  and  additional  modifications  may  be  made  in  the  future.  In  December  2017,  the  Basel  Committee 
published standards that it described as the finalization of the Basel III post-crisis regulatory reforms (commonly referred 
to as Basel IV). Among other things, these standards revise the Basel Committee’s standardized approach for credit risk 
(including by recalibrating risk weights and introducing new capital requirements for certain "unconditionally cancellable 
commitments," such as unused credit card lines of credit) and provides a new standardized approach for operational risk 
capital. Under the Basel framework, these standards will generally be effective on January 1, 2023, with an aggregate 
output floor phasing in through January 1, 2028. Under the current U.S. capital rules, operational risk capital requirements 
and a capital floor apply only to advanced approaches institutions, and not to the Company or the Bank. The impact of 
Basel IV on us will depend on the manner in which it is implemented by the federal bank regulators. 

In  accordance  with  the  Economic  Growth,  Regulatory  Relief,  and  Consumer  Protection  Act  (the  "Regulatory 
Relief  Act"),  discussed  below,  the  federal  banking  agencies  published  final  rules  implementing  the  community  bank 
leverage ratio in November 2019. Under the final rules, which went into effect on January 1, 2020, depository institutions 
and depository institution holding companies that have less than $10 billion in total consolidated assets and meet other 
qualifying criteria, including a leverage capital ratio of greater than 9%, off-balance-sheet exposures of 25% or less of 
total consolidated assets and trading assets plus trading liabilities of 5% or less of total consolidated assets, are deemed 
"qualifying community banking organizations" and are eligible to opt into the community bank leverage ratio framework.  
A qualifying community banking organization that elects to use the community bank leverage ratio framework and that 
maintains a leverage capital ratio of greater than 9% is considered to have satisfied the generally applicable risk-based and 
leverage  capital requirements under the  Basel III Capital Rules and, if applicable, is considered to have  met the  “well 
capitalized” ratio requirements for purposes of its primary  federal regulators prompt corrective action rules, discussed 
below. Pursuant to the CARES Act, the federal banking agencies authorities adopted an interim rule, which temporarily 
reduced the Community Bank Leverage Ratio to 8%. This provision terminated on December 31, 2020.The Company and 
the Bank have not made an election to use the community bank leverage ratio framework but may make such an election 
in the future if determined to be possible and advantageous. 

19 

Regulation of the Company 

The Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended ("BHC Act"), and other federal laws subject bank holding 
companies to particular restrictions on the types of activities in which they may engage, and to a range of supervisory 
requirements and activities, including regulatory enforcement actions for violations of laws and regulations. 

Permitted Activities.    Generally, bank holding companies are prohibited under the BHC Act from engaging in, 
or acquiring direct or indirect control of more than 5% of the voting shares of any company engaged in any activity other 
than (i) banking or managing or controlling banks or (ii) an activity that the Federal Reserve determines to be so closely 
related to banking as to be a proper incident to the business of banking. The Federal Reserve has the authority to require a 
bank holding company to terminate an activity or terminate control of or liquidate or divest certain subsidiaries or affiliates 
when the Federal Reserve believes the activity or the control of the subsidiary or affiliate constitutes a significant risk to 
the financial safety, soundness or stability of any of its banking subsidiaries. 

Status as a Financial Holding Company.    Under the BHC Act, a bank holding company may file an election 
with the Federal Reserve to be treated as a financial holding company and engage in an expanded list of financial activities. 
The election must be accompanied by a certification that all of the company’s insured depository institution subsidiaries 
are "well capitalized" and "well managed." Additionally, the Community Reinvestment Act of 1977 ("CRA") rating of 
each  subsidiary  bank  must  be  satisfactory  or  better.  If,  after  becoming  a  financial  holding  company  and  undertaking 
activities not permissible for a bank holding company, the company fails to continue to meet any of the prerequisites for 
financial holding company status, the company must enter into an agreement with the Federal Reserve to comply with all 
applicable  capital  and  management  requirements.  If  the  company  does  not  return  to  compliance  within  180 days,  the 
Federal  Reserve  may  order  the  company  to  divest  its  subsidiary  banks  or  the  company  may  discontinue  or  divest 
investments in companies engaged in activities permissible only for a bank holding company that has elected to be treated 
as a financial holding company. The Company filed an election and became a financial holding company in 2006. 

Sound  Banking  Practices.    Bank  holding  companies  and  their  non-banking  subsidiaries  are  prohibited  from 
engaging in activities that represent unsafe or unsound banking practices. For example, under certain circumstances the 
Federal Reserve’s Regulation Y requires a holding company to give the Federal Reserve prior notice of any redemption 
or repurchase of its own equity  securities if  the consideration to be paid, together  with the consideration paid  for any 
repurchases in the preceding year, is equal to 10% or more of the company’s consolidated net worth. The Federal Reserve 
may oppose the transaction if it believes that the  transaction  would constitute an unsafe  or unsound practice or would 
violate a regulation. As another example, a holding company is prohibited from impairing its subsidiary bank’s soundness 
by causing the bank to make funds available to non-banking subsidiaries or their clients if the Federal Reserve believes it 
not prudent to do so. The Federal Reserve has the power to assess civil money penalties for knowing or reckless violations 
if the activities leading to a violation caused a substantial loss to a depository institution. Potential penalties are as high as 
$1.0 million for each day the activity continues. 

Source  of  Strength.    In  accordance  with  the  Dodd-Frank  Act  and  long-standing  Federal  Reserve  policy,  the 
Company must act as a source of financial and managerial strength to the Bank. Under this policy, the Company must 
commit resources to support the Bank, including at times when the Company may not be in a financial position to provide 
it.  As  discussed  below,  the  Company  could  be  required  to  guarantee  the  capital  plan  of  the  Bank  if  it  becomes 
undercapitalized for purposes of banking regulations. Any capital loans by a bank holding company to its subsidiary bank 
are subordinate in right of payment to deposits and to certain other indebtedness of such subsidiary bank. The BHC Act 
provides that, in the event of a bank holding company’s bankruptcy, any commitment by the bank holding company to a 
federal bank regulatory agency to maintain the capital of a bank subsidiary will be assumed by the bankruptcy trustee and 
entitled to priority of payment. 

Regulatory  agencies  have  promulgated  regulations  to  increase  the  capital  requirements  for  bank  holding 

companies to a level that matches those of banking institutions. 

Anti-Tying  Restrictions.    Bank  holding  companies  and  affiliates  are  prohibited  from  tying  the  provision  of 

services, such as extensions of credit, to other services offered by a holding company or its affiliates. 

Acquisitions.    The BHC Act, Section 18(c) of the  Federal Deposit Insurance  Act, as amended ("FDIA"), the 
Colorado Banking Code and other federal and state statutes regulate acquisitions of commercial banks and their holding 

20 

companies. The BHC Act generally limits acquisitions by bank holding companies to commercial banks and companies 
engaged in activities that the Federal Reserve has determined to be so closely related to banking as to be a proper incident 
thereto. The BHC Act requires every bank holding company to obtain the prior approval of the Federal Reserve before: 
(i) acquiring  more  than  5%  of  the  voting  stock  of  any  bank  or  other  bank  holding  company;  (ii) acquiring  all  or 
substantially all of the assets of any bank or bank holding company; or (iii) merging or consolidating with any other bank 
holding company. 

In reviewing applications seeking approval of merger and acquisition transactions, the bank regulatory authorities 
generally consider, among other things, the competitive effect and public benefits of the transactions, the financial and 
managerial resources and future prospects of the combined organization (including the capital position of the combined 
organization),  the  applicant’s  performance  record  under  the  Community  Reinvestment  Act,  (see  the  section  captioned 
"Community  Reinvestment  Act"  included  below  in  this  item),  fair  housing  laws  and  the  effectiveness  of  the  subject 
organizations in combating money laundering activities. 

The Company is also subject to the Change in Bank Control Act  of 1978 ("Control Act") and related Federal 
Reserve regulations, which provide that any person who proposes to acquire at least 10% (but less than 25%) of any class 
of a bank holding company’s voting securities is presumed to control the company (unless the company is not publicly 
held or some other shareholder owns a greater percentage of voting stock). Any person who would be presumed to acquire 
control or who proposes to acquire control of 25% or more of any class of a bank holding company’s voting securities, or 
who proposes to acquire actual control, must provide the Federal Reserve with at least 60 days’ prior written notice of the 
acquisition.  The  Federal  Reserve  may  disapprove  a  proposed  acquisition  if:  (i) it  would  result  in  adverse  competitive 
effects; (ii) the financial condition of the acquiring person might jeopardize the target institution’s financial stability or 
prejudice the interests of depositors; (iii) the competence, experience or integrity of any acquiring person indicates that the 
proposed acquisition would not be in the best interests of the depositors or the public; or (iv) the acquiring person fails to 
provide all of the information required by the Federal Reserve. Any proposed acquisition of the voting securities of a bank 
holding company that is subject to approval under the BHC Act is not subject to the Control Act notice requirements. Any 
company that proposes to acquire "control," as those terms are defined in the BHC Act and Federal Reserve regulations, 
of a bank holding company or to acquire 25% or more of any class of voting securities of a bank holding company would 
be required to seek the Federal Reserve’s prior approval under the BHC Act to become a bank holding company. 

Dividends.    The  Company’s  earnings  and  activities  are  affected  by  legislation,  by  regulations  and  by  local 
legislative  and  administrative  bodies  and decisions  of  courts  in  the  jurisdictions  in  which  we  conduct  business.  These 
include limitations on the ability of the Bank to pay dividends to the Company and the Company’s ability to pay dividends 
to its  shareholders. It is the policy of the Federal  Reserve  that bank holding companies  should pay cash dividends on 
common stock only out of income available over the past year and only if prospective earnings retention is consistent with 
the organization’s expected future needs and financial condition. The policy provides that bank holding companies should 
not maintain a level of cash dividends that undermines the bank holding company’s ability to serve as a source of strength 
to its banking subsidiary.  Consistent  with  such policy, a  banking organization should  have comprehensive policies on 
dividend payments that clearly articulate  the  organization’s objectives and approaches for maintaining a strong capital 
position and achieving the objectives of the policy statement. 

As a  Colorado state-chartered bank, the Bank is subject to limitations under Colorado law on the payment of 
dividends.  The  Colorado  Banking  Code  provides  that  a  bank  may  declare  dividends  from  retained  earnings  and  other 
components of capital specifically approved by the Colorado State Banking Board so long as the declaration is made in 
compliance with rules established by the Colorado State Banking Board. 

In addition, a state nonmember bank may not declare a dividend if paying the dividend would result in the bank 
being  undercapitalized under FDIA, discussed above, and must comply  with any discretionary distribution restrictions 
imposed  on  it  under  the  federal  banking  agencies’  capital  buffer  rules.  The  FDIC  has  stated  that,  in  general,  state 
nonmember banks can pay dividends in reasonable amounts only after the bank’s earnings have first been applied to the 
elimination of losses and the establishment of necessary reserves and prudent capital levels. The FDIC may also direct 
state nonmember banks that are poorly rated or subject to written supervisory actions not to pay dividends in order to 
ensure adequate capital exists to support their risk profile. 

In 2009, the Federal Reserve issued a supervisory letter providing greater clarity to its policy statement on the 
payment of dividends by bank holding companies. In this letter, the Federal Reserve stated that when a holding company’s 

21 

board of directors is deciding on the level of dividends to declare, it should consider, among other factors: (i) overall asset 
quality,  potential  need  to  increase  reserves  and  write  down  assets,  and  concentrations  of  credit;  (ii) potential  for 
unanticipated losses and declines in asset values; (iii) implicit and explicit liquidity and credit commitments, including 
off-balance sheet and contingent liabilities; (iv) quality and level of current and prospective earnings, including earnings 
capacity under a number of plausible economic scenarios; (v) current and prospective cash flow and liquidity; (vi) ability 
to serve as an ongoing source of financial and managerial strength to depository institution subsidiaries insured by the 
FDIC, including the extent of double leverage and the condition of subsidiary depository institutions; (vii) other risks that 
affect the holding company’s financial condition and are not fully captured in regulatory capital calculations; (viii) level, 
composition, and quality of capital; and (ix) ability to raise additional equity capital in prevailing market and economic 
conditions (the "Dividend Factors"). It is particularly important for a bank holding company’s board of directors to ensure 
that the dividend level is prudent relative to the organization’s financial position and is not based on overly optimistic 
earnings  scenarios.  In  addition,  a  bank  holding  company’s  board  of  directors  should  strongly  consider,  after  careful 
analysis of the Dividend Factors, reducing, deferring or eliminating dividends when the quantity and quality of the holding 
company’s  earnings  have  declined  or  the  holding  company  is  experiencing  other  financial  problems,  or  when  the 
macroeconomic outlook for the holding company’s primary profit centers has deteriorated. The Federal Reserve further 
stated that, as a general matter, a bank holding company should eliminate, defer or significantly reduce its distributions if: 
(i) its net income is not sufficient to fully fund the dividends; (ii) its prospective rate of earnings retention is not consistent 
with its capital needs and overall current and prospective financial condition; or (iii) it will not meet, or is in danger of not 
meeting, its minimum regulatory capital adequacy ratios. Failure to do so could result in a supervisory finding that the 
bank holding company is operating in an unsafe and unsound manner. 

Additionally, the Federal Reserve possesses enforcement powers over bank holding companies and their non-
bank subsidiaries with which it can prevent or remedy actions that represent unsafe or unsound practices, or violations of 
applicable statutes and regulations. Among these powers is the ability to proscribe the payment of dividends by banks and 
bank holding companies. 

Stock  Redemptions  and  Repurchases.    It  is  an  essential  principle  of  safety  and  soundness  that  a  banking 
organization’s redemption and repurchases of regulatory capital instruments, including common stock, from investors be 
consistent with the organization’s current and prospective capital needs. In assessing such needs, the board of directors 
and management of a bank holding company should consider the Dividend Factors discussed above under "Dividends." 
The risk-based capital rule directs bank holding companies to consult  with  the  Federal Reserve before redeeming any 
equity or other capital instrument included in  Tier 1 or Tier 2 capital prior to stated maturity, if such redemption could 
have a material effect on the level or composition of the organization’s capital base. Bank holding companies that are 
experiencing financial weaknesses, or that are at significant risk of developing financial weaknesses, must consult with 
the appropriate Federal Reserve supervisory staff before redeeming or repurchasing common stock or other regulatory 
capital instruments for cash or other valuable consideration. Similarly, any bank holding company considering expansion, 
whether  through  acquisitions  or  through  organic  growth  and  new  activities,  generally  also  must  consult  with  the 
appropriate Federal Reserve supervisory staff before redeeming or repurchasing common stock or other regulatory capital 
instruments  for  cash  or  other  valuable  consideration.  In  evaluating  the  appropriateness  of  a  bank  holding  company’s 
proposed redemption or repurchase of capital instruments, the Federal Reserve will consider the potential losses that the 
holding company may suffer from the prospective need to increase reserves and write down assets from continued asset 
deterioration and the holding company’s ability to raise additional common stock and other Tier 1 capital to replace capital 
instruments that are redeemed or repurchased. A bank holding company must inform the Federal Reserve of a redemption 
or repurchase of common stock or perpetual preferred stock for cash or other value resulting in a net reduction of the bank 
holding company’s outstanding amount of common stock or perpetual preferred stock below the amount of such capital 
instrument outstanding at the beginning of the quarter in which the redemption or repurchase occurs. In addition, a bank 
holding company must advise the Federal Reserve sufficiently in advance of such redemptions and repurchases to provide 
reasonable opportunity for supervisory review and possible objection should the Federal Reserve determine a transaction 
raises safety and soundness concerns. 

Regulation Y requires that a bank holding company that is not well capitalized or well managed, or that is subject 
to any unresolved supervisory issues, provide prior notice to the Federal Reserve for any repurchase or redemption of its 
equity securities for cash or other value that would reduce by 10% or more the holding company’s consolidated net worth 
aggregated over the preceding 12-month period. 

22 

Annual Reporting; Examinations.   The Company is required to file an annual report with the Federal Reserve 
and to provide such additional information as the Federal Reserve may require. The Federal Reserve may examine a bank 
holding company and any of its subsidiaries, and charge the company for the cost of such an examination. 

The Bank is examined from time to time by its primary federal banking regulator, the FDIC, and the CDB and is 
charged for the cost of such an examination. Depending on the results of a given examination, the FDIC and the CDB may 
revalue the Bank’s assets and require that the Bank establish specific reserves to compensate for the difference between 
the value determined by the regulator and the book value of the assets. The Company is required to provide annual audited 
financial statements and other information to the FDIC as required under Part 363 of FDIC rules and regulations. 

Imposition  of  Liability  for  Undercapitalized  Subsidiaries.    FDIA  requires  bank  regulators  to  take  "prompt 
corrective action" to resolve problems associated with insured depository institutions. In the event an institution becomes 
"undercapitalized,"  it  must  submit  a  capital  restoration  plan.  The  capital  restoration  plan  will  not  be  accepted  by  the 
regulators  unless  each  company  "having  control  of"  the  undercapitalized  institution  "guarantees"  the  subsidiary’s 
compliance with the capital restoration plan until it becomes  "adequately capitalized." For purposes of this statute, the 
Company has control of the Bank. Under FDIA, the aggregate liability of all companies controlling a particular institution 
is limited to the lesser of five percent of the depository institution’s total assets at the time it became undercapitalized or 
the amount necessary to bring the institution into compliance with applicable capital standards. FDIA grants greater powers 
to  bank  regulators  in  situations  where  an  institution  becomes  "significantly"  or  "critically"  undercapitalized  or  fails  to 
submit a capital restoration plan. For example, a bank holding company controlling such an institution can be required to 
obtain prior Federal Reserve approval of proposed distributions, or might be required to consent to a merger or to divest 
the troubled institution or other affiliates. 

State Law Restrictions.    As a Colorado corporation, the Company is subject to certain limitations and restrictions 
under  applicable  Colorado  corporate  law.  For  example,  state  law  restrictions  in  Colorado  include  limitations  and 
restrictions  relating  to  indemnification  of  directors;  distributions  and  dividends  to  shareholders;  transactions  involving 
directors,  officers  or  interested  shareholders;  maintenance  of  books,  records,  and  minutes;  and  observance  of  certain 
corporate formalities. 

Regulation of the Bank 

Capital Adequacy. Under the Basel III Capital Rules, discussed above, the FDIC monitors the capital adequacy 
of the Bank by using a combination of risk-based guidelines and leverage ratios. The FDIC considers the Bank’s capital 
levels when taking action on various types of applications and when conducting supervisory activities related to the safety 
and soundness of the Bank and the banking system. Higher capital levels may be required if warranted by the circumstances 
or risk profiles of individual institutions, or if required by the banking regulators due to the economic conditions impacting 
our  markets.  For  example,  FDIC  regulations  provide  that  higher  capital  may  be  required  to  take  adequate  account  of, 
among other things, interest rate risk and the risks posed by concentrations of credit, nontraditional activities or securities 
trading activities. 

As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, the Bank exceeded all regulatory minimum capital requirements. 

Prompt Corrective Regulatory Action.    Under applicable federal statutes, the federal bank regulatory agencies 
are required to take "prompt corrective  action" with respect to institutions that do not meet specified minimum capital 
requirements.  For  these  purposes,  the  law  establishes  five  capital  categories:  well  capitalized,  adequately  capitalized, 
undercapitalized, significantly undercapitalized and critically undercapitalized. Under the FDIC’s prompt corrective action 
regulations, an institution is deemed to be "well capitalized" if it has a total risk-based capital ratio of 10.0% or greater, a 
Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 8.0% or greater, a CET1 risk-based capital ratio of 6.5% or greater and a leverage capital 
ratio of 5.0% or greater. An institution is "adequately capitalized" if it has a total risk-based capital ratio of 8.0% or greater, 
a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 6.0% or greater, a CET1 risk-based capital ratio of 4.5% or greater and a leverage capital 
ratio of 4.0% or greater. An institution is "undercapitalized" if it has a total risk-based capital ratio of less than 8.0%, a 
Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of less than 6.0%, a CET1 risk-based capital ratio of less than 4.5% or a leverage capital 
ratio of less than 4.0%. An institution is deemed to be "significantly undercapitalized" if it has a total risk-based capital 
ratio of less than 6.0%, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of less than 4.0%, a CET1 capital ratio of less than 3.0% or a 
leverage capital ratio of less than 3.0%. An institution is considered to be "critically undercapitalized" if it has a ratio of 
tangible equity to total assets that is equal to or less than 2.0%. 

23 

 Undercapitalized institutions are subject to growth limitations and are required to submit a capital restoration 
plan to the FDIC. The federal bank regulatory agencies may not accept such a plan without determining, among other 
things,  that  the  plan  is  based  on  realistic  assumptions  and  is  likely  to  succeed  in  restoring  the  depository  institution’s 
capital. In addition, for a capital restoration plan to be acceptable, the depository institution’s parent holding company 
must guarantee that the institution will comply with such capital restoration plan. If a depository institution fails to submit 
an  acceptable  plan,  it  is  treated  as  if  it  is  "significantly  undercapitalized."  "Significantly  undercapitalized"  depository 
institutions may be subject to a number of requirements and restrictions, including orders to sell sufficient voting stock to 
become  "adequately  capitalized,"  requirements  to  reduce  total  assets,  and  cessation  of  receipt  of  deposits  from 
correspondent banks. "Critically undercapitalized" institutions are subject to the appointment of a receiver or conservator. 

As of December 31, 2020, the Bank qualified as "well capitalized" under the prompt corrective action rules. 

Deposit  Insurance  Assessments.    All  of  a  depositor’s  accounts  at  an  insured  bank,  including  all  noninterest-
bearing transaction accounts, are insured by the FDIC up to $250,000. FDIC-insured banks are required to pay deposit 
insurance premiums to the FDIC. The FDIC has adopted a risk-based assessment system whereby FDIC-insured depository 
institutions pay insurance premiums at rates based on their risk classification. An institution’s risk classification is assigned 
based  on  current  financial  ratios  and  supervisory  ratings  of  the  institution’s  financial  condition  and  operations. 
Assessments  are  based  on  an  institution’s  average  consolidated  total  assets  less  average  tangible  equity,  subject  to 
adjustments for certain types of institutions, including custodial banks. 

The FDIC may terminate a depository institution’s deposit insurance upon a finding that the institution’s financial 
condition  is  unsafe  or  unsound  or  that  the  institution  has  engaged  in  unsafe  or  unsound  practices  or  has  violated  any 
applicable  rule,  regulation,  order  or  condition  enacted  or  imposed  by  the  institution’s  regulatory  agency.  If  deposit 
insurance for a banking business that we invest in or acquire were to be terminated, that would have a material adverse 
effect on that banking business and potentially on the Company as a whole. 

Depositor Preference.    FDIA provides that, in the event of the "liquidation or other resolution" of an insured 
depository institution, the claims of depositors of the institution, including the claims of the FDIC as subrogee of insured 
depositors, and certain claims for administrative expenses of the FDIC as a receiver, will have priority over other general 
unsecured claims against the institution. If an insured depository institution fails, insured and uninsured depositors, along 
with the FDIC, will have priority in payment ahead of unsecured, non-deposit creditors, including the parent bank holding 
company, with respect to any extensions of credit they have made to such insured depository institution. 

Consumer Financial Protection.    The Bank is subject to a number of federal and state consumer protection laws 
that extensively govern its relationship  with its clients. These laws include the Equal Credit Opportunity  Act, the Fair 
Credit Reporting Act, the Truth in Lending Act, the Truth in Savings Act, the Electronic Fund Transfer Act, the Expedited 
Funds Availability Act, the Home Mortgage Disclosure Act, the Fair Housing Act, the Real Estate Settlement Procedures 
Act, the Fair Debt Collection Practices Act, the Right to Financial Privacy Act, the Service Members Civil Relief Act and 
these laws’ respective state law counterparts, as well as state usury laws and laws regarding unfair and deceptive acts and 
practices. These and other federal laws, among other things, require disclosures of the cost of credit and terms of deposit 
accounts,  provide substantive consumer rights, prohibit discrimination  in credit transactions, regulate  the  use of credit 
report  information,  provide  financial  privacy  protections,  prohibit  unfair,  deceptive  and  abusive  practices,  restrict  the 
Bank’s ability to raise interest rates and subject the Company and the Bank to substantial regulatory oversight. Violations 
of  applicable  consumer  protection  laws  can  result  in  significant  potential  liability  from  litigation  brought  by  clients, 
including actual damages, restitution and attorneys’ fees. Federal bank regulators, state attorneys general and state and 
local consumer protection agencies may also seek to enforce consumer protection requirements and obtain these and other 
remedies, including regulatory sanctions, customer rescission rights, action by the state and local attorneys general in each 
jurisdiction in which we operate and civil money penalties. Failure to comply with consumer protection requirements may 
also  result  in  our  failure  to  obtain  any  required  bank  regulatory  approval  for  merger  or  acquisition  transactions  the 
Company may want to pursue or our prohibition from engaging in such transactions even if approval is not required. 

The  Consumer  Financial  Protection  Bureau  ("CFPB")  has  broad  rulemaking  authority  for  a  wide  range  of 
consumer  financial  laws  that  apply  to  all  banks.  The  CFPB  is  authorized  to  issue  rules  for  both  bank  and  non-bank 
companies  that  offer  consumer  financial  products  and  services,  subject  to  consultation  with  the  prudential  banking 

24 

 
regulators. In general, however, banks with assets of $10 billion or less, such as the Bank, will continue to be examined 
for consumer compliance by their primary federal bank regulator. 

Much of the CFPB’s rulemaking has focused on mortgage  lending and servicing, including an important rule 
requiring lenders to ensure that prospective buyers have the ability to repay their mortgages. Other areas of current CFPB 
focus  include  consumer  protections  for  prepaid  cards,  payday  lending,  debt  collection,  overdraft  services  and  privacy 
notices. The CFPB has been particularly active in issuing rules and guidelines concerning residential mortgage lending 
and servicing, issuing numerous rules and guidance related to residential mortgages. Perhaps the most significant of these 
guidelines  is  the  "Ability-to-Repay  and  Qualified  Mortgage  Standards  under  the  Truth  in  Lending  Act"  portions  of 
Regulation Z.  Under  the  Dodd-Frank  Act,  creditors  must  make  a  reasonable  and  good  faith  determination,  based  on 
verified  and  documented  information,  that  the  consumer  has  a  reasonable  "ability  to  repay"  a  residential  mortgage 
according to its terms. There is a statutory presumption of compliance with this requirement for mortgages that meet the 
requirements to be deemed "qualified mortgages." The CFPB rule defines the key threshold terms "ability to repay" and 
"qualified mortgage." 

The CFPB has actively issued enforcement actions against both large and small entities and to entities across the 
entire financial service industry. The CFPB has relied upon "unfair, deceptive, or abusive acts" prohibitions as its primary 
enforcement tool. However, the CFPB and Department of Justice ("DOJ") continue to be focused on fair lending in taking 
enforcement actions against banks with renewed emphasis on alleged "redlining" practices. Failure to comply with these 
laws and regulations could give rise to regulatory sanctions, client rescission rights, actions by state and local attorneys 
general and civil or criminal liability. 

Brokered Deposit Restrictions.    Well capitalized institutions are not subject to limitations on brokered deposits, 
while an adequately capitalized institution is able to accept, renew or roll over brokered deposits only with a waiver from 
the FDIC and is subject to certain restrictions on the yield paid on such deposits. Undercapitalized institutions are generally 
not permitted to accept, renew or roll over brokered deposits. 

Community Reinvestment Act.    The CRA is intended to encourage banks to help meet the credit needs of their 
entire communities, including low- and moderate-income neighborhoods, consistent with safe and sound operations. The 
regulators examine banks and assign each bank a public CRA rating. The CRA then requires bank regulators to take into 
account  the  bank’s  record  in  meeting  the  needs  of  its  community  when  considering  certain  applications  by  a  bank, 
including applications to establish a banking center or to conduct certain mergers or acquisitions. The Federal Reserve is 
required to consider the CRA records of a bank holding company’s controlled banks when considering an application by 
the bank holding company to acquire a bank or to merge with another bank holding company. 

When we apply for regulatory approval to make certain investments, the regulators will consider the CRA record 
of the target institution and our depository institution subsidiary. An unsatisfactory CRA record could substantially delay 
approval or result in denial of an application. 

Insider Credit Transactions.    Banks are subject to certain restrictions imposed by the Federal Reserve Act on 
extensions of credit to certain executive officers, directors, principal shareholders and any related interests of such persons 
(Regulation O). Extensions of credit to such persons must (a) be made on substantially the same terms, including interest 
rates and collateral, and follow credit underwriting procedures that are not less stringent than those prevailing at the time 
for comparable transactions with persons not covered by such restrictions, and (b) not involve more than the normal risk 
of repayment or present other unfavorable features. Banks are also subject to certain lending limits and restrictions on 
overdrafts to such persons.  A violation of these restrictions  may result  in the assessment of substantial civil  monetary 
penalties on the affected bank or any officer, director, employee, agent or other person participating in the conduct of the 
affairs of that bank, the imposition of a cease and desist order, and other regulatory sanctions. 

Safety and Soundness Standards.    Under the FDIC Improvement Act ("FDICIA"), each federal banking agency 
has  prescribed,  by  regulation,  non-capital  safety  and  soundness  standards  for  institutions  under  its  authority.  These 
standards cover internal controls, information and internal audit systems, loan documentation, credit underwriting, interest 
rate  exposure,  asset  growth,  compensation,  fees  and  benefits,  such  other  operational  and  managerial  standards  as  the 
agency determines to be appropriate, and standards for asset quality, earnings and stock valuation. An institution which 
fails to meet these standards must develop a plan acceptable to the agency, specifying the steps that the institution will 
take to meet the standards. Failure to submit or implement such a plan may subject the institution to regulatory sanctions. 

25 

Financial Privacy.    In accordance with the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act of 1999 (the "GLB Act"), federal banking 
regulators adopted rules that limit the ability of banks and other financial institutions to disclose nonpublic information 
about consumers to nonaffiliated third parties. These rules require disclosure of privacy policies to consumers and, in some 
circumstances, allow consumers to prevent disclosure of certain personal information to a nonaffiliated third party. The 
privacy provisions of the GLB Act affect how consumer information is transmitted through diversified financial companies 
and conveyed to outside vendors. 

Anti-Money Laundering.    Under federal law, including the Bank Secrecy Act and Title III of the Uniting and 
Strengthening America by Providing Appropriate Tools Required to Intercept and Obstruct Terrorism Act of 2001 (the 
"USA PATRIOT Act"), certain types of  financial institutions, including insured depository institutions,  must  maintain 
anti-money  laundering  programs  that  include  established  internal  policies,  procedures  and  controls;  a  designated 
compliance officer; an ongoing training program; and testing of the program by an independent audit function. Financial 
institutions  are  restricted  from  entering  into  specified  financial  transactions  and  account  relationships  and  must  meet 
enhanced standards for due diligence, client identification and recordkeeping, including in their dealings with non-U.S. 
financial institutions and non-U.S. clients. Financial institutions must take reasonable steps to conduct enhanced scrutiny 
of  account  relationships  to  guard  against  money  laundering  and  to  report  any  suspicious  information  maintained  by 
financial institutions. Bank regulators routinely examine institutions for compliance with these obligations and they must 
consider  an  institution’s  anti-money  laundering  compliance  when  considering  regulatory  applications  filed  by  the 
institution, including applications for banking mergers and acquisitions. The regulatory authorities have imposed "cease 
and desist" orders and civil money penalty sanctions against institutions found to be violating these obligations. 

Office of Foreign Assets Control Regulation.    The United States has imposed economic sanctions that affect 
transactions with designated foreign countries, foreign nationals and others. These are typically known as the  "OFAC" 
rules based on their administration by the U.S. Department of the Treasury Office of Foreign Assets Control ("OFAC"). 
The OFAC-administered sanctions targeting countries take many different forms. Generally, however, they contain one or 
more of the following elements: (i) restrictions on trade with or investment in a sanctioned country, including prohibitions 
against direct or indirect imports from and exports to a sanctioned country and prohibitions on "U.S. persons" engaging in 
financial  transactions  relating  to  making  investments  in,  or  providing  investment-related  advice  or  assistance  to,  a 
sanctioned  country;  and  (ii) a  blocking  of  assets  in  which  the  government  or  specially  designated  nationals  of  the 
sanctioned country have an interest, by prohibiting transfers of property subject to U.S. jurisdiction (including property in 
the possession or control of U.S. persons). Blocked assets (e.g., property and bank deposits) cannot be paid out, withdrawn, 
set  off  or  transferred  in  any  manner  without  a  license  from  OFAC.  The  Bank  is  responsible  for,  among  other  things, 
blocking  accounts  of,  and  transactions  with,  such  targets  and  countries,  prohibiting  unlicensed  trade  and  financial 
transactions with them and reporting blocked transactions after their occurrence. Failure to comply with these sanctions 
could have serious legal and reputational consequences 

Transactions with Affiliates 

Transactions between depository institutions and their affiliates, including transactions between the Bank and the 
Company, are governed by Sections 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act and the Federal Reserve’s Regulation W 
promulgated thereunder. Generally, Section 23A limits the extent to which a depository institution and its subsidiaries may 
engage in "covered transactions" with any one affiliate to an amount equal to 10% of the depository institution’s capital 
stock and surplus, and contains an aggregate limit on all such transactions with all affiliates of an amount equal to 20% of 
the depository institution’s capital stock and surplus. Section 23A also establishes specific collateral requirements for loans 
or  extensions  of  credit  to,  or  guarantees,  acceptances  or  letters  of  credit  issued  on  behalf  of,  an  affiliate.  Section 23B 
requires that covered transactions and a broad list of other specified transactions be on terms substantially the same, or at 
least as favorable to the depository institution and its subsidiaries, as those for similar transactions with non-affiliates. 

The Volcker Rule 

Section 619 of the Dodd-Frank Act, commonly known as the "Volcker Rule," generally prohibits certain banking 
entities from engaging in short-term proprietary trading of financial instruments and from owning, sponsoring or having 
certain relationships with hedge funds or private equity funds (collectively, "covered funds"). The Regulatory Relief Act, 
discussed  below,  includes  a  provision  exempting  banking  organizations  with  $10  billion  or  less  in  total  consolidation 
assets, and total trading assets and trading liabilities that are 5% or less of total consolidated assets, from the Volcker Rule. 
Thus, the Company and the Bank are not currently subject to the Volcker Rule. 

26 

Concentration in Commercial Real Estate Lending 

As a part of their regulatory oversight, the federal regulators have issued guidelines on sound risk management 
practices  with  respect  to  a  financial  institution’s  CRE  lending  activities.  The  guidelines  identify  certain  concentration 
levels that, if exceeded, will expose the institution to additional supervisory analysis surrounding the institution’s CRE 
concentration  risk.  The  guidelines  are  designed  to  promote  appropriate  levels  of  capital  and  sound  loan  and  risk 
management  practices  for  institutions  with  a  concentration  of  CRE  loans.  The  Company’s  CRE  concentrations  are 
discussed in the "Risk Factors" section below. 

Interstate Banking and Branching 

Under the Riegle-Neal Interstate Banking and Branching Efficiency Act of 1999 (the "Riegle-Neal Act"), a bank 
holding company may acquire banks in states other than its home state, subject to any state requirement that the bank has 
been organized and operating for a minimum period of time, not to exceed five years, and to certain deposit market-share 
limitations. Bank holding companies must be well capitalized and well managed, not merely adequately capitalized and 
adequately managed, in order to acquire a bank located outside of the bank holding company’s home state. The Riegle-
Neal Act also authorizes banks to merge across state lines, thereby creating interstate branches. 

Colorado state law provides that a Colorado-chartered bank can establish a branch anywhere in Colorado provided 
that the branch is approved in advance by the CDB. The branch must also be approved by the FDIC. The approval process 
takes  into  account  a  number  of  factors,  including  financial  history,  capital  adequacy,  earnings  prospects,  character  of 
management, needs of the community and consistency with corporate powers. The Dodd-Frank Act permits a national or 
state bank, with the approval of its regulator, to open a de novo branch in any state if the law of the state in which the 
branch is proposed would permit the establishment of the branch if the bank was charted in such state. 

The Federal Reserve, the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency and FDIC jointly issued a final rule in 1997 
that adopted uniform regulations implementing Section 109 of the Riegle-Neal Act. Section 109 which prohibits any bank 
from  establishing  or  acquiring  a  branch  or  branches  outside  of  its  home  state  primarily  for  the  purpose  of  deposit 
production. Congress enacted Section 109 to ensure that interstate branches would not take deposits from a community 
without the bank reasonably helping to meet the credit needs of that community. 

Limitations on Incentive Compensation 

In June 2016, several federal financial agencies (including the Federal Reserve and FDIC) re-proposed restrictions 
on incentive-based compensation pursuant to Section 956 of the Dodd-Frank Act for financial institutions with $1 billion 
or more in total consolidated assets. For institutions with at least $1 billion but less than $50 billion in total consolidated 
assets,  the  proposal  would  impose  principles-based  restrictions  that  are  broadly  consistent  with  existing  interagency 
guidance  on  incentive-based  compensation.  Such  institutions  would  be  prohibited  from  entering  into  incentive 
compensation  arrangements  that  encourage  inappropriate  risks  by  the  institution  (i) by  providing  an  executive  officer, 
employee, director, principal shareholder or individuals who are "significant risk takers" with excessive compensation, 
fees or benefits, or (ii) that could lead to material financial loss to the institution. The comment period for these proposed 
regulations has closed, but a final rule has not been published. Depending upon the outcome of the rule making process, 
the application of this rule to us could require us to revise our compensation strategy, increase our administrative costs and 
adversely affect our ability to recruit and retain qualified associates. 

Cybersecurity 

In March 2015, the Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council ("FFIEC") issued two related statements 
regarding  cybersecurity.  One  statement  indicates  that  financial  institutions  should  design  multiple  layers  of  security 
controls to establish lines of defense and to ensure that their risk management processes also address the risk posed by 
compromised  customer  credentials,  including  security  measures  to  reliably  authenticate  customers  accessing  internet-
based  services  of  the  financial  institution.  The  other  statement  indicates  that  a  financial  institution’s  management  is 
expected  to  maintain  sufficient  business  continuity  management  planning  processes  to  ensure  the  rapid  recovery, 
resumption and maintenance of the institution’s operations after a cyber-attack involving destructive malware. A financial 
institution is also expected to develop appropriate processes to enable recovery of data and business operations and address 

27 

 
rebuilding network capabilities and restoring data if the institution or its critical service providers fall victim to this type 
of cyber-attack. If we fail to observe the regulatory guidance, we could be subject to various regulatory sanctions, including 
financial penalties. 

In  November  2019,  the  FFIEC  also  released  updated  examination  procedures  regarding  overall  business 
continuity management ("BCM"). The new BCM release focuses on enterprise-wide approaches that address technology, 
business operations, testing, and communication strategies critical to the continuity of the business. The BCM procedures 
describe  principles  and  practices  for  information  technology  ("IT")  and  operations  designed  to  achieve  safety  and 
soundness, consumer financial protection, and compliance with applicable laws, regulations, and rules. 

The Company had a robust pandemic plan at the time of COVID-19, which covered similar disaster events and 
included detailed preparation, training and testing that had been conducted over multiple years prior to COVID-19. This 
preparation  includes  a  comprehensive,  annual  Business  Impact  Analysis.  As  such,  the  Company  was  poised  to  react 
successfully to the pandemic event. 

2018 Regulatory Reform 

The Regulatory Relief Act, which was designed to ease certain restrictions imposed by the Dodd-Frank Act, was 
enacted on May 24, 2018. Most of the provisions of the Regulatory Relief Act can be grouped into five general areas: 
mortgage  lending;  certain  regulatory  relief  for  "community"  banks;  enhanced  consumer  protections  in  specific  areas, 
including  subjecting  credit  reporting  agencies  to  additional  requirements;  certain  regulatory  relief  for  large  financial 
institutions,  including  increasing  the  threshold  at  which  institutions  are  classified  a  systemically  important  financial 
institutions (from $50 billion to $250 billion) and therefore subject to stricter oversight, and revising the rules for larger 
institution stress testing; and certain changes to Federal securities regulations designed to promote capital formation. Some 
of the key provisions of the Regulatory Relief Act as it relates to community banks and bank holding companies include, 
but are not limited to: (i) designating mortgages held in portfolio as  "qualified mortgages" for banks with less than $10 
billion in assets, subject to certain documentation and product limitations; (ii) exempting banks with less than $10 billion 
in assets (and total trading assets and trading liabilities of  5% or less of total assets)  from Volcker Rule requirements 
relating  to  proprietary  trading;  (iii)  simplifying  capital  calculations  for  banks  with  less  than  $10  billion  in  assets  by 
requiring  the  federal  banking  agencies  to  establish  a  community  bank  leverage  ratio  of  tangible  equity  to  average 
consolidated assets of not less than 8% or more than 10%, and provide that banks that maintain tangible equity in excess 
of such ratio will be deemed to be in compliance with risk-based capital and leverage requirements; (iv) assisting smaller 
banks  with  obtaining  stable  funding  by  providing  an  exception  for  reciprocal  deposits  from  FDIC  restrictions  on 
acceptance of brokered deposits; (v) raising the eligibility threshold for use of short-form Call Reports from $1 billion to 
$5 billion in assets; (vi) clarifying definitions pertaining to high volatility commercial real estate loans ("HVCRE"), which 
require higher capital allocations, so that only loans with increased risk are subject to higher risk weightings; (vii) directing 
the Federal Reserve to raise the asset threshold of the Policy Statement from $1 billion to $3 billion; and (viii) raising the 
consolidated asset threshold from $1 billion to $3 billion for eligible banks to undergo 18-month examination cycles rather 
than annual cycles. 

Changing Regulatory Structure and Future Legislation and Regulation 

Congress  may  enact  further  legislation  that  affects  the  regulation  of  the  financial  services  industry,  and  state 
legislatures may enact further legislation affecting the regulation of financial institutions chartered by or operating in these 
states. Federal and state regulatory agencies also periodically propose and adopt changes to their regulations or change the 
manner  in  which  existing  regulations  are  applied.  We  cannot  predict  the  substance  or  impact  of  pending  or  future 
legislation  or  regulations,  or  the  application  thereof,  although  enactment  of  the  proposed  legislation  could  impact  the 
regulatory structure under which the  Company operates and may significantly increase costs, impede the efficiency of 
internal business processes, require an increase in regulatory capital,  require  modifications to the Company’s business 
strategy, and limit the Company’s ability to pursue business opportunities in an efficient manner. A change in statutes, 
regulations or regulatory policies applicable to the Company or any of its subsidiaries could have a material effect on our 
business. 

28 

Monetary Policy and Economic Environment 

The policies of regulatory authorities, including the monetary policy of the Federal Reserve, can have a significant 
effect on the operating results of bank holding companies and their subsidiaries. Among the means available to the Federal 
Reserve to affect the money supply are open market operations in United States government securities, changes in the 
discount rate on member bank borrowings, and changes in reserve requirements against member bank deposits. These 
means  are  used  in  varying  combinations  to  influence  overall  growth  and  distribution  of  bank  loans,  investments  and 
deposits, and their use may affect interest rates charged on loans or paid on deposits. 

The Federal Reserve’s monetary policies have materially affected the operating results of commercial banks in 
the past and are expected to continue to do so in the future. The nature of future monetary policies and the effects of these 
policies on the Bank’s business and earnings cannot be predicted. 

29 

 
 
 
 
ITEM 1A. Risk Factors 

Our business and results of operations are subject to numerous risks and uncertainties, many of which are beyond our 
control.  The  material  risks  and  uncertainties  that  management  believes  affect  the  Company  are  described  below. 
Additional risks and uncertainties that management is not aware of, or that management currently deems immaterial, may 
also impair the Company’s business operations. This report is qualified in its entirety by these risk factors. If any of the 
following  risks  actually  occur,  our  business,  financial  condition  and  results  of  operations  could  be  materially  and 
adversely affected. If this were to happen, the value of our securities could decline significantly, and you could lose all or 
part of your investment. Some statements in the following risk factors constitute forward-looking statements. Please refer 
to "Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements" elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 10-K. 

Summary of Risk Factors 

The following is a summary of the principal risks that we believe could adversely affect our business, financial condition 
or results of operations: 

Risks Related to Our Business 

-  Geographic concentration in Colorado, Arizona, Wyoming and California. 

-  Negative changes in the economy affecting real estate values and liquidity could impair the value of collateral securing 

our real estate loans and result in loan and other losses. 

- 

If we are unable to continue to originate residential real estate loans and sell them into the secondary market for a 
profit, our earnings could decrease. 

-  Our commercial loan portfolio involves risks specific to commercial borrowers.  

-  We may be subject to claims and litigation pertaining to our fiduciary responsibilities. 

-  The loss of a key investment manager could adversely affect our business. 

-  The fair value of our investment securities can fluctuate due to factors outside of our control. 

-  The investment management contracts we have with our clients are terminable without cause and on relatively short 

notice by our clients. 

-  Changes to the level or type of investment activity by our clients may reduce our fee revenue.  

-  The trust  wealth  management fees  we  receive  may decrease as a result of poor investment performance, in either 

relative or absolute terms, which could decrease our revenues and net earnings. 

-  Changes in interest rates could reduce our net interest margins and net interest income. 

-  We may be adversely impacted by the transition from LIBOR as a reference rate and the uncertainty related to one or 

more alternative reference rates intended to replace LIBOR. 

-  Our allowance for loan losses may not be adequate to cover actual losses. 

-  We have pledged all of the stock of the Bank as collateral for a loan and if the lender forecloses, you could lose your 

investment. 

-  Liquidity risk could adversely affect our ability to fund operations and hurt our financial condition. 

-  Our largest trust client accounts for 39.0% of our total assets under management. 

30 

-  We face intense competition from other banks and financial institutions and other wealth and investment management 

firms that could hurt our business. 

-  Acquisition and divestitures may subject us to risks including integration risks and other unknown risks. 

-  Our goodwill or other intangible assets may become impaired. 

-  We are required to make significant estimates and assumptions in the preparation of our financial statements and our 

estimates and assumptions may not be accurate. 

- 

Fraud, breaches of our information security, and cybersecurity attacks could adversely affect us. 

-  We rely on communications, information, operating and financial control systems technology and related services 

from third-party service providers and we may suffer an interruption in those systems. 

-  We may incur significant losses due to ineffective risk management processes and strategies. 

-  We are exposed to the risk of environmental liabilities with respect to real properties that we may acquire. 

-  New lines of business or new products and services may subject us to additional risks. 

-  We rely on customer and counterparty information, which subjects us to risks if that information is not accurate or is 

incomplete. 

-  The COVID-19 pandemic  has adversely impacted our business and  financial results, and the ultimate impact  will 
depend on future developments, which are highly uncertain and cannot be predicted, including the scope and duration 
of the pandemic and actions taken by governmental authorities in response to the pandemic. 

Risks Related to Our Regulatory Environment 

-  The financial services industry is highly regulated our failure to comply with any current or future regulation may 

adversely affect us. 

-  The level of our commercial real estate loan portfolio may subject us to heightened regulatory scrutiny. 

Risks Related to Ownership of our Common Stock 

-  The trading volume in our common stock is less than other larger financial institutions. 

- 

Securities analysts may not initiate or continue coverage on us. 

-  Our management and board of directors have significant control over our business. 

-  We are dependent upon the Bank for cash flow, and the Bank’s ability to make cash distributions is restricted. 

General Risk Factors 

-  The market price of our common stock could decline significantly. 

-  The market price of our common stock may be subject to substantial fluctuations. 

The foregoing factors should not be construed as exhaustive. This summary of risk factors should be read in conjunction 
with the more detailed risk factors below. 

31 

Risks Related to Our Business 

Our banking, trust and wealth advisory operations are geographically concentrated in Colorado, Arizona, Wyoming 
and California, leading to significant exposure to those markets. 

Our  business  activities  and  credit  exposure,  including  real  estate  collateral  for  many  of  our  loans,  are  concentrated  in 
Colorado, Arizona, Wyoming and California. As of  December 31, 2020, 87.1% of the loans in our loan portfolio were 
made to borrowers who live in or conduct business in those states. This geographic concentration imposes risks from lack 
of geographic diversification. Difficult economic conditions, including state and local government deficits, in Colorado, 
Arizona, Wyoming and California may affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and future prospects, 
where adverse economic developments, among other things, could affect the volume of loan originations, increase the 
level of nonperforming assets, increase the rate of foreclosure losses on loans and reduce the value of our loans and loan 
servicing portfolio. Any regional or local economic downturn that affects Colorado, Arizona, Wyoming and California or 
existing or prospective borrowers or property values in such areas may affect us and our profitability more significantly 
and more adversely than our competitors whose operations are less geographically concentrated. This includes a sustained 
downturn  in  the  oil  and  gas  market,  which  is  important  for  the  general  economic  health  of  Colorado  in  particular.  A 
prolonged period of low oil prices could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition. 

Because a significant portion of our loan portfolio is comprised of real estate loans, negative changes in the economy 
affecting real estate values and liquidity could impair the value of collateral securing our real estate loans and result 
in loan and other losses. 

As  of  December 31, 2020,  approximately  $1.03 billion,  or  66.9%,  of  our  gross  loans  were  loans  with  real  estate  as  a 
primary  or  secondary  component  of  collateral.  The  repayment  of  such  loans  is  highly  dependent  on  the  ability  of  the 
borrowers to meet their loan repayment obligations to us, which can be adversely affected by economic downturns that 
can  lead  to  (i) declines  in  the  rents  and,  therefore,  in  the  cash  flows  generated  by  those  real  properties  on  which  the 
borrowers depend to fund their loan payments to us, (ii) decreases in the values of those real properties, which make it 
more difficult for the borrowers to sell those real properties for amounts sufficient to repay their loans in full, and (iii) job 
losses of residential home buyers, which makes it more difficult for these  borrowers to fund their loan payments. As a 
result, our operating results are more vulnerable to adverse changes in the real estate market than other financial institutions 
with  more  diversified  loan  portfolios,  and  we  could  incur  losses  in  the  event  of  changes  in  economic  conditions  that 
disproportionately affect the real estate markets. 

Real estate values in many of our markets have generally experienced periods of fluctuation over the last five years. The 
market value of real estate can fluctuate significantly in a short period of time. As a result, adverse developments affecting 
real estate values and the liquidity of real estate in our primary markets could increase the credit risk associated with our 
loan portfolio, and could result in losses that adversely affect credit quality, financial condition and results of operations. 
Negative changes in the economy affecting real estate values and liquidity in our market areas could significantly impair 
the value of property pledged as collateral on loans and affect our ability to sell the collateral upon foreclosure without a 
loss or additional losses or our ability to sell these loans on the secondary securitization market. Such declines and losses 
would have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. If real estate values 
decline, it is also more likely that we would be required to increase our allowance for loan losses, which would adversely 
affect our business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition, adverse weather events, including wildfires, 
flooding, and mudslides, can cause damages to the property pledged as collateral on loans, which could result in additional 
losses upon a foreclosure. 

If we are unable to continue to originate residential real estate loans and sell them into the secondary market for a 
profit, our earnings could decrease. 

We derive a portion of our non-interest income from the origination of residential real estate loans and the subsequent sale 
of such loans into the secondary market. If we are unable to continue to originate and sell residential real estate loans at 
historical or greater levels, our residential real estate loan volume would decrease, which could decrease our earnings. A 
rising interest rate environment, general economic conditions, market volatility, or other factors beyond our control could 
adversely affect our ability to originate  residential real estate loans. The financial  services industry is experiencing an 
increase  in  regulations  and  compliance  requirements  related  to  mortgage  loan  originations  necessitating  technology 
upgrades and other changes. If new regulations continue to increase and we are unable to make technology upgrades, our 

32 

ability to originate mortgage loans will be reduced or eliminated. Additionally, we sell a large portion of our residential 
real estate loans to third-party investors, and rising interest rates could negatively affect our ability to generate suitable 
profits on the sale of such loans. If interest rates increase after we originate the loans, our ability to market those loans is 
impaired  as  the  profitability  on  the  loans  decreases.  These  fluctuations  can  have  an  adverse  effect  on  the  revenue  we 
generate from residential real estate loans and in certain instances, could result in a loss on the sale of the loans. 

Further, for the mortgage loans we sell in the secondary market, the mortgage loan sales contracts contain indemnification 
clauses should the loans default, generally within the first 90 – 120 days, or if documentation is determined not to be in 
compliance with regulations. While the Company has had no historic losses as a result of these indemnities, we could be 
required  to  repurchase  the  mortgage  loans  or  reimburse  the  purchaser  of  our  loans  for  losses  incurred.  Both  of  these 
situations could have an adverse effect on the profitability of our mortgage lending activities and negatively impact our 
net income. 

Our  loan  portfolio  includes  a  significant  number  of  commercial  loans,  which  involve  risks  specific  to  commercial 
borrowers. 

Our loan portfolio includes a significant amount of commercial real estate loans and commercial lines of credit. Our typical 
commercial  borrower  is  a  small  or  medium-sized  privately  owned  Colorado  business  entity.  Our  commercial  loans 
typically have greater credit risks than standard residential mortgage or consumer loans because commercial loans often 
have larger balances, and repayment usually depends on the borrowers’ successful business operations. Commercial loans 
also involve some additional risk because they generally are not fully repaid over the loan period and thus may require 
refinancing or a large payoff at maturity. If the general economy turns substantially downward, commercial borrowers 
may not be able to repay their loans, and the value of their assets, which are usually pledged as collateral, may decrease 
rapidly and significantly. Also, when credit markets tighten due to adverse developments in specific markets or the general 
economy, opportunities for refinancing may become more expensive or unavailable, resulting in loan defaults. 

We may be subject to claims and litigation pertaining to our fiduciary responsibilities. 

Some of the services we provide, such as trust and investment services, require us to act as fiduciaries for our clients and 
others. From time to time, third parties make claims and take legal action against us pertaining to the performance of our 
fiduciary responsibilities. If these claims and legal actions are not resolved in a manner favorable to us, we may be exposed 
to significant financial liability or our reputation could be damaged. Either of these results may adversely impact demand 
for our products and services or otherwise have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of 
operations. 

The  market  for  investment  managers  and  professionals  is  extremely  competitive  and  the  loss  of  a  key  investment 
manager could adversely affect our investment advisory and wealth management business. 

We believe that investment performance is one of the most important factors that affect the amount of assets under our 
management and, for that reason, the success of our business is heavily dependent on the quality and experience of our 
senior wealth management professionals and their track records in terms of making investment decisions that result in 
attractive investment returns for our clients. We consider the "chairman" and "president" roles in each of our profit center 
teams to be instrumental to executing our business strategy. However, the  market for such investment professionals is 
extremely competitive and is increasingly characterized by frequent movement of these individuals among different firms. 
In addition, our individual investment professionals often have direct contact with particular clients, which can lead to a 
strong client relationship based on the client’s trust in that individual manager. As a result, the loss of a key investment 
manager could jeopardize our relationships with some of our clients and lead to the loss of client accounts, which could 
have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects. 

The fair value of our investment securities can fluctuate due to factors outside of our control. 

As  of  December 31, 2020,  the  fair  value  of  our  investment  securities  portfolio  was  $36.7  million.  Factors  beyond  our 
control can significantly influence and cause adverse changes to occur in the fair values of securities in that portfolio. 
These factors include, but are not limited to, rating agency actions in respect of the investment securities in our portfolio, 
defaults by the issuers of such securities, concerns with respect to the enforceability of the payment or other key terms of 
such securities, changes in market interest rates and continued instability in the capital markets. Any of these factors, as 

33 

well  as  others,  could  cause  other-than-temporary  impairments  and  realized  or  unrealized  losses  in  future  periods  and 
declines in other comprehensive income, which could materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations, 
financial condition and prospects. In addition, the process for determining whether an impairment of a security is other-
than-temporary  usually requires complex, subjective judgments,  which could subsequently prove  to  have been  wrong, 
regarding  the  future  financial  performance  and  liquidity  of  the  issuer  of  the  security,  the  fair  value  of  any  collateral 
underlying the security and whether and the extent to which the principal of and interest on the security will ultimately be 
paid in accordance with its payment terms. 

We may be adversely affected by the soundness of certain securities brokerage firms. 

We do not provide custodial services for our clients. Instead, client investment accounts are maintained under custodial 
arrangements with large, well established securities brokerage firms or bank institutions that provide custodial services 
(collectively, "brokerage firms"), either directly or through arrangements made by us with those firms. As a result, the 
performance of, or even rumors or questions about the integrity or performance of, any of those brokerage firms could 
adversely affect the confidence of our clients in the services provided by those firms or otherwise adversely impact their 
custodial holdings. Such an occurrence could negatively impact our ability to retain existing or attract new clients and, as 
a result, could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects. 

The investment management contracts we have with our clients are terminable without cause and on relatively short 
notice by our clients, which makes us vulnerable to short-term declines in the performance of the securities under our 
management. 

Like most investment advisory and wealth management businesses, the investment advisory contracts we have with our 
clients are typically terminable by the client without cause upon less than 30 days’ notice. As a result, even short-term 
declines in the performance of the securities we manage, which can result from factors outside our control, such as adverse 
changes in market or economic condition or the poor performance of some of the investments we have recommended to 
our clients, could lead some of our clients to move assets under our management to other asset classes such as broad index 
funds or treasury securities, or to investment advisors which have investment product offerings or investment strategies 
different than ours. Therefore, our operating results are heavily dependent on the financial performance of our investment 
portfolios and the investment strategies we employ in our investment advisory businesses and even short-term declines in 
the performance of the investment portfolios we manage for our clients, whatever the cause, could result in a decline in 
assets under management and a corresponding decline in investment management fees, which would adversely affect our 
results of operations. 

Fee revenue represents a significant portion of our consolidated revenue and is subject to decline, among other things, 
in the event of a reduction in, or changes to, the level or type of investment activity by our clients. 

A significant portion of our revenue results from fee-based services related to wealth advisory, private banking, personal 
trust,  investment  management,  mortgage  lending  and  institutional  asset  management  services  to  derive  revenue.  This 
contrasts with many commercial banks that may rely more heavily on interest-based sources of revenue, such as loans. For 
the year ended December 31, 2020, adjusted non-interest income represented approximately 52.6% of our consolidated 
gross revenue. The level of these fees is influenced by several factors, including the mix and volume of our assets under 
custody and administration and our assets under management, the value and type of securities positions held (with respect 
to assets under custody) and the volume of portfolio transactions, and the types of products and services used by our clients. 

In addition, our clients include institutional investors, such as mutual funds, collective investment funds, hedge funds and 
other  investment  pools,  corporate  and  public  retirement  plans,  insurance  companies,  foundations,  endowments  and 
investment  managers.  Economic,  market  or  other  factors  that  reduce  the  level  or  rates  of  savings  in  or  with  those 
institutions,  either  through  reductions  in  financial  asset  valuations  or  through  changes  in  investor  preferences,  could 
materially reduce our fee revenue or have a material adverse effect on our consolidated results of operations. These clients 
also, by their nature, are often able to exert considerable market influence, and this, combined with strong competitive 
forces in the markets for our services, has resulted in, and may continue to result in, significant pressure to reduce the fees 
we charge for our services in both our asset servicing and asset management business lines. 

34 

The trust wealth management fees we receive may decrease as a result of poor investment performance, in either relative 
or absolute terms, which could decrease our revenues and net earnings. 

We  derive  a  significant  amount  of  our  revenues  primarily  from  investment  management  fees  based  on  assets  under 
management. Our ability to maintain or  increase assets under management is subject to a number of factors, including 
investors’  perception  of  our  past  performance,  in  either  relative  or  absolute  terms,  market  and  economic  conditions, 
including changes in oil and gas prices, and competition from investment management companies. Financial markets are 
affected by many factors, all of which are beyond our control, including general economic conditions, including changes 
in oil and gas prices; securities market conditions; the level and volatility of interest rates and equity prices; competitive 
conditions;  liquidity  of  global  markets;  international  and  regional  political  conditions;  regulatory  and  legislative 
developments; monetary and fiscal policy; investor sentiment; availability and cost of capital; technological changes and 
events; outcome of legal proceedings; changes in currency values; inflation; credit ratings; and the size, volume and timing 
of  transactions.  A  decline  in  the  fair  value  of  the  assets  under  management,  caused  by  a  decline  in  general  economic 
conditions, would decrease our wealth management fee income. 

Investment performance is one of the most important factors in retaining existing clients and competing for new wealth 
management  clients.  Poor  investment  performance  could  reduce  our  revenues  and  impair  our  growth  in  the  following 
ways: 

  Existing clients may withdraw funds from our wealth management business in favor of better performing products;  

  Asset-based management fees could decline from a decrease in assets under management;  

  Our ability to attract funds from existing and new clients might diminish; and  

  Our portfolio managers may depart, to join a competitor or otherwise. 

Even  when  market  conditions  are  generally  favorable,  our  investment  performance  may  be  adversely  affected  by  the 
investment style of our asset managers and the particular investments that they make. To the extent our future investment 
performance  is  perceived  to  be  poor  in  either  relative  or  absolute  terms,  the  revenues  and  profitability  of  our  wealth 
management  business  will  likely  be  reduced  and  our  ability  to  attract  new  clients  will  likely  be  impaired.  As  such, 
fluctuations in the equity and debt markets can have a direct impact upon our net earnings. 

Changes in interest rates could reduce our net interest margins and net interest income. 

Interest rates are key drivers of our net interest margin and subject to many factors beyond our control. Income and cash 
flows from our banking operations depend to a great extent on the difference or "spread" between the interest we earn on 
interest-earning assets, such as loans and investment securities, and the rates at which we pay interest on interest-bearing 
liabilities, such as deposits and borrowings. As interest rates change, net interest income is affected. Rapidly increasing 
interest rates in the future could result in interest expense increasing faster than interest income because of a divergence 
in financial instrument  maturities or competitive  pressures. Further, substantially  higher interest rates generally reduce 
loan demand and may result in slower loan growth. Decreases or increases in interest rates could have a negative effect on 
the spreads between the interest rates earned on assets and the rates of interest paid on liabilities, and therefore decrease 
net  interest  income.  Also,  changes  in  interest  rates  might  also  impact  the  values  of  equity  and  debt  securities  under 
management and administration, which may have a negative impact on fee income. 

Interest  rates  are  highly  sensitive  to  many  factors  that  are  beyond  our  control,  including  (among  others)  general  and 
regional  and  local  economic  conditions,  the  monetary  policies  of  the  Federal  Reserve,  bank  regulatory  requirements, 
competition from other banks and financial institutions and a change over time in the mix of our loans and investment 
securities, on the one hand, and on our deposits and other liabilities, on the other hand. Changes in monetary policy will, 
in particular, influence the origination and market value of and the yields we can realize on loans and investment securities, 
and the interest we pay on deposits. Additionally, sustained low levels of market interest rates, as we have experienced 
during  the  past  decade,  could  continue  to  place  downward  pressure  on  our  net  interest  margins  and,  therefore,  on  our 
earnings. 

35 

Our net interest margins and earnings also could be adversely affected if we are unable to adjust our interest rates on loans 
and deposits on a timely basis in response to changes in economic conditions or monetary policies. For example, if the 
rates of interest we pay on deposits, borrowings and other interest-bearing liabilities increase faster than we are able to 
increase the rates of interest we charge on loans or the yields we realize on investments and other interest-earning assets, 
our net interest income and, therefore, our earnings will decrease. In particular, the rates of interest we charge on loans 
may  be  subject  to  longer  fixed  interest  periods  compared  to  the  interest  we  must  pay  on  deposits.  On  the  other  hand, 
increasing interest rates generally lead to increases in net interest income; however, such increases also may result in a 
reduction in loan originations, declines in loan prepayment rates and reductions in the ability of borrowers to repay their 
current loan obligations, which could result in increased loan defaults and charge-offs and could require increases to our 
allowance for loan losses, thereby offsetting either partially or totally the increases in net interest income resulting from 
the increase in interest rates. Additionally, we could be prevented from increasing the interest rates we charge on loans or 
from reducing the interest rates we offer on deposits due to "price" competition from other banks and financial institutions 
with which we compete. Conversely, in a declining interest rate environment, our earnings could be adversely affected if 
the interest rates we are able to charge on loans or other investments decline more quickly than those we pay on deposits 
and borrowings. 

We may be adversely impacted by the transition from LIBOR as a reference rate and the uncertainty related to one or 
more alternative reference rates intended to replace LIBOR. 

In 2017, the United Kingdom’s Financial Conduct Authority announced that after 2021 it would no longer compel banks 
to submit the rates required to calculate the London Interbank Offered Rate ("LIBOR"). This announcement indicates that 
the continuation of LIBOR on the current basis cannot and will not be guaranteed after 2021. It remains unclear what rate 
or rates may develop as accepted alternatives to LIBOR, or what the effect of such changes will be on the markets for 
LIBOR-based  financial  instruments.  The  Secured  Overnight  Financing  Rate  ("SOFR")  has  been  recommended  by  the 
Alternative Reference Rates Committee (a group of private-market participants convened by the Federal Reserve Board 
and the Federal Reserve Bank of New York) as an alternative for USD LIBOR, but uncertainty as to the adoption, market 
acceptance or availability of SOFR or other alternative reference rates may adversely affect the value of LIBOR or SOFR-
based assets and liabilities held or issued by the Company. 

The language in our contracts and financial instruments that define and use LIBOR have developed over time and have 
various events that trigger when a successor rate to the designated rate would be selected. If a trigger is satisfied, contracts 
and  financial  instruments  often  give  the  calculation  agent  (which  may  be  us)  discretion  over  the  successor  rate  or 
benchmark  to  be  selected.  As  a  result,  there  is  considerable  uncertainty  as  to  how  the  financial  services  industry  will 
address the discontinuance of designated rates in contracts and financial instruments or such designated rates ceasing to 
be  acceptable reference  rates.  This  uncertainty  could  ultimately  result  in  client  disputes  and  litigation  surrounding  the 
proper interpretation of our LIBOR-based contracts and financial instruments. 

We have a significant number of loans and borrowings with attributes that are either directly or indirectly dependent on 
LIBOR. The transition from LIBOR could create considerable costs and additional risk. Since proposed alternative rates 
are calculated differently, payments under contracts referencing new rates will differ from those referencing LIBOR. The 
transition will change our market risk profiles, requiring changes to risk and pricing models, valuation tools, product design 
and hedging strategies. Furthermore, failure to adequately manage this transition process with our clients could adversely 
impact our reputation. Although we are currently unable to assess what the ultimate impact of the transition from LIBOR 
will be, failure to adequately manage the transition could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition 
and results of operations. 

The  Alternative  Reference  Rates  Committee  (a  group  of  private-market  participants  convened  by  the  Federal  Reserve 
Board and the Federal Reserve Bank of New York) has identified the Secured Overnight Financing Rate, or SOFR, as the 
recommend alternative to  LIBOR. Uncertainty as to the adoption, market acceptance or availability of SOFR or other 
alternative reference rates may adversely affect the value of LIBOR or SOFR-based assets and liabilities held or issued by 
the Company. 

Our allowance for loan losses may not be adequate to cover actual losses. 

In accordance with regulatory requirements and GAAP, we maintain an allowance for loan losses to provide for incurred 
loan and lease losses and a reserve for unfunded loan commitments. Our allowance for loan losses may not be adequate to 

36 

absorb actual loan losses, and future provisions for loan losses could materially and adversely affect our operating results. 
Our allowance  for loan losses is based on prior experience and an evaluation of the risks inherent in our then-current 
portfolio. The amount of future losses may also vary depending on changes in economic, operating and other conditions, 
including changes in interest rates that may be beyond our control, and these losses may exceed current estimates. Federal 
and state regulators, as an integral part of their examination process, review our loans and leases and allowance for loan 
losses. While we believe our allowance for loan losses is appropriate for the risk identified in our loan and lease portfolio, 
we may need to increase the allowance for loan losses, such increases may not be sufficient to address losses, and regulators 
may require us to increase this allowance even further. Any of these occurrences could have a material adverse effect on 
our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects. 

Our business and operations may be adversely affected in numerous and complex ways by external business disruptors 
in the financial services industry. 

The financial services industry is undergoing rapid change, as technology enables non-traditional new entrants to compete 
in certain segments of the banking market, in some cases with reduced regulation. New entrants may use new technologies, 
advanced data and analytic tools, lower cost to serve, reduced regulatory burden or faster processes to challenge traditional 
banks.  For  example,  new  business  models  have  been  observed  in  retail  payments,  consumer  and  commercial  lending, 
foreign exchange and low-cost investment advisory services. While we closely monitor business disruptors and seek to 
adapt to changing technologies, matching the pace of innovation exhibited by new and differently situated competitors 
may require us and policy-makers to adapt at a greater pace. 

We have pledged all of the stock of the Bank as collateral for a loan and if the lender forecloses, you could lose your 
investment. 

We  have  pledged  all  of  the  stock  of  the  Bank  as  collateral  for  a  third-party  loan.  The  loan  had  no  balance  as  of 
December 31, 2020. If we were to incur indebtedness under this loan and default, the lender of such loan could foreclose 
on the Bank’s stock and we would lose our principal asset. In that event, if the value of the Bank’s stock is less than the 
amount of the indebtedness, you could lose the entire amount of your investment. 

 Liquidity risk could adversely affect our ability to fund operations and hurt our financial condition. 

Liquidity is essential to our banking business, as we use cash to make loans and purchase investment securities and other 
interest-earning assets and to fund deposit withdrawals that occur in the ordinary course of our business. Our principal 
sources of liquidity include earnings, deposits, repayment by clients of loans we have made to them, and the proceeds from 
sales by us of our equity securities or from borrowings that we may obtain. Potential alternative sources of liquidity include 
the sale of loans, the acquisition of national market non-core deposits, the issuance of additional collateralized borrowings 
such as FHLB advances, access to the Federal Reserve discount window and the issuance of additional equity securities. 
If our ability to obtain funds from these sources becomes limited or the costs of those funds increase, whether due to factors 
that affect us specifically, including our financial performance, or due to factors that affect the financial services industry 
in  general,  including  weakening  economic  conditions  or  negative  views  and  expectations  about  the  prospects  for  the 
financial services industry as a whole, then our ability to grow our banking and investment advisory and trust businesses 
would be harmed, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations 
and prospects. 

We may not be able to maintain a strong core deposit base or other low-cost funding sources. 

We depend on checking and savings deposit account balances and other forms of client deposits as our primary source of 
funding for our lending activities. Our future  growth will largely depend on our ability to maintain and grow a strong 
deposit base and our ability to retain our largest trust clients, many of whom are also depositors. We may not be able to 
grow  and  maintain  our  deposit  base. The  account  and  deposit  balances  can  decrease  when  clients  perceive  alternative 
investments, such as the stock market or real estate, as providing a better risk/return tradeoff. If clients, including our trust 
clients, move money out of bank deposits and into investments (or similar deposit products at other institutions that may 
provide  a  higher rate  of return),  we  could lose  a relatively low cost source of funds, increasing our funding costs and 
reducing our net interest income and net income. We also have increased risks from losses of bank deposit clients due to 
the  large  deposits  we hold from certain clients. For example, as of  December 31, 2020, 15.2% and  41.8% of our total 
deposits consisted of our 10 largest depositors and allocations to interest-bearing accounts for certain other trust clients 

37 

deposits we manage, respectively. Loss of any one of these deposit clients would have an outsized impact on our results 
of  operations.  Additionally,  any  such  loss  of  funds  could  result  in  lower  loan  originations,  which  could  materially 
negatively impact our growth strategy. 

We receive substantial deposits and assets under management as a result of referrals by professionals, such as attorneys, 
accountants, and doctors, and such referrals are dependent upon the continued positive interaction with and financial 
health of those referral sources. 

Many of our deposit clients and clients of our private trust bank offices are individuals involved in professional vocations, 
such as lawyers, accountants, and doctors. These clients are a significant source of referrals for new clients in both the 
deposit and wealth management areas. If we fail to adequately serve these professional clients with our deposit services, 
lending, and wealth management products, this source of referrals may diminish, which could have a negative impact on 
our results. Further, if the economy in the geographic areas that we serve is negatively impacted, the amount of deposits 
and services that these professional individuals will utilize and the amount of referrals that they will make may decrease, 
which may have a material and adverse impact on our business, financial condition or results of operations. 

Our largest trust client accounts for 39.0% of our total assets under management. 

As  of  December 31, 2020,  our  largest  trust  client  accounted  for,  in  the  aggregate,  39.0%  of  our  total  assets  under 
management and 1.4% of our non-interest income. As a result, a material decrease in the volume of those trust assets by 
that client could materially reduce our assets under management, which would adversely affect our non-interest income 
and, therefore, our results of operations. 

The success of our business depends on achieving our strategic objectives, including through acquisitions which may 
not increase our profitability and may adversely affect our future operating results. 

Since we commenced our banking business in 2004, we have grown our banking franchise and now have fifteen locations 
in Colorado, Arizona, Wyoming and California, including a centralized operations center in downtown Denver. We plan 
to continue to grow our banking business both organically and through acquisitions of other banks and financial service 
providers, which may include entry into new markets. However, the implementation of our growth strategy poses a number 
of risks for us, including that: 

  Any newly established offices may not generate revenues in amounts sufficient to cover the start-up costs of those 

offices, which would reduce our earnings;  

  Acquisitions we might consummate in the future may prove not to be accretive to or may reduce our earnings if we do 
not realize anticipated cost savings, or if we incur unanticipated costs in integrating the acquired businesses into our 
operations  or  if  a  substantial  number  of  the  clients  of  any  of  the  acquired  businesses  move  their  business  to  our 
competitors;  

  Such  expansion  efforts  will  divert  management  time  and  effort  from  our  existing  banking  operations,  which  could 

adversely affect our future financial performance; and  

  Additional  capital  which  we  may  need  to  support  our  growth  or  the  issuance  of  shares  in  any  acquisitions  will  be 
dilutive of the investments that our existing shareholders have in the shares of our common stock that they own and in 
their respective percentage ownership interests they have in the Company. 

We face intense competition from other banks and financial institutions and other wealth and investment management 
firms that could hurt our business. 

We conduct our business operations in markets where the banking business is highly competitive and is dominated by 
large multi-state and in-state banks with operations and offices covering wide geographic areas. We also compete with 
other financial service businesses, including investment advisory and wealth management firms, mutual fund companies, 
financial technology companies, and  securities brokerage and investment banking firms that offer competitive banking 
and financial products and services as well as products and services that we do not offer. Larger banks and many of those 
other financial service organizations have greater financial and marketing resources than we do that enable them to conduct 
38 

extensive advertising campaigns and to shift resources to regions or activities of greater potential profitability. They also 
have substantially more capital and higher lending limits than we do, which enable them to attract larger clients and offer 
financial products and services that we are unable to offer, putting us at a disadvantage in competing with them for loans 
and deposits and investment management clients. If  we are unable to  compete  effectively  with those banking or other 
financial services businesses, we could find it more difficult to attract new and retain existing clients and our net interest 
margins, net interest income and investment management fees could decline, which would materially adversely affect our 
business, results of operations and prospects, and could cause us to incur losses in the future. 

In addition, our ability to successfully attract and retain investment advisory and wealth management clients is dependent 
on our ability to compete  with competitors’ investment products, level of investment performance, client  services and 
marketing  and  distribution  capabilities.  If  we  are  not  successful  in  retaining  existing  and  attracting  new  investment 
management clients, our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects may be materially and adversely 
affected. 

We may not be successful in implementing our internal growth strategy or be able to manage the risks associated with 
our anticipated growth through opening new boutique private trust bank offices, which could have a material adverse 
effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. 

Our business strategy includes pursuing organic and internal growth and evaluating strategic opportunities to grow through 
opening new boutique private trust bank offices. We believe that banking location expansion has been meaningful to our 
growth since inception. We intend to pursue an organic growth strategy in addition to our acquisition strategy, the success 
of which is dependent on our ability to generate an increasing level of loans, deposits and assets under management at 
acceptable risk levels without incurring corresponding increases in non-interest expense. Opening new offices carries with 
it certain potential risks, including significant startup costs and anticipated initial operating losses; an inability to gain 
regulatory approval; an inability to secure  the  services of qualified senior  management to operate  the new offices and 
successfully integrate and promote our corporate culture; poor market reception for our new offices established in markets 
where we do not have a preexisting reputation; challenges posed by local economic conditions; challenges associated with 
securing attractive locations at a reasonable cost; and the additional strain on management resources and internal systems 
and controls. Further, we may not be successful in our organic growth strategies generally due to, among other factors, 
delays  in  introducing  and  implementing  new  products  and  services  and  other  impediments  resulting  from  regulatory 
oversight, lack of qualified personnel at existing locations. In addition, the success of our internal growth strategy will 
depend on maintaining sufficient regulatory capital levels and on favorable economic conditions in our primary market 
areas. Failure to adequately manage the risks associated with our anticipated growth, including growth through creating 
new boutique private trust bank offices, could have a material adverse effect on our business and results of operations. 

Although we plan to grow our business internally, we may expand our business by acquiring other banks and financial 
services companies, and we may not be successful in doing so. 

While a key element of our business plan is to grow our banking franchise and increase our market share through internal 
and organic growth, we intend to take advantage of opportunities to acquire other banks, investment advisors, and other 
financial  services  companies  as  such  opportunities  present  themselves.  However,  we  may  not  succeed  in  seizing  such 
opportunities when they arise. Our ability to execute on acquisition opportunities may require us to raise additional capital 
and to increase our capital position to support the growth of our franchise. It will also depend on market conditions; over 
which we have no control. Moreover, any acquisitions may require the approval of our bank regulators and we may not be 
able to obtain such approvals on acceptable terms, if at all. 

Acquisition and divestitures may subject us to integration risks and other unknown risks. 

Although  we  plan  to  continue  to  grow  our  business  organically  and  through  opening  new  boutique  private  trust  bank 
offices, we also intend to pursue acquisition opportunities that we believe complement our activities and have the ability 
to enhance our profitability and provide attractive risk-adjusted returns. We also intend to explore the divestiture of assets 
and businesses that do not fit within our strategic plan. Our acquisition activities could be material to our business and 
involve a number of risks, including the failure to: adequately centralize and standardize policies, procedures, products, 
and processes; combine employee benefit plans and compensation cultures; implement a unified investment policy and 
make  related  adjustments  to  combined  investment  portfolios;  implement  a  unified  loan  policy  and  conform  lending 
authority; implement a standard loan management system; avoid delays in implementing new policies or procedures; and 

39 

apply new policies or procedures. In addition, divestitures pose unique risks including the failure to: close the divestiture, 
manage expenses associated with the divestiture, retain employees and effectively manage a business or assets subject to 
divestiture.  

Certain events may arise before the date of an acquisition or divestiture but after the announcement of an acquisition or 
divestiture,  or  we  may  learn  of  certain  facts,  events  or  circumstances,  that  may  affect  our  financial  condition  or 
performance or subject us to risk of loss. Certain events may arise after the date of an acquisition or divestiture, or we may 
learn of certain facts, events or circumstances after the closing of an acquisition or divestiture, that may affect our financial 
condition or performance or subject us to risk of loss. It is possible that we could undertake an acquisition that subsequently 
does not perform in line with our financial or strategic objectives or expectations. These events include, but are not limited 
to: retaining key associates and clients, achieving anticipated synergies, meeting expectations and otherwise realizing the 
undertaking’s anticipated benefits; litigation resulting from circumstances occurring at the acquired entity prior to the date 
of acquisition; loan downgrades and loan loss provisions resulting from underwriting of certain acquired loans determined 
not to meet our credit standards; personnel changes that cause instability within a department; and other events relating to 
the performance of our business. In addition, if we determined that the value of an acquired business had decreased and 
that the related goodwill was impaired, an impairment of goodwill charge to earnings would be recognized. 

Acquisitions involve inherent uncertainty and we cannot determine all potential events, facts and circumstances that could 
result in loss or increased costs. Our due diligence or mitigation efforts may not be sufficient to protect against any such 
loss or increased costs. 

We may be required to recognize a significant charge to earnings if our goodwill or other intangible assets become 
impaired, which could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. 

Goodwill and purchased intangible assets with indefinite lives are not amortized but are reviewed for impairment annually 
and  more  frequently  when events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying  value of an asset  may  not be 
recoverable. Our annual goodwill impairment assessment date for the Company’s reporting units is October 31. Goodwill 
impairment testing includes an assessment of qualitative factors to determine whether certain circumstances or events exist 
that lead to a determination that the  fair value of goodwill is less than  the carrying  value. This qualitative assessment 
includes various factors that could affect the reporting unit’s fair value as well as mitigating events or conditions. One 
such factor that could impact the assessment are the conditions within the markets that trade the Company’s stock. The 
assessment of each reporting unit compares the aggregate  fair value to its carrying value, along with several valuation 
assumptions  and  methods  in  order  to  determine  if  any  impairment  was  triggered  as  of  the  measurement  date. 
Notwithstanding  the  foregoing,  the  results  of  impairment  testing  on  our  intangible  assets  will  have  no  impact  on  our 
tangible book value or regulatory capital levels. There is no guarantee that we may not be forced to recognize impairment 
charges in the future as operating and economic conditions change or as part of strategic divestitures. The recognition of 
a significant charge to earnings in our consolidated financial statements resulting from any impairment of our goodwill or 
other intangible assets could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. 

 We are required to make significant estimates and assumptions in the preparation of our financial statements and our 
estimates and assumptions may not be accurate. 

The  preparation of our consolidated financial statements in conformity  with GAAP requires our  management to  make 
significant estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosures of contingent 
assets and liabilities at the date of the consolidated financial statements, and the reported amounts of income and expense 
during the reporting periods. Critical estimates are made by management in determining, among other things, the allowance 
for loan losses, amounts of impairment of assets, intangibles, and valuation of income taxes. If our underlying estimates 
and  assumptions  prove  to  be  incorrect,  our  financial  condition  and  results  of  operations  may  be  materially  adversely 
affected. 

40 

The occurrence of fraudulent activity, breaches of our information security, and cybersecurity attacks could adversely 
affect our ability to conduct our business, manage our exposure to risk or expand our businesses, result in the disclosure 
or misuse of confidential or proprietary information, increase our costs to maintain and update our operational and 
security systems and infrastructure, and adversely impact our results of operations, liquidity and financial condition, 
as well as cause legal or reputational harm. 

As a financial institution, we are susceptible to fraudulent activity, information security breaches and cybersecurity-related 
incidents that  may be committed against us, our clients, or third parties  with  whom  we interact and that  may result in 
financial losses or increased costs to us or our clients, disclosure or misuse of confidential information belonging to us or 
personal  or  confidential  information  belonging  to  our  clients,  misappropriation  of  assets,  litigation,  or  damage  to  our 
reputation. Our industry has seen increases in electronic fraudulent activity, hacking, security breaches, sophisticated social 
engineering and cyber-attacks within the financial services industry, including in the commercial banking sector, as cyber-
criminals have been targeting commercial bank and brokerage accounts on an increasing basis. 

Our  business  is  highly  dependent  on  the  security  and  efficacy  of  our  infrastructure,  computer  and  data  management 
systems, as well as those of third parties with whom we interact or on whom we rely. Our business relies on the secure 
processing, transmission, storage and retrieval of confidential, proprietary and other information in our computer and data 
management systems and networks, and in the computer and data management systems and networks of third parties. In 
addition, to access our network, products and services, our clients and other third parties may use personal mobile devices 
or computing devices that are outside of our network environment and are subject to their own cybersecurity risks. All of 
these factors increase our risks related to cyber-threats and electronic disruptions. 

In addition to well-known risks related to fraudulent activity, which take many forms, such as check "kiting" or fraud, wire 
fraud, and other dishonest acts, information security breaches and cybersecurity-related incidents have become a material 
risk in the financial services industry. These threats may include fraudulent or unauthorized access to data processing or 
data  storage  systems  used  by  us  or  by  our  clients,  electronic  identity  theft,  "phishing,"  account  takeover,  denial  or 
degradation of service attacks, and malware or other cyber-attacks. These electronic viruses or malicious code are typically 
designed to, among other things: 

  Obtain unauthorized access to confidential information belonging to us or our clients;  

  Manipulate or destroy data;  

  Disrupt, sabotage or degrade service on a financial institution’s systems; or  

  Steal money. 

In  recent  periods,  several  governmental  agencies  and  large  corporations,  including  financial  service  organizations  and 
retail companies, have suffered major data breaches, in some cases exposing not only their confidential and proprietary 
corporate information, but also sensitive financial and other personal information of their clients or their employees or 
other  third  parties,  and  subjecting  those  agencies  and  corporations  to  potential  fraudulent  activity  and  their  clients, 
employees  and  other  third  parties  to  identity  theft  and  fraudulent  activity  in  their  credit  card  and  banking  accounts. 
Therefore, security breaches and cyber-attacks can cause significant increases in operating costs, including the costs of 
compensating clients for any resulting losses they may incur and the costs and capital expenditures required to correct the 
deficiencies in and strengthen the security of data processing and storage systems. 

Unfortunately, it is not always possible to anticipate, detect, or recognize these threats to our systems, or to implement 
effective preventative measures against all breaches, whether those breaches are malicious or accidental. Cybersecurity 
risks for banking organizations have significantly increased in recent years and have been difficult to detect before they 
occur because of, among other reasons: 

  The  proliferation of new technologies, and the  use of the  Internet and telecommunications technologies to conduct 

financial transactions;  

  These threats arising from numerous sources, not all of which are in our control, including among others human error, 
fraud  or  malice  on  the  part  of  employees  or  third  parties,  accidental  technological  failure,  electrical  or 

41 

telecommunication outages, failures of computer servers or other damage to our property or assets, natural disasters or 
severe weather conditions, health emergencies or pandemics, or outbreaks of hostilities or terrorist acts;  

  The techniques used in cyber-attacks changing frequently and possibly not being recognized until launched or until 

well after the breach has occurred;  

  The increased sophistication and activities of organized crime groups, hackers, terrorist organizations, hostile foreign 
governments,  disgruntled  employees  or  vendors,  activists  and  other  external  parties,  including  those  involved  in 
corporate espionage; 

  The vulnerability of systems to third parties seeking to gain access to such systems either directly or using equipment 
or security passwords belonging to employees, clients, third-party service providers or other users of our systems; and  

  Our frequent transmission of sensitive information to, and storage of such information by, third parties, including our 
vendors and regulators, and possible weaknesses that go undetected in our data systems notwithstanding the testing we 
conduct of those systems. 

Although to date we have not experienced any losses or other material consequences relating to technology failure, cyber-
attacks or other information, we may suffer such losses or other consequences in the future. While we invest in systems 
and processes that are designed to detect and prevent security breaches and cyber-attacks and we conduct periodic tests of 
our security systems and processes, we may not succeed in anticipating or adequately protecting against or preventing all 
security  breaches  and  cyber-attacks  from  occurring.  Even  the  most  advanced  internal  control  environment  may  be 
vulnerable to compromise. Targeted social engineering attacks are becoming more sophisticated and are extremely difficult 
to prevent. Additionally, the existence of cyber-attacks or security breaches at third parties with access to our data, such 
as vendors, may not be disclosed to us in a timely manner. While we had insurance against losses related to cyber-attacks 
as of the filing date of this Form 10-K, we may not be able to insure against losses related to cyber-threats in the future 
and our insurance may not insure against all possible losses. As cyber-threats continue to evolve, we may be required to 
expend significant additional resources to continue to modify or enhance our protective measures or to investigate and 
remediate any information security vulnerabilities or incidents. 

As is the case with non-electronic fraudulent activity, cyber-attacks or other information or security breaches, whether 
directed  at  us  or  third  parties,  may  result  in  a  material  loss  or  have  material  consequences.  Furthermore,  the  public 
perception that a cyber-attack on our systems has been successful, whether or not this perception is correct, may damage 
our reputation  with clients and third parties  with  whom  we do business.  A successful penetration or circumvention of 
system security could cause us negative consequences, including loss of clients and business opportunities, disruption to 
our operations and business, misappropriation or destruction of our confidential information and/or that of our clients, or 
damage to our clients’ and/or third parties’ computers or systems, and could expose us to additional regulatory scrutiny 
and  result  in  a  violation  of  applicable  privacy  laws  and  other  laws,  litigation  exposure,  regulatory  fines,  penalties  or 
intervention,  loss  of  confidence  in  our  security  measures,  reputational  damage,  reimbursement  or  other  compensatory 
costs, additional compliance costs, and could adversely impact our results of operations, liquidity and financial condition. 

We rely on communications, information, operating and financial control systems technology and related services from 
third-party service providers and we may suffer an interruption in those systems. 

We also face indirect technology, cybersecurity and operational risks relating to the third parties with whom we do business 
or upon whom we rely to facilitate or enable our business activities. In addition to clients, the third parties with whom we 
interact  and  upon  whom  we  rely  include  financial  counterparties;  financial  intermediaries  such  as  clearing  agents, 
exchanges and clearing houses; vendors; regulators; providers of critical infrastructure such as internet access and electrical 
power;  and  other  parties  for  whom  we  process  transactions.  Each  of  these  third  parties  faces  the  risk  of  cyber-attack, 
information breach or loss, or technology failure. Any such cyber-attack, information breach or loss, or technology failure 
of a third party could, among other things, adversely affect our ability to effect transactions, service our clients, manage 
our exposure to risk or expand our businesses. Additionally, interruptions in service and security breaches could damage 
our reputation, lead existing clients to terminate their business relationships with us, make it more difficult for us to attract 
new clients and subject us to additional regulatory scrutiny and possibly financial liability, any of which could have a 
material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects. 

42 

We continually encounter technological change, and we may have fewer resources than many of our competitors to 
invest in technological improvements. 

The financial services industry is undergoing rapid technological changes with frequent introductions of new technology-
driven products and services. The effective use of technology increases efficiency and enables financial institutions to 
better serve clients and to reduce costs. Our future success will depend, in part, upon our ability to address the needs of 
our clients by using technology to provide products and services that will satisfy client demands for convenience, as well 
as to create additional efficiencies in our operations. Many national vendors provide turn-key services that allow smaller 
banks to compete with institutions that have substantially greater resources to invest in technological improvements. We 
may  not  be  able,  however,  to  effectively  implement  new  technology-driven  products  and  services  or  be  successful  in 
marketing these products and services to our clients. 

Our ability to attract and retain clients and key associates could be adversely affected if our reputation is harmed. 

Our ability to attract and retain clients and key associates could be adversely affected if our reputation is harmed. Any 
actual or perceived failure to address various issues could cause reputational harm, including a failure to address any of 
the following types of issues: legal and regulatory requirements; the proper maintenance or protection of the privacy of 
client and employee financial or other personal information; record keeping deficiencies or errors; money-laundering; and 
potential conflicts of interest or ethical issues. Moreover, any failure to appropriately address any issues of this nature 
could give rise to additional regulatory restrictions, and legal risks, which could lead to costly litigation or subject us to 
enforcement  actions,  fines,  or  penalties  and  cause  us  to  incur  related  costs  and  expenses.  In  addition,  our  banking, 
investment advisory and wealth management businesses are dependent on the integrity of our banking personnel and our 
investment advisory and wealth managers. Lapses in integrity could cause reputational harm to our businesses that could 
lead to the  loss of existing clients and  make it  more  difficult for us to attract new clients and, therefore, could have a 
material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects. 

We may incur significant losses due to ineffective risk management processes and strategies. 

We seek to monitor and control our risk exposures through a comprehensive risk and control framework encompassing a 
variety of separate but complementary financial, credit, transactional, operational and compliance systems, and internal 
control and management testing and review processes. However, those systems and review processes and the judgments 
that accompany their application may not be effective and, as a result, we may not anticipate every economic and financial 
outcome in all market environments or the specifics and timing of such outcomes, particularly in the event of the kinds of 
dislocations in market conditions experienced in recent years, which highlight the limitations inherent in using historical 
data to manage risk. If those systems and review processes prove to be ineffective in identifying and managing risks, or 
testing scenarios not reveal real-life failures of technology, we could be subjected to increased regulatory scrutiny and 
regulatory restrictions could be imposed on our business, including on our potential future business lines, as a result of 
which our business and operating results could be adversely affected. 

We are exposed to risk of environmental liabilities with respect to real properties that we may acquire. 

From time to time, in the ordinary course of our business, we acquire, by or in lieu of foreclosure, real properties which 
collateralize nonperforming loans. As an owner of such properties, we could become subject to environmental liabilities 
and incur substantial costs for any property damage, personal injury, investigation and clean-up that may be required due 
to any environmental contamination that may be found to exist at any of those properties, even if we did not engage in the 
activities that led to such contamination and those activities took place prior to our ownership of the properties. In addition, 
if we are the owner or former owner of a contaminated site, we may be subject to common law claims by third parties 
seeking damages for environmental contamination emanating from the site. If we were to become subject to significant 
environmental liabilities or costs, our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects could be materially 
and adversely affected. 

New lines of business or new products and services may subject us to additional risks. 

From time to time, we may implement new lines of business or offer new products and services within existing lines of 
business. There are substantial risks and uncertainties associated with these efforts. We may invest significant  time and 
resources  in  developing  and  marketing  new  lines  of  business  or  new  products  and  services.  Initial  timetables  for  the 

43 

introduction and development of new lines of business or new products or services may not be achieved and price and 
profitability targets may not prove feasible or may be dependent on identifying and hiring a qualified person to lead the 
division.  In  addition,  existing  management  personnel  may  not  have  the  experience  or  capacity  to  provide  effective 
oversight of new lines of business or new products and services. 

External factors, such as compliance with regulations, competitive alternatives, and shifting market preferences, may also 
impact the successful implementation of a new line of business or a new product or service and result in consumer harm. 
Furthermore, any new line of business or new product or service could have a significant impact on the effectiveness of 
our system of internal controls. Failure to successfully manage these risks in the development and implementation of new 
lines of business or new products or services could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations, 
financial condition and prospects. 

We rely on customer and counterparty information, which subjects us to risks if that information is not accurate or is 
incomplete. 

When deciding whether to extend credit or enter into other transactions with clients or counterparties, we may rely on 
information provided by or on behalf of those clients and counterparties, including audited financial statements and other 
financial information. We may also rely on representations made by clients and counterparties that the information they 
provide is accurate and complete. We conduct appropriate due diligence on such customer information and, where practical 
and economical, we engage valuation and other experts or sources of information to assist with assessing collateral and 
other customer risks. Our financial results could be adversely affected if the financial statements, collateral value or other 
financial information provided by clients or counterparties are incorrect. 

The  COVID-19  pandemic  has  adversely  impacted  our  business  and  financial  results,  and  the  ultimate  impact  will 
depend on future developments, which are highly uncertain and cannot be predicted, including the scope and duration 
of the pandemic and actions taken by governmental authorities in response to the pandemic. 

The COVID-19 pandemic is creating extensive disruptions to the global economy and to the lives of individuals throughout 
the world. Governments, businesses, and the public are taking unprecedented actions to contain the spread of COVID-19 
and to mitigate its effects, including quarantines, travel bans, shelter-in-place orders, closures of businesses and schools, 
fiscal stimulus, and legislation designed to deliver monetary aid and other relief. While the scope, duration, and full effects 
of COVID-19 are rapidly evolving and  not fully  known, the  pandemic and related efforts to contain it  have disrupted 
global  economic  activity,  adversely  affected  the  functioning  of  financial  markets,  impacted  interest  rates,  increased 
economic and market uncertainty, and disrupted trade and supply chains. If these effects continue for a prolonged period 
or result in sustained economic stress or recession, many of the risk factors identified could be exacerbated and such effects 
could have a material adverse impact on us in a number of ways related to credit, collateral, customer demand, funding, 
operations, interest rate risk, and human capital, as described in more detail below. 

  Credit Risk. Our risks of timely loan repayment and the value of collateral supporting the loans are affected by the 
strength of our borrower’s financial condition and business. Concern about the spread of COVID-19 has caused and is 
likely  to  continue  to  cause  business  shutdowns,  limitations  on  commercial  activity  and  financial  transactions, 
suspensions  on  evictions,  labor  shortages,  supply  chain  interruptions,  increased  unemployment  and  commercial 
property vacancy rates, reduced profitability and ability for property owners to make mortgage payments, and overall 
economic and financial market instability, all of which may cause our  clients to be unable to make scheduled loan 
payments. If the effects of COVID-19 result in widespread and sustained repayment shortfalls on loans in our portfolio 
or defaults by counterparties, we could incur significant delinquencies, foreclosures and credit losses, particularly if 
the available collateral is insufficient to cover our exposure. The future effects of COVID-19 on economic activity 
could negatively affect the collateral values associated with our existing loans, the ability to liquidate the real estate 
collateral securing our residential and commercial real estate loans, our ability to maintain loan origination volume and 
to  obtain  additional  financing,  the  future  demand  for  or  profitability  of  our  lending,  trust,  wealth  management  and 
depository services, and the financial condition and credit risk of our clients. Further, in the event of delinquencies, 
regulatory changes and policies designed to protect borrowers  may slow or prevent us from or, in some cases, our 
business decisions may result in, a delay in our taking certain remediation actions, such as foreclosure. In addition, we 
have  unfunded commitments to extend credit to  clients, which are generally not drawn upon. During a challenging 
economic environment, such as the ongoing pandemic, our clients are more dependent on our credit commitments and 
increased  borrowings  under  these  commitments  could  adversely  impact  our  liquidity.  Furthermore,  in  an  effort  to 

44 

 
support our communities during the pandemic, we participated in the PPP under the CARES Act whereby loans to 
small businesses were made and those loans are subject to the regulatory requirements that would require forbearance 
of loan payments for a specified time or that would limit our ability to pursue all available remedies in the event of a 
loan default. If the borrower under the PPP loan fails to qualify for loan forgiveness, we are at the heightened risk of 
holding  these  loans  at  unfavorable  interest  rates  as  compared  to  the  loans  to  clients  that  we  would  have  otherwise 
extended credit. 

  Strategic Risk. Our success may be affected by a variety of external factors that may affect the price or marketability 
of our products and services, including disruptions in the capital markets, changes in interest rates that may increase 
our funding costs, reduced demand for our financial products due to economic conditions and the various response of 
governmental and nongovernmental authorities. The COVID-19 pandemic has significantly increased economic and 
demand uncertainty and has led to disruption and volatility in the global capital markets, which increases the cost of 
capital and adversely impacts access to capital. Furthermore, many of the governmental actions have been directed 
toward  curtailing  household  and  business  activity  to  contain  COVID-19.  These  actions  have  continued  to  change 
throughout  the  COVID-19  pandemic.  For  example,  in  some  of  our  markets,  local  governments  have  acted  to 
temporarily close or restrict the operations of most businesses while others have returned to pre-pandemic operations. 
In particular, the Company experienced a decline in origination of loans at the beginning of the COVID-19 pandemic. 
The future effects of COVID-19 on economic activity could negatively affect the future banking products we provide 
including the ability to sell mortgage loan that we originate with the intent to sell. 

  Operational Risk. Current and future restrictions on our workforce’s access to our facilities could limit our ability to 
meet  customer  servicing  expectations  and  have  a  material  adverse  effect  on  our  operations.  We  rely  on  business 
processes and profit center activity that largely depend on people, technology, and the use of complex systems and 
models to manage our business, including access to information technology systems and models as well as information, 
applications,  payment  systems  and  other  services  provided  by  third  parties.  In  response  to  COVID-19,  we  have 
modified our business practices  with a  majority of our employees  working remotely  from their  homes to  have our 
operations uninterrupted as much as possible. Further, technology in employees’ homes may not be as robust as in our 
offices and could cause the networks, information systems, applications, and other tools available to employees to be 
more  limited  or  less  reliable  than  in  our  offices,  the  continuation  of  these  work-from-home  measures  introduces 
additional  operational  risk,  especially  including  increased  cybersecurity  risk.  These  cyber  risks  include  greater 
phishing,  malware,  and  other  cybersecurity  attacks,  vulnerability  to  disruptions  of  our  information  technology 
infrastructure and telecommunications systems for remote operations, increased risk of unauthorized dissemination of 
confidential information, limited ability to restore the systems in the event of a systems failure or interruption, great 
risk of a security breach resulting in destruction or misuse of valuable information, and potential impairment of our 
ability to perform critical functions, including wiring funds, all of which could expose us to risks of data or financial 
loss, litigation and liability and could seriously disrupt our operations and the operations of any impacted clients. 

Moreover, we rely on many third parties in our business operations, including appraisers of real property collateral, 
vendors that supply essential services such as loan servicers, providers of financial information, systems and analytical 
tools and providers of electronic payment and settlement systems, and local and federal government agencies, offices, 
and courthouses. In light of the developing measures responding to the pandemic, many of these entities have limited 
the  availability  and  access  of  their  services.  For  example,  loan  origination  could  be  delayed  due  to  the  limited 
availability of real estate appraisers for the collateral. Loan closings could be delayed related to reductions in available 
staff  in  recording  offices  or  the  closing  of  courthouses  in  certain  counties,  which  slows  the  process  for  title  work, 
mortgage and UCC filings in those counties. If the third party service providers continue to have limited capacities for 
a prolonged period or if additional limitations or potential disruptions in these services materialize, it may negatively 
affect our operations. 

  Interest Rate Risk. Our net interest income, lending activities, deposits, hedging activities, and profitability could be 
negatively affected by volatility in interest rates caused by uncertainties stemming from COVID-19. In March 2020, 
the Federal Reserve lowered the target range for the federal funds rate to a range from 0 to 0.25 percent, citing concerns 
about the impact of COVID-19 on markets and stress in the energy sector. A prolonged period of extremely volatile 
and unstable market conditions would likely increase our funding costs and negatively affect market risk mitigation 
strategies. Higher income volatility from changes in interest rates and spreads to benchmark indices could cause a loss 
of future net interest income and a decrease in current fair market values of our assets. Fluctuations in interest rates 
will impact both the level of income and expense recorded on most of our assets and liabilities and the market value of 

45 

 
 
 
all interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities, other than those which have a short-term to maturity, which 
in turn could have a material adverse effect on our net income, operating results, or financial condition. 

  Trust and Investment Management Risk. Recent market volatility associated with the pandemic and the decline in oil 
and gas prices has adversely impacted the value of our assets under management. We derive a significant amount of 
our revenues primarily from investment management fees based on assets under management. As such, fluctuations in 
the equity and debt markets can have a direct impact upon our net earnings. A sustained decline in the value of the 
assets that we manage or otherwise administer or service for others, could have an adverse effect on related fee income 
and demand for our services. 

Because there have been no comparable recent global pandemics that resulted in similar global impact, we do not yet know 
the  full  extent  of  COVID-19’s  effects  on  our  business,  operations,  or  the  global  economy  as  a  whole.  Any  future 
development  will  be  highly  uncertain  and  cannot  be  predicted,  including  the  scope  and  duration  of  the  pandemic,  the 
effectiveness of our work from home arrangements and third party providers’ ability to support our operation, any actions 
taken by governmental authorities and other third parties in response to the pandemic. The uncertain future development 
of this crisis could materially and adversely affect our business, operations, operating results, financial condition, liquidity 
or capital levels.  

Risks Related to Our Regulatory Environment 

The financial services industry is highly regulated, and legislative or regulatory actions taken now or in the future 
may have a significant adverse effect on our operations. 

The financial services industry is extensively regulated and supervised under both federal and state laws and regulations 
that are intended primarily to protect clients, depositors, the FDIC deposit insurance fund, and the banking system as a 
whole, not our shareholders. We are subject to the regulation and supervision of the Federal Reserve, the FDIC and the 
CDB. The banking laws, regulations and policies applicable to us govern matters ranging from the maintenance of adequate 
capital, safety and soundness, mergers and changes in control to the general business operations conducted by us, including 
permissible types, amounts and terms of loans and investments, the amount of reserves held against deposits, restrictions 
on dividends, imposition of specific accounting requirements, establishment of new offices and the maximum interest rate 
that may be charged on loans. 

We are subject to changes in federal and state banking statutes, regulations and governmental policies, or the interpretation 
or implementation of them, and are subject to changes and increased complexity in regulatory requirements as governments 
and regulators continue reforms intended to strengthen the stability of the financial system and protect key markets and 
participants. Any changes in any federal or state banking statute, regulation or governmental policy, including changes 
which occurred in 2020 and may occur in 2021 and beyond during the current and future administration, could affect us 
in  substantial  and  unpredictable  ways,  including  ways  that  may  adversely  affect  our  business,  results  of  operations, 
financial condition or prospects. Compliance with laws and regulations can be difficult and costly, and changes to laws 
and regulations often impose additional compliance costs. In addition, federal and state banking regulators have broad 
authority to supervise our banking business and that of our subsidiaries, including the authority to prohibit activities that 
represent unsafe or unsound banking practices or constitute violations of statute, rule, regulation, or administrative order. 
Failure to comply with any such laws, regulations or regulatory policies could result in sanctions by regulatory agencies, 
restrictions on our business activities, civil money penalties or damage to our reputation, all of  which could adversely 
affect our business, results of operations, financial condition or prospects. 

 Federal and state banking agencies periodically conduct  examinations of our business, including compliance with 
laws and regulations, and our failure to comply with any supervisory actions which we are, or may become, subject to 
as a result of such examinations may adversely affect us. 

The Federal Reserve, the FDIC, SEC, and the CDB may conduct examinations of our business, including for compliance 
with applicable laws and regulations. As a result of an examination, regulatory agencies may determine that the financial 
condition, capital resources, asset quality, asset concentrations, earnings prospects, management, liquidity, sensitivity to 
market risk, or other aspects of any of our operations are unsatisfactory, or that we or our management are in violation of 
any law, regulation or guideline in effect from time to time. Regulatory agencies may take a number of different remedial 
actions,  including  the  power  to  enjoin  "unsafe  or  unsound"  practices,  to  require  affirmative  actions  to  correct  any 
conditions resulting from any violation or practice, to issue an administrative order that can be judicially enforced, to direct 
46 

 
an increase in our capital, to restrict our growth, to change the composition of our concentrations in portfolio or balance 
sheet assets, to assess civil monetary penalties against officers or directors, to remove officers and directors and, if such 
conditions cannot be corrected or there is an imminent risk of loss to depositors, the  FDIC  may terminate  our deposit 
insurance.  A  regulatory  action  against  us  could  have  a  material  adverse  effect  on  our  business,  results  of  operations, 
financial condition and prospects. 

We are subject to stringent capital requirements. 

Banking institutions are required to hold more capital as a percentage of assets than most industries. Holding high amounts 
of capital compresses our earnings and constrains growth. In addition, the failure to meet applicable regulatory capital 
requirements could result in one or more of our regulators placing limitations or conditions on our activities, including our 
growth initiatives, or restricting the commencement of new activities, and could affect client and investor confidence, our 
costs of funds and FDIC insurance costs and our ability to make acquisitions and result in a material adverse effect on our 
business, financial condition, results of operations and growth prospects. 

New and future rulemaking by the CFPB and other regulators, as well as enforcement of existing consumer protection 
laws, may have a material and adverse effect on our operations and operating costs. 

The CFPB has the authority to implement and enforce a variety of existing federal consumer protection  statutes and to 
issue new regulations but, with respect to institutions of our size, does not have primary examination and enforcement 
authority with respect to such laws and regulations. The authority to examine depository institutions with $10 billion or 
less in assets, like us, for compliance with federal consumer laws remains largely with our primary federal regulator, the 
FDIC. However, the CFPB may participate in examinations of smaller institutions on a  "sampling basis" and may refer 
potential enforcement actions against such institutions to their primary regulators. In some cases, regulators such as the 
Federal Trade Commission and the Department of Justice also retain certain rulemaking or enforcement authority, and we 
also remain subject to certain state consumer protection laws. As an independent bureau within the Federal Reserve, the 
CFPB may impose requirements more severe than the previous bank regulatory agencies. The CFPB has placed significant 
emphasis on consumer complaint management and has established a public consumer complaint database to encourage 
consumers to file complaints they may have against financial institutions. We are expected to monitor and respond to these 
complaints, including those that we deem frivolous, and doing so may require management to reallocate resources away 
from more profitable endeavors. 

The level of our commercial real estate loan portfolio may subject us to heightened regulatory scrutiny. 

The FDIC and the Federal Reserve have promulgated joint guidance on sound risk management practices for financial 
institutions with concentrations in commercial real estate lending. Under the guidance, a financial institution that is actively 
involved  in  commercial  real  estate  lending  should  perform  a  risk  assessment  to  identify  potential  concentrations  in 
commercial real estate lending.  A  financial  institution  may have  such a concentration if, among other  factors: (i) total 
outstanding loans for construction, land development, and other land represent 100% or more of total risk-based capital 
("CRE  1  Concentration");  or  (ii) total  outstanding  loans  for  construction,  land  development  and  other  land  and  loans 
secured by multifamily and non-owner occupied non-farm, non-residential properties (excluding loans secured by owner-
occupied  properties)  represent  300%  or  more  of  total  risk-based  capital ("CRE  2  Concentration")  and  the  institution’s 
commercial real estate loan portfolio has increased by 50% or more during the prior 36-month period. In such an instance, 
management  should  employ  heightened  risk  management  practices,  including  board  and  management  oversight  and 
strategic planning, development of underwriting standards, risk assessment and monitoring through market analysis and 
stress testing. As of December 31, 2020, our CRE 1 Concentration level was 90.6% and our CRE 2 Concentration level 
was 194.9%. We may, at some point, be considered to have a concentration in the future, or our risk management practices 
may be found to be deficient,  which could result in increased reserves and capital costs as well as potential regulatory 
enforcement action. 

The implementation of the Current Expected Credit Loss accounting standard could require the Company to increase 
its allowance for credit losses and may have a material adverse effect on its financial condition and results of 
operations. 

In June 2016, the FASB issued ASU 2016-13, Financial Instruments - Credit Losses (Topic 326): Measurement of Credit 
Losses on Financial Instruments. ASU 2016-13 replaces the incurred loss model with an expected loss model, which is 

47 

referred  to  as  the  current  expected  credit  loss  model,  or  CECL.  On  July  17,  2019,  the  FASB  voted  to  delay  CECL 
implementation  for  certain  companies  including  smaller  reporting  companies  ("SRCs")  as  defined  by  the  SEC.  The 
Company is designated as a SRC with the SEC. The proposed delay by FASB was subject to a comment period. At the 
October 16, 2019 FASB meeting, the FASB voted unanimously to delay the effective date of CECL adoption for SRCs to 
January 1, 2023. CECL requires a change in the model to recognize a valuation allowance based on estimated expected 
credit  losses  over  the  life  of  the  portfolio,  compared  to  the  probable  incurred  loss  model.  The  change  to  the  CECL 
framework will require the Company to greatly increase the data the Company must collect and review to determine the 
appropriate level of the allowance for credit losses. The adoption of CECL may result in greater volatility in the level of 
the allowance for credit losses, depending on various factors and assumptions applied in the model, such as the forecasted 
economic conditions in the foreseeable future and loan payment behaviors. Any increase in the allowance for credit losses, 
or expenses incurred to determine the appropriate level of the allowance for credit losses, may have an adverse effect on 
the Company’s financial condition and results of operations. Currently, we are unable to estimate the impact the adoption 
of  this  update  will  have  on  the  consolidated  financial  statements  and  disclosures.  However,  the  Company  expects  the 
impact of the adoption will be significantly influenced by the composition and characteristics of its loan portfolios along 
with  economic  conditions  prevalent  as  of  the  date  of  adoption.  The  Company  expects  to  implement  the  new  standard 
beginning January 1, 2023. 

We are subject to numerous laws designed to protect consumers, including the Community Reinvestment Act and fair 
lending laws, and failure to comply with these laws could lead to a wide variety of sanctions. 

The Community Reinvestment Act, the Equal Credit Opportunity Act, the Fair Housing Act and other fair lending laws 
and regulations impose nondiscriminatory lending requirements on financial institutions. The Department of Justice, the 
CFPB  and  other  federal  agencies  are  responsible  for  enforcing  these  laws  and  regulations.  A  successful  regulatory 
challenge to an institution’s performance under the Community Reinvestment Act or fair lending laws and regulations 
could result in a wide variety of sanctions, including damages and civil money penalties, injunctive relief, restrictions on 
mergers and acquisitions activity, restrictions on expansion, and restrictions on entering new business lines. Private parties 
may also have the ability to challenge an institution’s performance under fair lending laws in private class action litigation. 
Any  such  actions  could  have  a  material  adverse  effect  on  our  business,  financial  condition,  results  of  operations  and 
prospects. 

We face a risk of noncompliance and enforcement action with the Bank Secrecy Act and other anti-money laundering 
statutes and regulations. 

The  federal  Bank  Secrecy  Act,  Title  III  of  the  USA  PATRIOT  Act  and  other  laws  and  regulations  require  financial 
institutions, among other duties, to institute and maintain effective anti-money laundering programs and file suspicious 
activity and currency transaction reports as appropriate. The federal Financial Crimes Enforcement Network, established 
by the Treasury to administer the Bank Secrecy Act, is authorized to impose significant civil money penalties for violations 
of those requirements and has recently engaged in coordinated enforcement efforts with the individual federal banking 
regulators, as well as the U.S. Department of Justice, Drug Enforcement Administration and Internal Revenue Service. 
There is also increased scrutiny of compliance with the sanctions rules enforced by the Office of Foreign Assets Control. 
If  our  policies,  procedures  and  systems  are  deemed  deficient  or  the  policies,  procedures  and  systems  of  any  financial 
institutions that we may acquire in the future are deemed deficient, we would be  subject to liability, including fines and 
regulatory actions such as restrictions on our ability to pay dividends and the necessity to obtain regulatory approvals to 
proceed with certain aspects of our business plan, which would negatively impact our business, financial condition and 
results of operations. Failure to maintain and implement adequate  programs to combat money laundering and terrorist 
financing could also have serious reputational consequences for us. Any of these results could materially and adversely 
affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects. 

Regulations relating to privacy, information security and data protection could increase our costs, affect or limit how 
we collect and use personal information and adversely affect our business opportunities. 

We  are  subject  to  various  privacy,  information  security  and  data  protection  laws,  including  requirements  concerning 
security breach notification, and we could be negatively impacted by these laws. For example, our business is subject to 
the  GLB  Act  which,  among  other  things:  (i) imposes  certain  limitations  on  our  ability  to  share  non-public  personal 
information about our clients with non-affiliated third parties; (ii) requires that we provide certain disclosures to clients 
about our information collection, sharing and security practices and afford clients the right to "opt out" of any information 

48 

sharing  by  us  with  non-affiliated  third  parties  (with  certain  exceptions);  and  (iii) requires  we  develop,  implement  and 
maintain a written comprehensive information security program containing safeguards appropriate based on our size and 
complexity, the nature and scope of our activities, and the sensitivity of client information we process, as well as plans for 
responding to data security breaches. Various state and federal banking regulators and states and foreign countries have 
also enacted data security breach notification requirements with varying levels of individual, consumer, regulatory or law 
enforcement notification in certain circumstances in the event of a security breach. Moreover, legislators and regulators in 
the United States and other countries are increasingly adopting or revising privacy, information security and data protection 
laws that potentially could have a significant impact on our current and planned privacy, data protection and information 
security-related practices, our collection, use, sharing, retention and safeguarding of consumer or employee information, 
and some  of our current or planned business activities. This could also increase our costs of compliance and business 
operations and could reduce income from certain business initiatives. This includes increased privacy-related enforcement 
activity at the federal level, by the Federal Trade Commission, as well as at the state level, such as with regard to mobile 
applications. 

Compliance  with  current  or  future  privacy,  data  protection  and  information  security  laws  (including  those  regarding 
security breach notification) affecting client or employee data to which we are subject could result in higher compliance 
and technology costs and could restrict our ability to provide certain products and services, which could have a material 
adverse  effect  on  our  business,  financial  conditions  or  results  of  operations.  Our  failure  to  comply  with  privacy,  data 
protection and information security laws could result in potentially significant regulatory or governmental investigations 
or actions, litigation, fines, sanctions and damage to our reputation, which could have a material adverse effect on our 
business, financial condition or results of operations. 

We can be subject to legal and regulatory proceedings, investigations and inquiries related to conduct risk. 

Such legal and regulatory activities could result in significant penalties and other negative impacts on our businesses and 
results of operations. At any given time, we can be involved in defending legal and regulatory proceedings and are subject 
to  numerous  governmental  and  regulatory  examinations,  investigations  and  other  inquiries.  The  frequency  with  which 
such proceedings, investigations and inquiries are initiated have increased over the last few years, and the global judicial, 
regulatory and political environment generally remains hostile to financial institutions. For example, the U.S. Department 
of  Justice,  or  the  DOJ,  conditions  the  granting  of  cooperation  credit  in  civil  and  criminal  investigations  of  corporate 
wrongdoing  on  the  company  involved  having  provided  to  investigators  all  relevant  facts  relating  to  the  individuals 
responsible for the alleged misconduct. The complexity of the federal and state regulatory and enforcement regimes in the 
U.S.,  means  that  a  single  event  or  issue  may  give  rise  to  a  large  number  of  overlapping  investigations  and  regulatory 
proceedings, either by multiple federal and state agencies in the U.S. or by multiple regulators and other governmental 
entities in different jurisdictions. Moreover, U.S. authorities have been increasingly focused on "conduct risk," a term that 
is used to describe the risks associated with behavior by employees and agents, including third-party vendors, that could 
harm  clients,  consumers,  investors  or  the  markets,  such  as  failures  to  safeguard  consumers’  and  investors’  personal 
information, failures to identify and manage conflicts of interest and improperly creating, selling and marketing products 
and services. In addition to increasing compliance risks, this focus on conduct risk could lead to more regulatory or other 
enforcement proceedings and litigation, including for practices which historically were acceptable but are now receiving 
greater scrutiny. Further, while we take numerous steps to prevent and detect conduct by employees and agents that could 
potentially  harm  clients,  investors  or  the  markets,  such  behavior  may  not  always  be  deterred  or  prevented.  Banking 
regulators  have also focused  on the overall culture of  financial  services  firms. In addition to regulatory restrictions or 
structural changes that could result from perceived deficiencies in our culture, such focus could also  lead to additional 
regulatory proceedings. 

Risks Related to Ownership of our Common Stock 

The trading volume in our common stock is less than other larger financial institutions. 

Although our common stock is listed for trading on the Nasdaq Global Select Market, the trading volume in our common 
stock  is  less  than  that  of  other,  larger  financial  services  companies.  A  public  trading  market  having  the  desired 
characteristics of depth, liquidity and orderliness depends on the presence in the marketplace of willing buyers and sellers 
of  our  common  stock  at  any  given  time.  This  presence  depends  on  the  individual  decisions  of  investors  and  general 
economic and market conditions over which we have no control. Given the lower trading volume of our common stock, 

49 

significant sales of our common stock, or the expectation of these sales, could cause the price of our common stock to 
decline. 

The obligations associated with being a public company require significant resources and management attention, which 
will increase our costs of operations and may divert focus from our business operations. 

As a public company, we face increased legal, accounting, administrative and other costs and expenses that we did not 
incur as a private company, particularly after we no longer qualify as an emerging growth company.  

We expect to incur substantial costs related to operating as a public company, and these costs may be higher when we no 
longer qualify as an emerging growth company. We are subject to the reporting requirements of the Securities Exchange 
Act of 1934, as amended, or the Exchange  Act,  which requires that  we  file annual, quarterly and current reports  with 
respect to our business and financial condition and proxy and other information statements, and the rules and regulations 
implemented by the SEC, the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, or the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, the Dodd-Frank Act, the PCAOB 
and  the  Nasdaq  Global  Select  Market,  each  of  which  imposes  additional  reporting  and  other  obligations  on  public 
companies. As a public company, compliance with these reporting requirements and other SEC and the Nasdaq Global 
Select Market rules makes certain operating activities more time-consuming, and has caused us to incur significant new 
legal, accounting, insurance and other expenses. Furthermore, the need to establish the corporate infrastructure demanded 
of a public company may divert management’s attention from implementing our operating strategy, which could prevent 
us from successfully implementing our strategic initiatives and improving our results of operations. We have made, and 
will continue to make, changes to our internal controls and procedures for financial reporting and accounting systems to 
meet our reporting obligations as a public company. However, we cannot predict or estimate the amount of additional 
costs we may incur in order to comply with these requirements. We anticipate that these costs will materially increase our 
general and administrative expenses and such increases will reduce our profitability. 

If we fail to maintain effective internal control over financial reporting, we may not be able to report our financial 
results accurately and timely. 

Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting and for 
evaluating  and  reporting  on  that  system  of  internal  control.  Our  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  is  a  process 
designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial 
statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. As a public company, we 
are required to make annual assessments of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting. In addition, 
when we cease to be an emerging growth company under the JOBS Act, our independent registered public accounting 
firm will be required to report on the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting. 

A  significant  deficiency  is  a  deficiency,  or  a  combination  of  deficiencies,  in  internal  control  that  is  less  severe  than  a 
material weakness, yet important enough to merit attention by those responsible for oversight of the Company’s financial 
reporting. We have implemented measures designed to address historical internal control significant deficiencies and will 
continue to implement measures designed to improve our internal control over financial reporting and disclosure controls 
and procedures. 

We  will  continue  to  periodically  test  and  update,  as  necessary,  our  internal  control  systems,  including  our  financial 
reporting controls. In addition, we hired additional accounting personnel as part of our transition from a private company 
to a public company. Our actions, however, may not be sufficient to result in an effective internal control environment and 
any future failure to maintain effective internal control over financial reporting could impair the reliability of our financial 
statements, which in turn could harm our business, impair investor confidence in the accuracy and  completeness of our 
financial reports, impair our access to the capital markets, cause the price of our common stock to decline and subject us 
to increased regulatory scrutiny and/or penalties, and higher risk of shareholder litigation. 

Securities analysts may not initiate or continue coverage on us. 

The trading market for our common stock depends, in part, on the research and reports that securities analysts publish 
about us and our business. We do not have any control over these securities analysts, and they may not cover us. If one or 
more of these analysts cease to cover us or fail to publish regular reports on us, we could lose visibility in the financial 

50 

markets, which could cause the price or trading volume of our common stock to decline. If we are covered by securities 
analysts and are the subject of an unfavorable report, the price of our common stock may decline. 

Our management and board of directors have significant control over our business. 

As of December 31, 2020, our directors and executive officers beneficially owned an aggregate of 1,795,748 shares, or 
approximately 21.9% of our shares of common stock. Consequently, our management and board of directors may be able 
to significantly affect our affairs and policies, including the outcome of the election of directors and the potential outcome 
of other matters submitted to a vote of our shareholders, such as mergers, the sale of substantially all of our assets and 
other extraordinary corporate matters. This influence may also have the effect of delaying or preventing changes of control 
or changes in management, or limiting the ability of our other shareholders to approve transactions that they may deem to 
be  in  the  best  interests  of  our  Company.  The  interests  of  these  insiders  could  conflict  with  the  interests  of  our  other 
shareholders, including you. 

We may issue new debt securities, which would be senior to our common stock and may cause the market price of our 
common stock to decline. 

We have issued $6.6 million aggregate principal amount of subordinated notes due 2026 and $17.7 million due 2030. In 
the future, we may increase our capital resources by making offerings of debt or equity securities, which may include 
senior or additional subordinated notes, series of preferred shares or common shares. Holders of our common stock are 
not entitled to preemptive rights or other protections against dilution. Preferred shares and debt, if issued, have a preference 
on  liquidating  distributions  or  a  preference  on  dividend  or  interest  payments  that  could  limit  our  ability  to  make  a 
distribution to the holders of our common stock. Future issuances and sales of parity preferred stock, or the perception that 
such issuances and sales could occur, may also cause prevailing market prices for the series of preferred stock and our 
common stock to decline and may adversely affect our ability to raise additional capital in the financial markets at times 
and prices favorable to us. Further issuances of our common stock could be dilutive to holders of our common stock. 

Our common stock is subordinate to our existing and future indebtedness, and is effectively subordinated to all the 
indebtedness and other non-common equity claims against our subsidiaries. 

Shares of our common stock represent equity interests in the Company and do not constitute indebtedness. Accordingly, 
the shares of our common stock rank junior to all of our indebtedness and to other non-equity claims on the Company with 
respect to assets available to satisfy such claims. Additionally, dividends to holders of the Company’s common stock are 
subject to the prior dividend and liquidation rights of any preferred stock we may issue. 

The Company’s right to participate in any distribution of assets of any of its subsidiaries upon the subsidiary’s liquidation 
or otherwise, and thus the ability of the Company’s common shareholders to benefit indirectly from such distribution, will 
be subject to the prior claims of creditors of that subsidiary. As a result, holders of the Company’s common stock will be 
effectively  subordinated  to  all  existing  and  future  liabilities  and  obligations  of  its  subsidiaries,  including  claims  of 
depositors. 

We may issue shares of preferred stock in the future, which could make it difficult for another company to acquire us 
or could otherwise adversely affect holders of our common stock, which could depress the price of our common stock. 

Our articles of incorporation authorize us to issue up to 10 million shares of one or more series of preferred stock. Our 
board of directors has the authority to determine the preferences, limitations and relative rights of shares of preferred stock 
and to fix the number of shares constituting any series and the designation of such series, without any further vote or action 
by our shareholders. Our preferred stock could be issued with voting, liquidation, dividend and other rights superior to the 
rights of our common stock. The potential issuance of preferred stock may delay or prevent a change in control of us, 
discourage bids for our common stock at a premium over the market price and materially adversely affect the market price 
and the voting and other rights of the holders of our common stock. 

We are dependent upon the Bank for cash flow, and the Bank’s ability to make cash distributions is restricted. 

Our primary tangible asset is the stock of the Bank. As such, we depend upon the Bank for cash distributions (through 
dividends on the Bank’s common stock) that we use to pay our operating expenses, satisfy our obligations (including our 

51 

preferred dividends, subordinated debentures, notes, and our other debt obligations) and to pay dividends on our common 
stock. Federal statutes, regulations and policies restrict the Bank’s ability to make cash distributions to us. These statutes 
and regulations require, among other things, that the Bank maintain certain levels of capital in order to pay a dividend. In 
addition, there are certain restrictions imposed by federal  banking  laws, regulations and authorities on the payment of 
dividends by us and by the Bank. If the Bank is unable to pay dividends to us, we will not be able to satisfy our obligations 
or pay dividends on our common stock. Our dividend policy may change without notice, and our future ability to pay 
dividends is subject to restrictions. 

We are a separate and distinct legal entity from the Bank. We receive substantially all of our revenue from dividends paid 
to  us  by  the  Bank,  which  we  use  as  the  principal  source  of  funds  to  pay  our  expenses  and  to  pay  dividends  to  our 
shareholders, if any. Various federal and state laws and regulations limit the amount of dividends that the Bank may pay 
us. If the Bank does not receive regulatory approval or does not maintain a level of capital sufficient to permit it to make 
dividend  payments  to  us  while  maintaining  adequate  capital  levels,  our  ability  to  pay  our  expenses  and  our  business, 
financial condition or results of operations could be materially and adversely impacted. 

As a bank holding company, we are subject to regulation by the Federal Reserve. The Federal Reserve has indicated that 
bank holding companies should carefully review their dividend policy in relation to the organization’s overall asset quality, 
current and prospective earnings and level, composition and quality of capital. The guidance provides that we inform and 
consult with the Federal Reserve prior to declaring and paying a dividend that exceeds earnings for the period for which 
the  dividend  is  being  paid  or  that  could  result  in  an  adverse  change  to  our  capital  structure,  including  interest  on  the 
subordinated debentures underlying our trust preferred securities and our other debt obligations. If required payments on 
our outstanding junior subordinated debentures, held by our unconsolidated subsidiary trusts, or our other debt obligations, 
are not made or are deferred, or dividends on any preferred stock we may issue are not paid, we will be prohibited from 
paying dividends on our common stock. 

Our corporate organizational documents and provisions of federal and state law to which we are subject contain certain 
provisions  that  could  have  an  anti-takeover  effect  and  may  delay,  make  more  difficult  or  prevent  an  attempted 
acquisition that you may favor or an attempted replacement of our board of directors or management. 

Our articles of incorporation and our bylaws may have an anti-takeover effect and may delay, discourage or prevent an 
attempted acquisition or change  of control or a  replacement of our  incumbent board of  directors or management.  Our 
governing documents include provisions that: 

  Empower  our  board  of  directors,  without  shareholder  approval,  to  issue  our  preferred  stock,  the  terms  of  which, 

including voting power, are to be set by our board of directors;  

  Provide that directors may only be removed from office for cause;  

  Eliminate cumulative voting in elections of directors;  

  Permit our board of directors to alter, amend or repeal our amended and restated bylaws or to adopt new bylaws;  

  Prohibit shareholder action by less than unanimous written consent, thereby requiring virtually all actions to be taken 

at a meeting of the shareholders;  

  Require shareholders that wish to bring business before annual or special meetings of shareholders, or to nominate 
candidates for election as directors at our annual meeting of shareholders, to provide timely notice of their intent in 
writing; and  

  Enable our board of directors to increase, between annual meetings, the number of persons serving as directors and to 
fill the vacancies created as a result of the increase by a majority vote of the directors present at a meeting of directors. 

Banking laws also impose notice, approval, and ongoing regulatory requirements on any shareholder or other party that 
seeks to acquire direct or indirect "control" of an FDIC-insured depository institution or its holding company. These laws 
include the BHC Act and the Change in Bank Control Act, or the CBCA. These laws could delay or prevent an acquisition. 

52 

Furthermore, our bylaws provide that the state or federal courts located in Denver County, Colorado, the county in which 
the city of Denver is located, will be the exclusive forum for: (i) any actual or purported derivative action or proceeding 
brought on our behalf; (ii) any action asserting a claim of breach of  fiduciary duty by any of our directors or officers; 
(iii) any  action  asserting  a  claim  against  us  or  our  directors  or  officers  arising  pursuant  to  the  Colorado  Business 
Corporations Act, our articles of incorporation, or our bylaws; or (iv) any action asserting a claim against us or our officers 
or directors that is governed by the internal affairs doctrine. By becoming a shareholder of our Company, you will be 
deemed to have notice of and have consented to the provisions of our bylaws related to choice of  forum. The choice of 
forum provision in our bylaws may limit our shareholders’ ability to obtain a favorable judicial forum for disputes with 
us.  Alternatively,  if  a  court  were  to  find  the  choice  of  forum  provision  contained  in  our  bylaws  to  be  inapplicable  or 
unenforceable in an action,  we  may incur additional costs  associated  with resolving  such action in other jurisdictions, 
which could adversely affect our business, operating results and financial condition. 

An investment in our common stock is not an insured deposit and is subject to risk of loss. 

Our common stock is not a savings accounts, deposits or other obligations of any of our bank or nonbank subsidiaries and 
will not be insured or guaranteed by the FDIC or any other government agency. Your investment in our common stock is 
subject to investment risk, and you must be capable of affording the loss of your entire investment. 

General Risk Factors 

The market price of our common stock could decline significantly due to actual or anticipated issuances or sales of our 
common stock in the future. 

Actual or anticipated issuances or sales of substantial amounts of our common stock could cause the market price of our 
common stock to decline significantly and make it more difficult for us to sell equity or equity-related securities in the 
future at a time and on terms that we deem appropriate. The issuance of any shares of our common stock in the future also 
would, and equity-related securities could, dilute the  percentage ownership interest held by shareholders prior to such 
issuance.  

In addition, we may issue shares of our common stock or other securities from time to time as consideration for future 
acquisitions and investments and pursuant to compensation and incentive plans. If any such acquisition or investment is 
significant, the number of shares of our common stock, or the number or aggregate principal amount, as the case may be, 
of other securities that we may issue may in turn be substantial. We may also grant registration rights covering those shares 
of our common stock or other securities in connection with any such acquisitions and investments. 

We cannot predict the size of future issuances of our common stock or the effect, if any, that future issuances and sales of 
our common stock will have on the market price of our common stock. Sales of substantial amounts of our common stock 
(including shares of our common stock issued in connection with an acquisition or under a compensation or incentive 
plan), or the perception that such sales could occur, may adversely affect prevailing market prices for our common stock 
and could impair our ability to raise capital through future sales of our securities. 

The market price of our common stock may be subject to substantial fluctuations, which may make it difficult for you 
to sell your shares at the volume, prices and times desired. 

The market price of our common stock may be highly volatile, which may make it difficult for you to resell your shares 
at the volume, prices and times desired. There are many factors that may affect the market price and trading volume of 
our common stock, including, without limitation: 

  Actual or anticipated fluctuations in our operating results, financial condition or asset quality;  

  Changes in economic or business conditions;  

  The effects of, and changes in, trade, monetary and fiscal policies, including the interest rate policies of the Federal 

Reserve; 

53 

  Publication of research reports about us, our competitors, or the financial services industry generally, or changes in, or 
failure to meet, securities analysts’ estimates of our financial and operating performance, or lack of research reports by 
industry analysts or ceasing of coverage;  

  Operating and stock price performance of companies that investors deemed comparable to us;  

  Additional or anticipated sales of our common stock or other securities by us or our existing shareholders;  

  Additions or departures of key personnel;  

  Prevailing market conditions, including increased general market volatility associated with recent fears of pandemics; 

  Perceptions in the marketplace regarding our competitors or us;  

  Significant acquisitions or business combinations, strategic partnerships, joint ventures or capital commitments by or 

involving our competitors or us;  

  Other  economic,  competitive,  governmental,  regulatory  and  technological  factors  affecting  our  operations,  pricing, 

products and services; and  

  Other news, announcements or disclosures (whether by us or others) related to us, our competitors, our primary markets 

or the financial services industry. 

The stock market and, in particular, the market for financial institution stocks have experienced substantial fluctuations in 
recent years, which in many cases have been unrelated to the operating performance and prospects of particular companies. 
In addition, significant fluctuations in the trading volume in our common stock may cause significant price variations to 
occur. Increased market volatility may materially and adversely affect the market price of our common stock, which could 
make it difficult to sell your shares at the volume, prices and times desired. 

Our business and operations may be adversely affected in numerous and complex ways by weak economic conditions 
and global trade. 

Our businesses and operations, including our private bank and trust services, which primarily consist of lending money to 
clients in the form of loans, borrowing money from clients in the form of deposits, investing in securities and investment 
management, are sensitive to general business and economic conditions in the United States. If the United States economy 
weakens,  our  growth  and  profitability  from  our  lending,  deposit  and  investment  operations  could  be  constrained. 
Uncertainty  about  the  federal  fiscal  policymaking  process,  the  medium-  and  long-term  fiscal  outlook  of  the  federal 
government, and future tax rates is a concern for businesses, consumers and investors in the United States. In addition, 
economic conditions in foreign countries and weakening global trade due to increased anti-globalization sentiment, war, 
epidemics  (including  the  recent  coronavirus),  or  other  unforeseen  events  could  affect  the  stability  of  global  financial 
markets, which could hinder the economic growth of the United States. Weak economic conditions are characterized by 
deflation, fluctuations in debt and equity capital markets, a lack of liquidity or depressed prices in the secondary market 
for loans, increased delinquencies on mortgage, consumer and commercial loans, residential and commercial real estate 
price declines and lower home sales and commercial activity. The current economic environment is also characterized by 
interest rates remaining at historically low levels, which impacts our ability to attract deposits and to generate attractive 
earnings through our investment portfolio. Further, a general economic slowdown could decrease the value of assets under 
management  and  administration  by  our  trust  services  resulting  in  lower  fee  income,  and  clients  potentially  seeking 
alternative investment opportunities with other providers, which could result in lower fee income to us. All of these factors 
are  detrimental  to  our  business,  and  the  interplay  between  these  factors  can  be  complex  and  unpredictable.  Adverse 
economic conditions and  government policy responses to such conditions could  have a  material adverse  effect on our 
business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects. Broad market performance may not be favorable in the 
future. 

54 

We may incur losses as a result of unforeseen or catastrophic events, including the emergence of a pandemic, terrorist 
attacks, extreme weather events or other natural disasters. 

The occurrence of unforeseen or catastrophic events, including the emergence of a pandemic, such as coronavirus, or other 
widespread health emergency (or concerns over the possibility of such an emergency), terrorist attacks, extreme terrestrial 
or  solar  weather  events  or  other  natural  disasters,  could  create  economic  and  financial  disruptions,  and  could  lead  to 
operational difficulties (including travel limitations) that could impair our ability to manage our businesses. In particular, 
Colorado, Wyoming, Arizona, and especially California, in which a substantial portion of our business is located, have 
been susceptible to natural disasters, such as earthquakes, floods, mudslides, and wildfires. The nature and level of such 
events cannot be predicted. These catastrophic events could harm our operations through interference with technology, 
including the interruption or loss of our computer systems, telephone communications and other technology-dependent 
services which could prevent or impede us from gathering deposits, originating loans and processing and controlling our 
flow of business, as well as through the destruction of facilities and our operational, financial and management information 
systems. Additionally, natural disasters could negatively impact the values of collateral securing our borrowers’ loans and 
interrupt our borrowers’ abilities to conduct their business in a manner to support their debt obligations, either of which 
could result in losses and increased provisions for loan losses for us. 

ITEM 1B: UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS 

None. 

ITEM 2: PROPERTIES 

Our corporate headquarters is located at 1900 16th Street, Suite 1200, Denver, Colorado 80202. Including our 
corporate headquarters, the Bank operates fifteen profit centers, which consists of eleven boutique private trust bank offices 
with two locations in Arizona, eight locations in Colorado and one location in Wyoming; two loan production offices with 
one location in Ft. Collins, Colorado and one location in Greenwood Village, Colorado; and two trust offices with one 
location in Laramie, Wyoming, and one location in Century City, California. We lease all of our locations. We believe 
that our facilities are suitable and adequate to meet our present needs. The chart below describes our locations, which we 
believe are strategically located in affluent and high-growth markets in fifteen locations (listed below) across Colorado, 
Arizona, Wyoming and California: 

Arizona 

Phoenix 

Scottsdale 

Wyoming 

California 

Jackson Hole 

Century City (2) 

Laramie (2) 

Colorado 

Downtown Denver (1) 

Aspen 

Boulder 

Cherry Creek 

Denver Tech Center / Cherry Hills   

Ft. Collins (3) 

Greenwood Village (3) 

Northern Colorado 

Vail Valley 

Lone Tree 

(1)  Headquarters and co-location of profit center, product groups and support centers 
(2) 
(3) 

Trust office 
Loan production office 

55 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ITEM 3. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS 

We are not currently subject to any material legal proceedings. From time to time, we are subject to claims and 
litigation  arising  in  the  ordinary  course  of  business.  These  claims  and  litigation  may  include,  among  other  things, 
allegations of violation of banking and other applicable regulations, competition law, labor laws and consumer protection 
laws, as well as claims or litigation relating to intellectual property, securities, breach of contract  and tort. We intend to 
defend ourselves vigorously against any pending or future claims and litigation. 

At this time, in the opinion of management, the likelihood is remote that the impact of such proceedings, either 
individually or in the aggregate, would have a material adverse effect on our consolidated results of operations, financial 
condition or cash flows. However, one or more unfavorable outcomes in any claim or litigation against us could have a 
material adverse effect for the period in which they are resolved. In addition, regardless of their merits or their ultimate 
outcomes, such matters are costly, divert management’s attention and may materially and adversely affect our reputation, 
even if resolved in our favor. 

ITEM 4. MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES 

Not applicable. 

PART II 

ITEM 5: MARKET FOR REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS 
AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES 

Market Information for Common Stock 

Shares of our common stock, no par value, are traded on the NASDAQ Global Select Market under the symbol 

"MYFW".  

Holders of Record 

As of March 8, 2021, there were approximately 133 holders of record of our common stock. 

Dividend Policy 

We have not declared or paid any dividends on our common stock and we do not currently anticipate paying any 
cash  dividends  on  our  common  stock  in  the  foreseeable  future.  Instead,  we  anticipate  that  all  of  our  earnings  in  the 
foreseeable future will be retained to support our operations and finance the growth and development of our business or 
be used for stock buybacks. Any future determination to pay dividends on our common stock will be made by our board 
of directors and will depend upon our results of operations, financial condition, capital requirements, general economic 
conditions,  regulatory  and  contractual  restrictions,  our  business  strategy,  our  ability  to  service  any  equity  or  debt 
obligations senior to our common stock and other factors that our board of directors deems relevant. We are not obligated 
to pay dividends on our common stock and are subject to restrictions on paying dividends on our common stock. 

As a bank holding company, our ability to pay dividends is affected by the policies and enforcement powers of 
the Federal Reserve. See "Supervision and Regulation—Regulation of the Company—Dividends." In addition, because 
we are a holding company, we are dependent upon the payment of dividends by the Bank to us as our principal source of 
funds  to  pay  dividends  in  the  future,  if  any,  and  to  make  other  payments.  The  Bank  is  also  subject  to  various  legal, 
regulatory  and  other  restrictions  on  its  ability  to  pay  dividends  and  make  other  distributions  and  payments  to  us.  See 
"Supervision and Regulation—Regulation of the Bank—Dividends." The present and future dividend policy of the Bank 
is subject to the discretion of the board of directors. The Bank is not obligated to pay us dividends. 

As a Colorado corporation, we are subject to certain restrictions on distributions under the Colorado Business 
Corporation Act. Generally, a Colorado corporation may not make a distribution to its shareholders if, after giving the 
distribution effect: (i) the corporation would not be able to pay its debts as they become due in the usual course of business; 

56 

 
 
 
or (ii) the corporation’s total assets would be less than the sum of its total liabilities plus the amount that would be needed, 
if the corporation were to be dissolved at the time of the distribution, to satisfy the preferential rights upon dissolution of 
shareholders whose preferential rights are superior to those receiving the distribution. 

Securities Authorized for Issuance under Equity Compensation Plans 

The  information  concerning  the  ownership  of  shares  of  our  common  stock  by  certain  beneficial  owners  and 
management required by this item is incorporated herein by reference from our definitive proxy statement for our 2020 
Annual Meeting of Shareholders, a copy of which will be filed with the SEC no later than 120 days after the end of  our 
fiscal year. 

The following table sets forth information as of December 31, 2020, regarding our equity compensation plans 
that provide  for the award of equity securities or the  grant  of options to purchase equity securities of the Company to 
employees and directors of First Western and its subsidiaries: 

(A) 
   Number of securities to be  
issued upon exercise of   

(B) 

(C) 
Number of securities 

    remaining  available for future 

Plan Category 
Equity compensation plans approved by shareholders 
Equity compensation plans not approved by shareholders 

Total 

Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities 

    outstanding options or 
    vesting of outstanding 
       restricted stock grants 
 871,541 

  Weighted average exercise  

issuance under equity 
  compensation plans (excluding 
      price of outstanding options       securities reflected in column (A) 
 458,947 
  $ 
 — 
 —      
 458,947 
 871,541      

 29.02      
 —      

     Maximum number (or 

October 1, 2020 through October 31, 2020 
November 1, 2020 through November 30, 2020 
December 1, 2020 through December 31, 2020 

 —  $ 
 — 

 —  
 —  
 426  $   17.30  

  Total number 
of shares 
      purchased 

  Average 
  price paid    announced plans 
      per share      

or programs 

  Total number of 
  shares purchased 
  as part of publicly   

approximate dollar 
value) of shares 
that may yet be 

  purchased under the 
      plans or programs 
 — 
 400,000 
 399,574 

 —   
 —   
 426  

ITEM 6: SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA  

You should read the following selected historical consolidated financial and other data in conjunction with our 
consolidated financial statements and related notes and the sections entitled "Management’s Discussion and Analysis of 
Financial Condition and Results of Operations." 

57 

 
 
  
 
   
 
  
 
   
      
      
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
    
    
    
       
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share data) 
Selected Period End Balance Sheet Data: 

Cash and cash equivalents 
Available-for-sale securities 
Mortgage loans held for sale 
Gross loans(1) 
Allowance for loan losses 
Promissory notes from related parties 
Goodwill 
Other intangible assets, net 
Company owned life insurance 
Other real estate owned, net 
Total assets 
Noninterest-bearing deposits 
Interest-bearing deposits 
FHLB and FRB borrowings 
Convertible subordinated debentures 
Subordinated notes 
Credit note payable 
Preferred stock (liquidation preference) 
Total shareholders’ equity 
Selected Income Statement Data: 

Interest income 
Interest expense 
Net interest income 
Provision for loan losses 
Net interest income after provision for loan losses 
Trust and investment management fees 
Net mortgage gain 
Net realized gain on sale of securities 
Other 
Non-interest income 
Non-interest expense 
Income before income tax 
Income tax expense 
Net income 
Preferred dividends paid to preferred shareholders 
Net income (loss) available to common shareholders 

Per Share Data: 

Earnings (loss) per share, basic 
Earnings (loss) per share, diluted 
Book value per share(2) 
Preferred dividends per share 
Weighted average outstanding shares, basic 
Weighted average outstanding shares, diluted 
Common shares outstanding, end of period 
Convertible preferred shares outstanding, end of period 
Preferred shares outstanding, end of period 

Summary Performance Ratios: 
Return on average assets 
Return on average equity 
Net interest margin 
Efficiency ratio(3) 
Loans to deposits ratio 
Net interest rate spread 
Non-interest income to average assets 
Non-interest expense to average assets 
Non-interest income to total income before non‑ interest expense 

Summary Credit Quality Ratios: 

Nonperforming loans to total loans 
Nonperforming assets to total assets 
Allowance for loan losses to nonperforming loans 
Allowance for loan losses to total loans 
Net charge-offs to average loans outstanding 

Other Selected Ratios and Data: 

Total noninterest‑ bearing deposits to total deposits 
Interest bearing deposits to total deposits 
Cost of funds 
Loan yield 
Total assets under management 
Total assets under management yield 

Summary Capital Ratios: 

Average equity to average assets ratio 

Non‑ GAAP Ratios: 

Tangible common equity(4) 
Tangible common equity ratio(5) 
Tangible book value per common share(6) 
Return on tangible common equity(7) 

Consolidated: 

Tier 1 capital ratio 
CET 1 capital ratio 
Total risk based capital ratio 
Leverage ratio 

Bank: 

Tier 1 capital ratio 
CET 1 capital ratio 
Total risk based capital ratio 
Leverage ratio 

2020 

$ 

 155,989   
 36,666   
 161,843   
    1,532,833   
 12,539   
 —   
 24,191   
 67   
 15,449   
 194   
    1,973,655   
 481,457   
    1,138,453   
 149,563   
 —   
 24,291   
 —   
 —   
 154,962   

 53,334   
 7,232   
 46,102   
 4,682   
 41,420   
 19,022   
 29,276   
 —   
 2,882   
 51,180   
 59,537   
 33,063   
 8,529   
 24,534   
 —   
 24,534   

As of and for the Years Ended December 31, 
2018 

2017 

2019 

$ 

$ 

 78,638   
 58,903   
 48,312   
 998,007   
 7,875   
 —   
 19,686   
 28   
 15,086   
 658   
    1,251,682   
 240,068   
 846,716   
 10,000   
 —   
 6,560   
 —   
 —   
 127,678   

$ 

 73,357   
 43,695   
 14,832   
 893,966   
 7,451   
 —   
 24,811   
 402   
 14,709   
 658   
    1,084,324   
 202,856   
 734,902   
 15,000   
 —   
 6,560   
 —   
 —   
 116,875   

 45,051   
 12,990   
 32,061   
 662   
 31,399   
 18,935   
 10,585   
 119   
 2,755   
 32,577   
 53,784   
 10,192   
 2,183   
 8,009   
 —   
 8,009   

 38,796   
 8,172   
 30,624   
 180   
 30,444   
 19,165   
 4,560   
 —   
 3,448   
 27,173   
 50,195   
 7,422   
 1,775   
 5,647   
 1,378   
 4,269   

 9,502   
 53,650   
 22,940   
 813,689   
 7,287   
 5,792   
 24,811   
 1,233   
 14,316   
 658   
 969,659   
 198,685   
 617,432   
 28,563   
 —   
 13,435   
 —   
 24,968   
 101,846   

 33,337   
 5,761   
 27,576   
 788   
 26,788   
 19,455   
 3,469   
 81   
 4,708   
 27,713   
 49,494   
 5,007   
 2,984   
 2,023   
 2,291   
 (268)  

$ 

2016 

 62,685   
 97,655   
 8,053   
 672,815   
 6,478   
 10,384   
 24,811   
 1,452   
 13,898   
 2,836   
 915,998   
 195,460   
 558,440   
 37,000   
 4,749   
 13,150   
 2,736   
 25,468   
 95,928   

 29,520   
 5,063   
 24,457   
 985   
 23,472   
 20,167   
 6,702   
 114   
 2,939   
 29,922   
 49,823   
 3,571   
 1,269   
 2,302   
 2,840   
 (538)  

 3.11   
 3.08   
 19.49   
$ 
 —   
    7,899,278   
    7,961,904   
    7,951,773   
 —   
 —   

 1.02   
 1.01   
 16.08   
$ 
 —   
    7,890,266   
    7,914,961   
    7,940,168   
 —   
 —   

 0.64   
 0.63   
 14.67   
$ 
 22.27   
    6,712,754   
    6,754,258   
    7,968,420   
 —   
 —   

 (0.05)  
 (0.05)  
 13.18   
$ 
 37.03   
    5,586,620   
    5,586,620   
    5,833,456   
 41,000   
 20,868   

 (0.11)  
 (0.11)  
 12.74   
$ 
 42.47   
    5,120,507   
    5,120,507   
    5,529,542   
 46,000   
 20,868   

 1.48  %     
 17.29   
 3.09   
 60.50   
 94.62   
 2.92   
 3.08   
 3.59   
 55.27   

 0.26   
 0.22   
 308.99   
 0.82   
 —   

 0.68  %     
 6.51   
 2.99   
 80.57   
 91.83   
 2.62   
 2.76   
 4.55   
 50.92   

 1.23   
 1.03   
 64.18   
 0.79   
 0.03   

 0.55  %     
 5.18   
 3.27   
 85.41   
 95.33   
 2.97   
 2.66   
 4.92   
 47.16   

 2.13   
 1.82   
 39.11   
 0.83   
 —   

 0.21  %     
 2.02   
 3.15   
 88.23   
 99.70   
 2.91   
 2.90   
 5.18   
 50.85   

 0.26  %   
 2.55   
 3.06   
 90.44   
 89.24   
 2.89   
 3.34   
 5.57   
 56.04   

 0.52   
 0.50   
 172.55   
 0.90   
 —   

 0.54   
 0.70   
 179.60   
 0.96   
 0.07   

 29.72   
 70.28   
 0.48   
 3.94  %     

 22.09   
 77.91   
 1.25   
 4.49  %     

 21.63   
 78.37   
 0.90   
 4.36  %     

 24.35   
 75.65   
 0.67   
 4.11  %     

 25.93   
 74.07   
 0.63   
 4.10  %   

$   6,255,336   

$   6,187,707   

$   5,235,177   

$   5,374,471   

$   4,925,939   

 0.30  %     

 0.31  %     

 0.37  %     

 0.36  %     

 0.41  %   

 8.55  %     

 10.41  %     

 10.68  %     

 10.47  %     

 10.10  %   

$ 

$ 

 130,704   

$ 
 6.70  %     
 16.44   
$ 
 18.77  %     

 104,411   

$ 
 8.50  %     
 13.15   
$ 
 7.67  %     

 91,662   

$ 
 8.65  %     
 11.50   
$ 
 4.66  %     

 50,834   

$ 
 5.39  %     
 8.71   
$ 
 (0.53) %     

 44,197   

 4.97  %   
 7.99   
 (1.22) %   

 9.96   
 9.96   
 12.80   
 7.45   

 11.31   
 11.31   
 12.87   
 8.58   

 11.35   
 11.35   
 13.06   
 9.28   

 10.22   
 10.22   
 11.20   
 7.62  %     

 10.67   
 10.67   
 11.53   
 8.09  %     

 10.55   
 10.55   
 11.47   
 8.63  %     

 8.79   
 6.56   
 11.70   
 7.41   

 9.81   
 9.81   
 10.75   

 8.27  %     

 8.43   
 6.28   
 12.07   
 7.00   

 9.20   
 9.20   
 10.16   
 7.63  %   

(1) 

Total  loans  net  of  loan  fees,  costs,  premiums,  and  discounts  do  not  include  mortgage  loans  held  for  sale  of  $161.8  million,  $48.3 million, 
$14.8 million, $22.9 million, and $8.1 million as of December 31, 2020, 2019, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. 

58 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
       
    
 
    
 
          
          
    
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
 
  
 
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
 
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
(2)  We calculate book value per share as total shareholders’ equity less preferred stock (liquidation preference), at the end of the relevant period divided 

by the outstanding number of shares of our common stock at the end of the relevant period. 

(3) 

(4) 

(5) 

(6) 

Efficiency ratio is a non-GAAP financial measure. Efficiency ratio is non-interest expense, less intangible amortization, loss on intangible assets 
held for sale, provision for other real estate owned ("OREO") and goodwill impairment, divided by net interest income (which is pre-provision), 
plus non-interest income after adjustments for gains on the sale of securities and assets. See our reconciliation of non-GAAP financial measures to 
their most directly comparable GAAP financial measures under the caption "GAAP Reconciliation and Management Explanation of Non-GAAP 
Financial Measures." 

Tangible common equity is a non-GAAP financial measure. We calculate tangible common equity as total shareholders’ equity, less preferred 
stock (liquidation preference), goodwill, intangibles held for sale and other intangible assets, net of accumulated amortization. See our reconciliation 
of  non-GAAP  financial  measures  to  their  most  directly  comparable  GAAP  financial  measures  under  the  caption  "GAAP  Reconciliation  and 
Management Explanation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures." 

Tangible common equity ratio is a non-GAAP financial measure. We calculate the tangible common equity ratio as tangible common equity divided 
by  total  assets  less  goodwill  and  other  intangible  assets,  net.  See  our  reconciliation  of  non-GAAP  financial  measures  to  their  most  directly 
comparable GAAP financial measures under the caption "GAAP Reconciliation and Management Explanation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures." 

Tangible book value per common share is a non-GAAP financial measure. We calculate tangible book value per common share as tangible common 
equity divided by common shares outstanding. See our reconciliation of non-GAAP financial measures to their most directly comparable GAAP 
financial measures under the caption "GAAP Reconciliation and Management Explanation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures." 

(7)  Return on tangible common equity is a non-GAAP financial measure. We calculate return on tangible common equity as net income (loss) available 
to common shareholders (net income (loss) less dividends paid on preferred stock) divided by tangible common equity. See our reconciliation of 
non-GAAP  financial  measures  to  their  most  directly  comparable  GAAP  financial  measures  under  the  caption  "GAAP  Reconciliation  and 
Management Explanation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures." 

GAAP Reconciliation and Management Explanation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures 

Our accounting and reporting policies conform to GAAP and the prevailing practices in the banking industry. 
However, we also evaluate our performance based on certain additional financial measures discussed in this Form 10-K 
as being non-GAAP financial measures. We classify a financial measure as being a non-GAAP financial measure if that 
financial measure excludes or includes amounts, or is subject to adjustments that have the effect of excluding or including 
amounts, that are not included or excluded, as the case may be, in the most directly comparable measure calculated and 
presented  in  accordance  with  GAAP  as  in  effect  from  time  to  time  in  the  United  States  in  our  Statements  of  Income, 
Balance Sheets or Statements of Cash Flows. Non-GAAP financial measures do not include operating and other statistical 
measures or ratios or statistical measures calculated using exclusively financial measures calculated in accordance with 
GAAP. 

The non-GAAP financial measures that we discuss in this Form 10-K should not be considered in isolation or as 
a substitute for the most directly comparable or other financial measures calculated in accordance with GAAP. Moreover, 
the manner in which we calculate the non-GAAP financial measures that we discuss in this Form 10-K may differ from 
that  of  other  companies,  reporting  measures  with  similar  names.  It  is  important  to  understand  how  other  banking 
organizations  calculate  their  financial  measures  with  names  similar  to  the  non-GAAP  financial  measures  we  have 
discussed in this Form 10-K when comparing such non-GAAP financial measures. 

Efficiency Ratio. We calculate our efficiency ratio as non-interest expense, less intangible amortization, loss on 
intangible assets held for sale, provision for OREO and goodwill impairment, plus gain on sale of LA fixed income team, 
divided by net interest income (which is pre-provision), plus non-interest income after adjustments for gains on the sale of 
securities and assets.  

59 

The  following  table  reconciles,  as  of  the  dates  set  forth  below,  non-interest  expense  to  adjusted  non-interest 
expense, and net interest income and non-interest income to adjusted non-interest income and adjusted total income, and 
presents the calculation of our efficiency ratios: 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Non‑ interest expense 
Less: 

Amortization 
Goodwill impairment 
Provision on other real estate owned 
Loss on assets held for sale 

Plus: Gain on sale of LA fixed income team 
Adjusted non‑ interest expense 

Net interest income 
Non‑ interest income 
Less: 

Net gain on sale of securities 
Net gain on sale of assets 
Adjusted non‑ interest income 
Adjusted total income 
Efficiency ratio 

For the Year Ended December 31, 

2020 
 $  59,537  

2019 
$  53,784  

2018 
$  50,195  

2017 
$  49,494  

2016 
$  49,823  

 14  
 —  
 176  
 553  
 (62)  
 $  58,856  

 374  
 1,572  
 —  
 —  
 —  
$  51,838  

 831  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
$  49,364  

 784  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
$  48,710  

 747  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
$  49,076  

 $  46,102  
    51,180  

$  32,061  
   32,577  

$  30,624  
   27,173  

$  27,576  
   27,713  

$  24,457  
   29,922  

 —  
 —  
 $  51,180  
 $  97,282  
     60.50 %     

 119  
 183  
$  32,275  
$  64,336  

 —  
 —  
$  27,173  
$  57,797  

 81  
 —  
$  27,632  
$  55,208  

 114  
 —  
$  29,808  
$  54,265  

 80.57 %     

 85.41 %     

 88.23 %     

 90.44 %   

Tangible Common Equity and Tangible Common Equity Ratio. We calculate tangible common equity as total 
shareholders’ equity, less preferred stock (liquidation preference), goodwill and other intangible assets, net of accumulated 
amortization. We calculate tangible assets as total assets less goodwill and other intangible assets,  net of accumulated 
amortization. We calculate the tangible common equity ratio as tangible common equity divided by tangible assets. The 
most directly comparable GAAP financial measure for tangible common equity is total shareholders’ equity and the most 
directly comparable GAAP financial measure for tangible assets is total assets. 

We  believe  the  use  of  tangible  common  book  value  has  less  relevance  for  high-fee  banks  and  investment 
management firms than for most banks, as a large portion of our goodwill is associated with highly desirable fee business. 
We recognize  that the  tangible common book value per common share  measure is important to  many investors in the 
marketplace who are interested in changes from period to period in book value per share exclusive of changes in intangible 
assets. Goodwill and other intangible assets have the effect of increasing total book value while not increasing our tangible 
book value. 

60 

 
 
    
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
             
     
 
     
     
 
 
   
 
   
  
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
   
   
  
  
  
  
 
   
  
 
 
 
 
 
   
  
 
 
 
 
 
   
  
 
 
 
 
 
   
  
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
  
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
   
 
   
 
   
    
    
    
    
    
 
 
   
  
 
 
 
 
 
   
  
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
The following table reconciles and presents, as of the dates set forth below, total shareholders’ equity to tangible 

common equity, total assets to tangible assets and presents the calculation of the tangible common equity ratio: 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Total shareholders’ equity 
Less: 

Preferred stock 
Goodwill and other intangibles, net 
Intangibles held for sale(1) 

Tangible common equity 
Total assets 
Less: 

2020 
  $   154,962  

2019 
$   127,678  

2018 
$   116,875  

2017 
$  101,846  

2016 
$   95,928  

As of December 31, 

 —  
 24,258  
 —  
  $   130,704  
  $  1,973,655  

 —  
 19,714  
 3,553  
$   104,411  
$  1,251,682  

 —  
 25,213  
 —  
 91,662  
$ 
$  1,084,324  

 24,968  
 26,044  
 —  
$   50,834  
$  969,659  

    25,468  
    26,263  
 —  
$   44,197  
$  915,998  

Goodwill and other intangibles, net 
Intangibles held for sale(1) 

Tangible assets 
Tangible common equity ratio 

 24,258  
 —  
  $  1,949,397  

 19,714  
 3,553  
$  1,228,415  

 25,213  
 —  
$  1,059,111  

 26,044  
 —  
$  943,615  

    26,263  
 —  
$  889,735  

 6.70 %     

 8.50 %     

 8.65 %     

 5.39 %     

 4.97 %   

(1)  Represents only the intangible portion of Assets held for sale. 

Tangible  Book  Value  per  Common  Share.  We  calculate  tangible  book  value  per  common  share  as  tangible 

common equity divided by common shares outstanding as detailed in the table below: 

(Dollars in thousands, except share and per share data) 
Total shareholders’ equity 
Less: 

Preferred stock 
Goodwill and other intangibles, net 
Intangibles held for sale(1) 

Tangible common equity 

Common shares outstanding, end of period 

Tangible common book value per share 

2020 

2019 

As of December 31, 
2018 

2017 

  $   154,962   $   127,678   $   116,875   $   101,846   $ 

2016 
 95,928 

 —    
 24,258    
 —    

 —    
 19,714     
 3,553    

 25,468 
 26,263 
 — 
 44,197 
   7,951,773      7,940,168      7,968,420      5,833,456      5,529,542 
 7.99 

 —    
 25,213     
 —    

 24,968    
 26,044     
 —    

  $   130,704   $   104,411   $ 

 91,662   $ 

 50,834   $ 

 13.15   $ 

 16.44   $ 

 11.50   $ 

 8.71   $ 

  $ 

(1)  Represents only the intangible portion of Assets held for sale. 

Return  on  Tangible  Common  Equity.  We  calculate  return  on  tangible  common  equity  as  net  income  (loss) 
available to common shareholders (net income (loss) less dividends paid on preferred stock) divided by tangible common 
equity. The most directly comparable GAAP financial measure for tangible common equity is total shareholders’ equity. 

The following table reconciles net income to income (loss) available to common shareholders and presents the 

calculation of return on tangible common equity: 

2020 
(Dollars in thousands) 
  $   24,534  
Net income, as reported 
Less: preferred stock dividends 
 —  
Net income (loss) available to common shareholders   $   24,534  
  $  130,704  
Tangible common equity 
Return (loss) on tangible common equity 

As of and for the Year Ended December 31, 

$ 

2019 
 8,009  
 —  
$ 
 8,009  
$  104,411  

2018 
$   5,647  
 1,378  
$   4,269  
$  91,662  

2017 
$   2,023  
 2,291  
$ 
 (268)  
$  50,834  

2016 
$   2,302  
 2,840  
$ 
 (538)  
$  44,197  

 18.77 %     

 7.67 %     

 4.66 %     

 (0.53) %     

 (1.22) %   

Pre-tax, Pre-Provision Income. Pre-tax, pre-provision income is income before income tax with provision for 
loan  loss  added  back.  The  most  directly  comparable  GAAP  financial  measure  is  net  income.  We  believe  pre-tax, 
pre-provision  income  provides  the  readers  of  the  financial  statements  information  on  our  performance  trends  absent 
fluctuations in credit trends and loan balance changes which both drive provision, and elimination of taxes which provides 
readers more insight into our performance without consideration of changes in statutory tax rates. 

61 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
 
     
     
 
 
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    
    
    
    
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
 
     
     
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
The following table reconciles, as of the dates set forth below, net income to pre-tax, pre-provision income: 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Net income, as reported 

Plus: income tax expense 
Plus: provision for loan losses 

Pre‑ tax, pre‑ provision income 

2020 

For the Year Ended December 31, 
2018 

      2017 

2019 

      2016 

  $  24,534   $   8,009   $  5,647   $  2,023   $  2,302 
   1,269 
 985 
  $  37,745   $  10,854   $  7,602   $  5,795   $  4,556 

 2,183      1,775  
 180  

 8,529  
    4,682  

   2,984  
 788  

 662     

Gross Revenue. Gross revenue is our total income before non-interest expense, less net gains on sale of securities, 
less net gains on sale of assets, plus provision for loan losses. The most directly comparable GAAP financial measure is 
total  income  before  non-interest  expense.  We  believe  gross  revenue  provides  the  readers  of  the  financial  statements 
information on our performance trends absent fluctuations in liquidity and credit trends. 

The following table reconciles, as of the dates set forth below, total income before non-interest expense to gross 

revenue: 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Total income before non-interest expense 
Less: net gain on sale of securities 
Less: net gain on sale of assets 
Plus: provision for loan losses 

Gross revenue 

2020 

For the Year Ended of December 31, 
2017 
2018 
2019 

2016 

  $   92,600   $   63,976   $   57,617   $   54,501   $   53,394 
 114 
 — 
 985 
  $   97,282   $   64,336   $   57,797   $   55,208   $   54,265 

 —  
 —  
 4,682  

 81  
 —  
 788  

 —  
 —  
 180  

 119  
 183  
 662  

62 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
 
     
     
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS 
OF OPERATIONS 

The  following  discussion  and  analysis  of  our  financial  condition  and  results  of  operations  should  be  read  in 
conjunction with our audited consolidated financial statements and the accompanying notes included elsewhere in this 
Annual  Report  on  Form  10-K.  The  following  discussion  contains  "forward-looking  statements"  that  reflect  our  future 
plans, estimates, beliefs and expected performance. We caution that assumptions, expectations, projections, intentions or 
beliefs about future events may, and often do, vary from actual results and the differences can be material. See "Cautionary 
Statement Regarding Forward-Looking Statements." Also, see the risk factors and other cautionary statements described 
under the heading "Item 1A – Risk Factors" included in Item 1A of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. We do not undertake 
any obligation to publicly update any forward-looking statements except as otherwise required by applicable law. 

Company Overview 

We are a financial holding company founded in 2002 and headquartered in Denver, Colorado. We provide a fully 
integrated  suite  of  wealth  management  services  to  our  clients  including  banking,  trust  and  investment  management 
products and services. Our mission is to be the best private bank for the Western wealth management client. We target 
entrepreneurs, professionals and high-net worth individuals, typically with $1.0 million-plus in liquid net worth, and their 
related philanthropic and business organizations, which we refer to as the "Western wealth management client." We believe 
that  the  Western  wealth  management  client  shares  our  entrepreneurial  spirit  and  values  our  sophisticated,  high-touch 
wealth management services that are tailored to meet their specific needs. We partner with our clients to solve their unique 
financial needs through our expert integrated services provided in a team approach.  

We offer our services through a branded network of boutique private trust bank offices, which we believe are 
strategically located in affluent and high-growth markets in locations across Colorado, Arizona, Wyoming and California. 
Our profit centers, which are comprised of private bankers, lenders, wealth planners and portfolio managers, under the 
leadership of a local chairman and/or president, are also supported centrally by teams providing management services such 
technology  support,  human  capital  and 
as  operations,  risk  management,  credit  administration,  marketing, 
accounting/finance services, which we refer to as support centers.  

From 2004, when we opened our first profit center, until  December 31, 2020, we have expanded our footprint 
into  eleven  full  service  profit  centers,  two  loan  production  offices,  and  two  trust  offices  located  across  four  states. 
Following the completion of the branch purchase and assumption agreement ("Branch Acquisition") in the second quarter 
2020, we added one full service profit center in Lone Tree, Colorado. During the third quarter of 2020, we closed two 
branch locations which were acquired in the Branch Acquisition during the second quarter of 2020. As of and for the year 
ended December 31, 2020, we had $1.97 billion in total assets, $92.6 million in total revenues and provided fiduciary and 
advisory services on $6.26 billion of assets under management ("AUM").  

Response to COVID-19 

The spread of COVID-19 has caused significant disruptions in the U.S. economy since it was declared a pandemic 
in March 2020 by the World Health Organization. Disruptions include temporary closures of many businesses that have 
led to a loss of revenues and a rapid increase in unemployment,  disrupted global supply chains, market downturns and 
volatility,  changes  in  consumer  behavior  related  to  pandemic  fears,  related  emergency  response  legislation  and  an 
expectation  that  Federal  Reserve  policy  will  maintain  a  low  interest  rate  environment  for  the  foreseeable  future.  The 
changes have impacted our clients and their industries, as well as the financial services industry. At this time, we cannot 
predict the impact or how long the economy or our impacted clients will be disrupted. 

The Company activated its Business Continuity Plan in early March in response to the emergence of COVID-19 
and has continued to adjust as the crisis continues to impact our markets, clients and business. Since March, a majority of 
our  associates  have  been  working  remotely.  All  of  our  offices  are  open,  functioning,  and  continue  to  operate  in  an 
appointment  only  model  for  client  service  to  limit  the  risk  of  potential  exposure  to  COVID-19  for  our  associates  and 
clients.  We  are  taking  additional  precautions  within  our  profit  centers,  including  enhanced  cleaning  procedures  and 
physical distancing measures, to ensure the safety of our clients and our associates. 

63 

A provision in the Coronavirus Aid, Relief and Economic Security Act ("CARES Act") created the Paycheck 
Protection Program ("PPP"), which is administered by the Small Business Administration ("SBA"). The PPP is intended 
to provide loans to small businesses to pay their employees, rent, mortgage interest and utilities. The loans may be forgiven 
conditioned  upon  the  client  providing  payroll  documentation  evidencing  their  compliant  use  of  funds  and  otherwise 
complying with the terms of the program. The Bank is an approved SBA lender and began accepting applications for the 
program on April 3, 2020. As of December 31, 2020, we held 423 PPP loans for a total of $142.9 million with an average 
loan size of $0.3 million. As of February 28, 2021, the Company had submitted 509 loans with original loan amounts of 
$142.0 million to the SBA for forgiveness and had received forgiveness on 456 loans totaling $78.5 million all related to 
the first round of the PPP. 

On January 11, 2021 the SBA reopened the PPP, to First Draw PPP Loans and began accepting applications for 
Second Draw PPP Loans on January 13, 2021. The Bank began accepting applications for the reopened program on January 
19, 2021. As of February 28, 2021, we had received 660 applications for the newest round of PPP loans from borrowers 
for $91.4 million with an average loan size of $0.1 million; of the applications received, 410 applications for $68.7 million 
have been approved and funded by the SBA under the reopened program. 

As a result of the COVID-19 pandemic, a loan modification program was designed and implemented to assist our 
clients experiencing financial stress resulting from the economic impacts caused by the global pandemic. The Company 
has  offered  loan  extensions,  temporary  payment  moratoriums,  and  financial  covenant  waivers  for  commercial  and 
consumer borrowers impacted by the pandemic who have a pass risk rating and have not been delinquent over 30 days on 
payments in the last two years. The Company had eighty-nine loans across multiple industries in the amount of $160.8 
million of loans that took part in the Company’s COVID loan modification program. No loans in the loan modification 
program were delinquent according to Bank policy as of December 31, 2020. Two loans, in the aggregate amount of $2.1 
million,  were  still  in  the  modification  period  as  of  December  31,  2020.  The  CARES  Act  provides  banks  optional, 
temporary  relief  from  accounting  for  certain  loan  modifications  as  a  troubled  debt  restructuring  ("TDR").  The 
modifications must be related to the adverse effects of COVID-19, and certain other criteria are required to be met in order 
to apply the relief. Interagency guidance from the Federal Reserve and the FDIC confirmed with the FASB that short-term 
modifications made on a good faith basis in response to COVID-19 to borrowers who were current prior to any relief, are 
not to be considered TDRs. We believe our loan modification program satisfies the applicable requirements. 

The Company will continue to closely monitor the performance of COVID-19 impacted clients. Additionally, the 
Company will continue to review and revise its provision for loan losses as more information becomes available including 
the resolution of certain uncertainties some of our impacted clients face related to the government mandated shutdowns 
and shelter-in-place orders and the resulting financial stress. The extent to which the COVID-19 pandemic and government 
actions taken in response to the pandemic will impact our operations and financial results is highly uncertain. 

The Company is also lending under the Federal Reserve’s Main Street Lending Program ("MSLP") to support 
lending to small and medium-sized for profit businesses and nonprofit organizations that were in sound financial condition 
before the onset of the COVID-19 pandemic. As of December 31, 2020, the Company had six loans with a balance held 
by the Bank of $6.6  million.  These loans represent 4.5% of the  Commercial and Industrial line. Further details of the 
MSLP are provided in Note 5 – Loans and the Allowance for Loan Losses of the accompanying Notes to the Consolidated 
Financial Statements.  

Primary Factors Used to Evaluate the Results of Operations 

As  a  financial  institution,  we  manage  and  evaluate  various  aspects  of  both  our  results  of  operations  and  our 
financial condition. We evaluate the comparative levels and trends of the line items in our Consolidated Balance Sheets 
and Statements of Income as well as various financial ratios that are commonly used in our industry. The primary factors 
we use to evaluate our results of operations include net interest income, non-interest income and non-interest expense.  

Net Interest Income 

Net  interest income represents interest income less interest expense. We generate  interest income on interest-
earning assets, primarily loans and available-for-sale securities. We incur interest expense on interest-bearing liabilities, 
primarily interest-bearing deposits and borrowings. To evaluate net interest income, we measure and monitor: (i) yields 
on loans, available-for-sale securities and other interest-earning assets; (ii) the costs of deposits and other funding sources; 

64 

(iii) the rates incurred on borrowings and other interest-bearing liabilities; and (iv) the regulatory risk weighting associated 
with the assets. Interest income is primarily impacted by loan growth and loan repayments, along with changes in interest 
rates  on  the  loans.  Interest  expense  is  primarily  impacted  by  changes  in  deposit  balances,  changes  in  interest  rates  on 
deposits,  along  with  the  volume  and  type  of  interest-bearing  liabilities.  Net  interest  income  is  primarily  impacted  by 
changes in market interest rates, the slope of the yield curve, and interest we earn on interest-earning assets or pay on 
interest-bearing liabilities. 

Non-Interest Income 

Non-interest income primarily consists of the following: 

  Trust and investment management fees—fees and other sources of income charged to clients for managing 
their  trust  and  investment  assets,  providing  financial  planning  consulting  services,  401(k)  and  retirement 
advisory consulting services, and other wealth management services. Trust and investment management fees 
are primarily impacted by rates charged and increases and decreases in AUM. AUM is primarily impacted 
by  opening  and  closing  of  client  advisory  and  trust  accounts,  contributions  and  withdrawals,  and  the 
fluctuation in market values. 

  Net  gain  on  mortgage  loans—gain  on  originating  and  selling  mortgages,  origination  fees,  and  borrower 
credits,  less  commissions  to  loan  originators,  lender  credits,  document  review  and  other  costs  specific  to 
originating and selling the loan. The market adjustments for interest rate lock commitments ("IRLC") and 
gains and losses incurred on the mandatory trading of loans are also included in this line item. Net gain on 
mortgage  loans  is  primarily  impacted  by  the  amount  of  loans  sold,  the  type  of  loans  sold  and  market 
conditions. 

  Bank fees—income generated through bank-related service charges such as: electronic transfer fees, treasury 
management fees, bill pay fees,  servicing fees for Main Street Lending Program, and other banking fees. 
Banking fees are primarily impacted by the level of business activities and cash movement activities of our 
clients. 

  Risk management and insurance fees—commissions earned on insurance policies we have placed for clients 
through our client risk  management team  who incorporate insurance services,  primarily  life insurance, to 
support our clients’ wealth planning needs. Our insurance revenues are primarily impacted by the type and 
volume of policies placed for our clients. 

 

Income on company-owned life insurance—income earned on the growth of the cash surrender value of life 
insurance policies we hold on certain key associates. The income on the increase in the cash surrender value 
is non-taxable income. 

  Net gain on sale of securities/assets—gain on sale of available-for-sale securities and other assets sold. Net 
gain on sale of securities/assets are primarily impacted by the amount of securities/assets sold, the type of 
securities/assets sold and market conditions. 

Non-Interest Expense 

Non-interest expense is comprised primarily of the following: 

 

Salaries  and  employee  benefits—all  forms  of  compensation-related  expenses  including  salary,  incentive 
compensation, payroll-related taxes, stock-based compensation, benefit plans, health insurance, 401(k) plan 
match costs and other benefit-related expenses. Salaries and employee benefit costs are primarily impacted 
by changes in headcount and fluctuations in benefits costs. 

  Occupancy and equipment—costs related to leasing our office space, depreciation charges for the furniture, 
fixtures  and  equipment,  amortization  of  leasehold  improvements,  utilities  and  other  occupancy-related 
expenses. Occupancy and equipment costs are primarily impacted by the number of locations we occupy. 

65 

  Professional services—costs related to legal, accounting, tax, consulting, personnel recruiting, insurance and 
other outsourcing arrangements. Professional services costs are primarily impacted by corporate activities 
requiring  specialized  services.  FDIC  insurance  expense  is  also  included  in  this  line  and  represents  the 
assessments that we pay to the FDIC for deposit insurance.  

  Technology  and  information  systems—costs  related  to  software  and  information  technology  services  to 
support  office  activities  and  internal  networks.  Technology  and  information  system  costs  are  primarily 
impacted by the number of locations we occupy, the number of associates we have and the level of service 
we require from our third-party technology vendors. 

  Data processing—costs related to processing fees paid to our third-party data processing system providers 
relating  to  our  core  private  trust  banking  platform.  Data  processing  costs  are  primarily  impacted  by  the 
number of loan, deposit and trust accounts we have and the level of transactions processed for our clients. 

  Marketing—costs  related  to  promoting  our  business  through  advertising,  promotions,  charitable  events, 
sponsorships, donations and other marketing-related expenses. Marketing costs are primarily impacted by 
the levels of advertising programs and other marketing activities and events held throughout the year. 

  Amortization of other intangible assets—primarily represents the amortization of intangible assets, including 

client lists and other similar items recognized in connection with acquisitions. 

  Goodwill  impairment—represents  the  $1.6  million  goodwill  impairment  charge  in  2019  related  to  the 

Company’s Los Angeles-based fixed income portfolio management team. 

  Net loss on assets held for sale—represents the fair value adjustment on disposal groups held for sale. 

  Provision  for  other  real  estate  owned—represents  the  fair  value  adjustment  for  other  real  estate  owned 

("OREO").  

  Other—includes  costs  related  to  operational  expenses  associated  with  office  supplies,  postage,  travel 
expenses,  meals  and  entertainment,  dues  and  memberships,  costs  to  maintain  or  prepare  OREO  for  sale, 
director  compensation  and  travel,  and  other  general  corporate  expenses  that  do  not  fit  within  one  of  the 
specific non-interest expense lines described above. Other operational expenses are generally impacted by 
our business activities and needs. 

Operating Segments 

We measure the overall profitability of operating segments based on income before income tax. We believe this 
is a more useful measurement as our wealth management products and services are fully integrated with our private trust 
bank.  We  allocate  costs  to  our  segments,  which  consist  primarily  of  compensation  and  overhead  expense  directly 
attributable  to  the  products  and  services  within  the  Wealth  Management  and  Mortgage  segments.  We  measure  the 
profitability of each segment based on a post-allocation basis, as we believe it better approximates the operating cash flows 
generated by our reportable operating segments. A description of each segment is provided in Note 19 - Segment Reporting 
of the accompanying Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements. 

During the year ended December 31, 2020, we evaluated our reportable segments following the sale of our Los 
Angeles-based fixed income portfolio management team and certain related advisory and sub-advisory arrangements ("LA 
fixed income team"). We determined that the income before income tax related to the Capital Management segment was 
no longer significant and management will no longer be evaluating Capital Management separately for internal reporting. 
As such, Capital Management is no longer a reporting unit and the Company has discontinued reporting of the Capital 
Management segment on a standalone basis. The residual assets that remained in the Capital Management segment are 
now  included  in  the  Wealth  Management  segment.  All  reported  periods  are  presented  under  the  Wealth  Management 
segment as of December 31, 2020.  

66 

Primary Factors Used to Evaluate our Balance Sheet 

The primary factors we use to evaluate our balance sheet include asset and liability levels, asset quality, capital, 

liquidity, and potential profit production from assets. 

We manage our asset levels to ensure our lending initiatives are efficiently and profitably supported and to ensure 
we have the necessary liquidity and capital to meet the required regulatory capital ratios. Funding needs are evaluated and 
forecasted  by  communicating  with  clients,  reviewing  loan  maturity  and  draw  expectations,  and  projecting  new  loan 
opportunities. 

We manage the diversification and quality of our assets based upon factors that include the level, distribution, 
severity and trend of problem assets such as those determined to be classified, delinquent, non-accrual, non-performing or 
restructured;  the  adequacy  of  our  allowance  for  loan  losses;  the  diversification  and  quality  of  loan  and  investment 
portfolios; the extent of counterparty risks, credit risk concentrations, and other factors. 

We manage our liquidity based upon factors that include the level and quality of capital and our overall financial 
condition, the trend and volume of problem assets, our balance sheet risk exposure, the level of deposits as a percentage 
of  total  loans,  the  amount  of  non-deposit  funding  used  to  fund  assets,  the  availability  of  unused  funding  sources  and 
off-balance sheet obligations, the availability of assets to be readily converted into cash without undue loss, the amount of 
cash and liquid securities we hold, and other factors. 

Financial institution regulators have established guidelines for minimum capital ratios for banks and bank holding 
companies. The Company has adopted the Basel III regulatory capital framework. As of December 31, 2020, the Bank’s 
capital ratios exceeded the current well capitalized regulatory requirements established under Basel III.  

Branch Acquisition 

On February 10, 2020, the Company entered into a branch purchase and assumption agreement with Simmons 
Bank, pursuant to which the Company agreed to acquire all of Simmons’ Colorado locations, including three branches and 
one loan production office located in metro Denver, as well as certain deposits and loans and other assets. On May 15, 
2020,  the  Branch  Acquisition  was  successfully  completed.  See  Note  2  -  Acquisitions  of  the  accompanying  Notes  to 
Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information. 

Recent Events 

On September 18, 2020, the Company entered into an agreement to sell its LA fixed income team and certain 
related advisory and sub-advisory arrangements to Lido Advisors, LLC and Oakhurst Advisors, LLC. On November 13, 
2020, the Company completed the sale. On an ongoing basis, the  sale  of the  LA  fixed income team is expected to be 
earnings  neutral  to  the  Company,  as  the  revenue  decrease  will  be  approximately  in-line  with  the  expected  expense 
reduction. The sale is not expected to have an impact on Bank clients but reduced the Company’s assets under management 
by $330.6 million. As a result of the sale, the Company evaluated its reportable segments and determined the remaining 
assets following the sale in the Capital Management segment no longer meet the thresholds of income before income tax 
to be a reportable segment. The residual assets that remained in the Capital Management segment are now included in the 
Wealth Management segment. 

Results of Operations 

Overview 

The  year  ended  December 31, 2020  compared  with  the  year  ended  December 31, 2019.  For  the  year  ended 
December 31, 2020, we reported net income available to common shareholders of $24.5 million, compared to net income 
available to common shareholders for December 31, 2019 of $8.0 million, a $16.5 million, or 206.3% increase. For the 
year ended December 31, 2020, our income before income tax was $33.1 million, a $22.9 million, or 224.4%, increase 
from December 31, 2019. For the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the year ended December 31, 2019, income 
before  income  tax increased primarily as a result of a  $14.0 million, or  43.8%, increase in net interest income and an 
increase of $18.6 million, or 57.1%, in non-interest income. The increase in non-interest income was primarily the result 

67 

of a $691.4 million increase in mortgage loans funded, which resulted in a $18.7 million increase in net gain on mortgage 
loans during the year ended December 31, 2020 compared to December 31, 2019. The increase in income before income 
taxes was partially offset by an increase of $5.8 million, or 10.7%, in non-interest expense, which was primarily due to an 
increase in expenses related to salaries and employee benefits and professional services.  

Net Interest Income 

The  year  ended  December 31, 2020  compared  with  the  year  ended  December 31, 2019.  For  the  year  ended 
December 31, 2020, compared to the year ended December 31, 2019, net interest income, before the provision for loan 
losses, increased $14.0 million, or 43.8%, to $46.1 million. This increase was partially attributable to a $381.8 million 
increase in average outstanding loan balances compared to December 31, 2019, and a 94 bps decrease in the average rate 
on  interest  bearing  deposits,  partially  offset  by  a  decrease  in  our  average  yield  on  loans  to  3.94%  for  the  year  ended 
December 31, 2020 from 4.49% for the year ended December 31, 2019. For the year ended December 31, 2020, our net 
interest margin was 3.09% and our net interest spread was 2.92%. For the year ended December 31, 2019, our net interest 
margin was 2.99% and our net interest spread was 2.62%. 

The increase in average loans outstanding for the year ended December 31, 2020 compared to the same periods 
in 2019 was primarily due to diversified growth across all loan categories. Net interest income is also impacted by changes 
in  the  amount  and  type  of  interest-earning  assets  and  interest-bearing  liabilities.  To  evaluate  net  interest  income,  we 
measure  and  monitor  the  yields  on  our  loans  and  other  interest-earning  assets  and  the  costs  of  our  deposits  and  other 
funding sources. 

Interest income on our available-for-sale securities portfolio decreased as a result of lower average investment 
balances and lower average yields on the portfolio for the year ended December 31, 2020 compared to the same period in 
2019. Our average available-for-sale securities balance during the year ended December 31, 2020 was $45.5 million, a 
decrease of $7.6 million from the year ended December 31, 2019. For the year ended December 31, 2020, our average 
yield on the available-for-sale securities portfolio decreased to 1.93%, from 2.40% the prior year. 

Interest expense on deposits decreased during the year ended December 31, 2020 compared to the same period 
in  2019.  Average  rates  on  interest  bearing  deposits  decreased  94  basis  points,  consistent  with  the  lower  interest  rate 
environment.  The  reduction  in  cost  of  deposits  was  partially  offset  by  an  increase  in  average  interest-bearing  deposit 
accounts of $177.1 million compared to the prior year. 

68 

The following tables present an analysis of net interest income and net interest margin for the periods presented, 
using daily average balances for each major category of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities, the interest 
earned or paid and the average rate earned or paid on those assets or liabilities. 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Assets 

Interest-earning assets: 

Interest-bearing deposits in other financial institutions 
Available-for-sale securities(2) 
Loans(3) 
Interest-earning assets 
Mortgage loans held for sale(4) 

Total interest-earning assets, plus mortgage loans held for 
sale 

Allowance for loan losses 
Noninterest-earning assets 

Total assets 

Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity 

Interest-bearing liabilities: 
Interest-bearing deposits 
FHLB and Federal Reserve borrowings 
Subordinated notes 

Total interest-bearing liabilities 

Noninterest-bearing liabilities: 
Noninterest-bearing deposits 
Other liabilities 

Total noninterest-bearing liabilities 

Shareholders’ equity 

Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity 

Net interest rate spread(5) 
Net interest income(6) 
Net interest margin(7) 

As of and For the Year Ended December 31,  

2020 
Interest 
Earned / 
Paid 

      Average 
Yield / 
Rate 

Average 
Balance (1) 

2019 
Interest 
Earned / 
Paid 

      Average 
Yield / 
Rate 

$ 

 458   
 878   
 51,998   
 53,334   
 2,388   

$ 

 0.35 %  $ 
 1.93  
 3.94  
 3.57  
 2.97  

 80,985  
 53,063  
 936,821  
 1,070,869  
 39,436  

 1,732   
 1,274   
 42,045   
 45,051   
 1,415   

 2.14 % 
 2.40  
 4.49  
 4.21  
 3.59  

$ 

 55,722   

 3.54 %  $ 

$ 

 1,110,305  
 (7,639)  
 79,700  
 1,182,366  

$ 

 46,466   

 4.18 % 

Average 
Balance(1) 

 129,670  
 45,466  
 1,318,648  
 1,493,784  
 80,469  

 1,574,253  
 (9,945)  
 94,935  
 1,659,243  

 976,108  
 122,773  
 13,812  
 1,112,693  

$ 

$ 

 5,794   
 584   
 854   
 7,232   

 0.59 %  $ 
 0.48  
 6.18  
 0.65 %  $ 

 798,986  
 12,217  
 6,560  
 817,763  

$ 

$ 

 12,263   
 250   
 477   
 12,990   

 1.53 % 
 2.05  
 7.27  
 1.59 % 

 383,271  
 21,402  
 404,673  
 141,877  
 1,659,243  

$ 

 46,102   

 222,058  
 19,511  
 241,569  
 123,034  
 1,182,366  

$ 

$ 
 2.92 %    

 3.09 %    

$ 

 32,061   

 2.62 % 

 2.99 % 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

(1)  Average balance represents daily averages, unless otherwise noted. 
(2)  Available-for-sale securities represents monthly averages. 
(3)  Non-performing loans are included in the respective average loan balances. Income, if any, on such loans is recognized on a cash basis. 
(4) 
(5)  Mortgage loans held for sale are separated from the interest-earning assets above, as these loans are held for a short period of time until sold in the 
secondary market and are not held for investment purposes, with interest income recognized in the net gain on mortgage loans line of the income 
statement. These balances are excluded from the margin calculations in these tables. 

Tax-equivalent yield adjustments are immaterial. 

(6)  Net interest spread is the average yield on interest-earning assets (excluding mortgage loans held for sale) minus the average rate on interest-bearing 

liabilities. 

(7)  Net interest income is the difference between income earned on interest-earning assets, which does not include interest earned on mortgage loans 

held for sale, and expense paid on interest-bearing liabilities. 

(8)  Net interest margin is equal to net interest income divided by average interest-earning assets (excluding mortgage loans held for sale). 

69 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
       
 
     
     
 
 
     
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
     
 
     
     
 
     
 
     
    
  
 
     
 
     
   
 
     
 
     
    
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
     
  
  
  
     
  
 
  
  
     
  
  
  
     
  
 
  
     
  
  
     
  
 
  
    
  
     
  
  
    
  
     
  
 
  
    
  
     
  
  
    
  
     
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
    
  
     
  
  
    
  
     
  
 
  
  
     
  
  
  
     
  
 
  
  
     
  
  
  
     
  
 
  
     
  
  
     
  
 
  
  
     
  
  
  
     
  
 
  
     
  
  
     
  
 
  
    
  
     
    
  
     
 
  
  
  
  
    
  
 
  
    
  
     
    
  
     
 
The following tables present the dollar amount of changes in interest income and interest expense for the periods 
presented, for each component of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities (excluding mortgage loans held for 
sale) and distinguishes between changes attributable to volume and interest rates. Changes attributable to both rate and 
volume that cannot be separated have been allocated to volume. 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Interest-earning assets: 

Interest-bearing deposits in other financial institutions 
Available for sale securities 
Loans 

Total increase (decrease) in interest income 
Interest-bearing liabilities: 

Interest-bearing deposits 
FHLB and Federal Reserve borrowings 
Subordinated notes 

Total increase (decrease) in interest expense 
Increase in net interest income 

Non-Interest Income 

Year Ended December 31, 2020 
Compared to 2019 

Increase 
(Decrease) Due 
to Change in: 

   Volume 

Rate 

Total 
Increase 
      (Decrease) 

  $ 

  $ 

 172   $ 
 (147)  
 15,056  
 15,081   $ 

 (1,446)   $   (1,274) 
 (396) 
 9,953 
 8,283 

 (249)  
 (5,103)  
 (6,798)   $ 

 1,051  
 526  
 448  
 2,025   $ 
 13,056   $ 

 (7,520)  
 (192)  
 (71)  

 (6,469) 
 334 
 377 
 (7,783)   $   (5,758) 
 985   $   14,041 

  $ 
  $ 

The  year  ended  December 31, 2020  compared  with  the  year  ended  December 31, 2019.  For  the  year  ended 
December 31, 2020  compared  to  the  year  ended  December 31, 2019,  non-interest  income  increased  $18.6  million,  or 
57.1%,  to  $51.2  million.  The  increase  in  non-interest  income  was  attributable  to  higher  net  gain  on  mortgage  loans, 
primarily related to a $691.4 million increase in mortgage loans funded from the prior year. 

The  table  below  presents  the  significant  categories  of  our  non-interest  income  for  the  year  ended 

December 31, 2020 and 2019. 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Non-interest income: 

Trust and investment management fees 
Net gain on mortgage loans 
Bank fees 
Risk management and insurance fees 
Income on company-owned life insurance 
Net gain on sale of securities 
Net gain on sale of assets 

Total non-interest income 
________________ 
* 

Not meaningful 

Year Ended  
December 31,  

Change 

2020 

2019 

$ 

      % 

  $  19,022   $  18,935   $ 

 87  
   18,691  
 147  
 (6)  
 (14)  
 (119)  
 (183)  
  $  51,180   $  32,577   $  18,603  

   10,585  
 1,173  
 1,205  
 377  
 119  
 183  

   29,276  
 1,320  
 1,199  
 363  
 —  
 —  

 0.5 % 

 176.6  
 12.5  
 (0.5)  
 (3.7)  
*  
*  
 57.1 % 

Trust and investment management fees— For the year ended December 31, 2020 compared to the same period in 

2019, our trust and investment management fees remained relatively unchanged. 

Net  gain  on  mortgage  loans—  For  the  year  ended  December 31, 2020  compared  to  the  year  ended 
December 31, 2019, our net gain on mortgage loans increased by $18.7 million, or 176.6%, to $29.3 million. For the year 
ended  December 31, 2020  and  2019,  our  origination  volume  of  mortgage  loans  was  $1.33  billion  and  $640.6  million, 
respectively. The net gain on sale of loans will fluctuate with the amount and type of loans sold and market conditions. 
The increase in gain on mortgage loans for the year ended December 31, 2020 compared to 2019 was primarily related to 
the increase in origination volume in 2020 compared to 2019. The increase in origination volume in 2020 was primarily 

70 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
     
   
     
 
     
 
   
    
  
  
    
  
  
    
    
  
    
  
   
    
  
  
    
  
  
    
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
     
     
     
 
    
       
    
     
 
 
    
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
related to lower market rates driving an increase in refinance activity, a strong residential real estate market in our footprint, 
and management’s commitment and ability to capitalize on the mortgage environment. 

Bank fees— For the year ended December 31, 2020 compared to the same period in 2019, our bank fees increased 

by $0.1 million or 12.5% mostly related to additional fees on MSLP loans. 

Risk  management  and  insurance  fees—  Risk  management  fees  include  fees  earned  by  our  risk  management 
product group as a result of assisting clients with obtaining life insurance policies and fees from the trailing annuity revenue 
streams. For the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019,  the Company recognized $1.2 million of risk management 
fees. 

Net  gain  on  sale  of  securities/assets—  For  the  year  ended  December 31, 2020,  the  Company  did  not  sell 
securities/assets. For the year ended December 31, 2019, the Company recognized a net gain on sale of securities of $0.1 
million and a net gain on sale of assets of $0.2 million related to the sale of our third party administrator services. 

Provision for Loan Losses 

We have a dedicated problem loan resolution team comprised of associates from our credit, senior leadership, 
risk  and  accounting  teams  that  meets  frequently  to  ensure  that  watch  list  and  problem  credits  are  identified  early  and 
actively managed. We work to identify potential losses in a timely manner and proactively manage the problem credits to 
minimize losses. For the year ended December 31, 2020, we recorded $4.7 million of provision for loan losses, primarily 
resulting from an increase based on the additional variability surrounding the loan modifications made during the second 
quarter  along  with  increased  economic  uncertainty  related  to  the  impact  of  the  COVID-19  pandemic  and  overall  loan 
growth. 

The Company has increased loan level reviews and portfolio monitoring to address the changing environment. 
We identified clients who could be more highly impacted by the recent COVID-19 pandemic and economic disruption 
and are meeting regularly with them. The analysis reviewed the borrowers in industries we believe may be more impacted 
including those the lenders believed would have one or more of the following characteristics: greater than 50% probability 
of a downgrade, a covenant violation or 20% reduction in collateral position. The Company receives and reviews current 
financial data and cash flow forecasts from borrowers with loan modification agreements. 

Management believes the financial strength of the Bank’s clientele and the diversity of the portfolio continues to 

mitigate the credit risk within the portfolio. Only two loans remained on modified terms at December 31, 2020. 

Non-Interest Expense 

The  year  ended  December 31, 2020  compared  with  the  year  ended  December 31, 2019.  The  increase  in  non-
interest expense of 10.7% to $59.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2020, was primarily due to higher salaries and 
employee benefits expense, higher professional services expense, offset partially by a reduction in goodwill impairment 
charges.  

71 

The table below presents the significant categories of our non-interest expense for the periods noted: 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Non-interest expense: 

Salaries and employee benefits 
Occupancy and equipment 
Professional services 
Technology and information systems 
Data processing 
Marketing 
Amortization of other intangible assets 
Goodwill impairment 
Net loss on assets held for sale 
Provision on other real estate owned 
Other  

Total non-interest expense 

* 

Not meaningful 

Year Ended  
December 31,  

2020 

2019 

Change 

$ 

      % 

  $  34,785   $  31,810   $   2,975  
 447  
 1,516  
 62  
 935  
 186  
 (360)  
    (1,572)  
 553  
 176  
 835  
  $  59,537   $  53,784   $   5,753  

 5,562  
 3,519  
 3,973  
 3,065  
 1,292  
 374  
 1,572  
 —  
 —  
 2,617  

 6,009  
 5,035  
 4,035  
 4,000  
 1,478  
 14  
 —  
 553  
 176  
 3,452  

 9.4 % 
 8.0  
 43.1  
 1.6  
 30.5  
 14.4  
 (96.3)  
*  
*  
*  
 31.9  
 10.7 % 

Salaries and employee benefits—The increase in salaries and employee benefits of $3.0 million, or 9.4%, was 
primarily related to added personnel from the Branch Acquisition and to support the growth in our Mortgage segment, and 
an  increase  in  incentive  compensation  accruals  driven  by  the  strong  financial  performance  of  the  Company.    These 
increases were partially offset by $2.9 million in deferred compensation  in the form of loan origination costs related to 
PPP loan originations during 2020. 

Occupancy and equipment—The increase in occupancy and equipment of $0.4 million, or 8.0%, was primarily 
driven by the addition of one full service profit center and the closing of two branch locations which were acquired in the 
Branch Acquisition. 

Professional Services—The increase in professional services of $1.5 million, or 43.1%, was primarily driven by 
additional  FDIC  insurance  expense  related  to  our  balance  sheet  growth,  transaction  expenses  related  to  the  Branch 
Acquisition, and an FDIC assessment credit offsetting expense in the year ended December 31, 2019. 

Data processing—The increase in data processing costs of $0.9 million, or 30.5%, was primarily driven by an 
increase in core systems cost as a result of an increase in accounts and transactions related to the Branch Acquisition and 
growth in our Mortgage segment. 

Marketing—The increase was driven by higher corporate advertising and agency related expenses, offset partially 

by lower client meal and entertainment related expenses. 

Amortization of other intangible assets—The decrease in amortization of other intangible assets of $0.4 million, 

or 96.3%, was primarily due to certain intangibles becoming fully amortized during the year ended December 31, 2019. 

Goodwill  impairment—The  decrease  was  due  to  a  goodwill  impairment  charge  of  $1.6  million  related  to  the 
Capital Management segment during the second quarter of 2019. No goodwill impairment charges were recorded in 2020. 
See Note 7 – Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets. 

Net loss on assets held for sale—This amount represents the fair value adjustment on disposal groups held for 
sale. In the first quarter of 2020, we recorded an impairment loss on intangibles held for sale of $0.6 million related to the 
Capital Management segment. 

Provision  on  other  real  estate  owned—This  amount  represents  the  fair  value  adjustment  for  other  real  estate 
owned. During the year ended December 31, 2020, we incurred $0.2 million in losses as a result of sales contracts in place 
which were lower than the carrying value. 

72 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
     
     
     
 
    
       
    
      
 
    
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
Other—The increase in other non-interest expense was driven by product related expenses, increased expense 
due to the growth in our balance sheet, and a $0.2 million SEC penalty in the previously reported Capital Management 
segment. 

Income Tax 

During  the  year  ended  December 31, 2020,  the  Company  recorded  an  income  tax  provision  of  $8.5  million, 
reflecting an effective tax rate 25.8%. During the year ended December 31, 2019, the Company recorded an income tax 
provision of $2.2 million, reflecting an effective tax rate of 21.4%. The increase in the effective tax rate was primarily 
attributable to a $0.4 million valuation allowance recorded following the sale of the LA fixed income team as a result of 
the Company’s ability to utilize the full California NOL. 

Segment Reporting 

We  have  two  reportable  operating  segments:  Wealth  Management  and  Mortgage.  Our  Wealth  Management 
segment  consists  of  operations  relating  to  the  Company’s  fully  integrated  wealth  management  products  and  services. 
Services provided include deposit, loan, insurance, and trust and investment management advisory products and services. 
Our Mortgage segment consists of operations relating to the Company’s residential mortgage service offerings. Mortgage 
products and services are financial in nature for which premiums are recognized, net of expenses, upon the sale of mortgage 
loans to third parties. Services provided by our Mortgage segment include soliciting, originating and selling  mortgage 
loans into the secondary market. Mortgage loans originated and held for investment purposes are recorded in the Wealth 
Management segment, as this segment provides ongoing services to our clients. 

The Company completed the sale of its LA fixed income team in the fourth quarter 2020. The LA fixed income 
team and the related assets made up a majority of the previously reported Capital Management Segment. As a result of the 
sale,  the  Company  evaluated  its  reportable  segments  and  determined  the  remaining  assets  in  the  Capital  Management 
segment no longer met the thresholds to be a reportable segment.  

For all periods presented, the Wealth Management segment includes the key metrics of the previously reported 

Capital Management segment. 

The following table presents key metrics related to our segments: 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Income(2) 
Income before taxes 
Profit margin 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Income(2) 
Income before taxes 

Profit margin 

Year Ended December 31, 2020 

Wealth 
Management(1) 

Mortgage 

Consolidated 

 63,256  
 12,086  

$ 
$ 

 19.1 %   

 29,344  
 20,977  

$ 
$ 

 71.5 %   

 92,600  
 33,063  

 35.7 % 

Year Ended December 31, 2019 

Wealth 
Management(1) 

Mortgage 

Consolidated 

 53,301  
 6,152  

$ 
$ 

 11.5 %   

 10,675  
 4,040  

$ 
$ 

 37.8 %   

 63,976  
 10,192  

 15.9 % 

$ 
$ 

$ 
$ 

Includes financial information previously reported under the Capital Management segment. 

(1) 
(2)  Net interest income after provision plus non-interest income. 

73 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
     
 
 
     
 
 
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
 
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
The tables below present selected financial metrics of each segment as of and for the periods presented: 

Wealth Management 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Total interest income 
Total interest expense 
Provision for loan losses 

Net interest income, after provision for loan losses 

Non-interest income 
Total income 

Depreciation and amortization expense 
All other non-interest expense 
Income before income tax 

Goodwill 
Assets held for sale 
Total assets 
________________________________________ 
* 
(1) 
(2) 
(3) 

Not meaningful 

As of and For the Year Ended 
December 31,  

  $ 

  $ 
  $ 

2020(1) 
 53,334   $ 
 7,232  
 4,682  
 41,420  
 21,836  
 63,256  
 1,035  
 50,135 (2)   
 12,086   $ 
 24,191   $ 
 —  

2019(1) 
 45,051   $ 
 12,990  
 662  
 31,399  
 21,902  
 53,301  
 1,453  
 45,696 (3)   
 6,152   $ 
 19,686   $ 
 3,553  

  $  1,798,416   $  1,204,620   $ 

      $ Change 

      % Change 

 8,283   
 (5,758)   
 4,020   
 10,021   
 (66)   
 9,955   
 (418)   
 4,439   
 5,934   
 4,505   
 (3,553)   
 593,796   

 18.4 % 
 (44.3)  
 607.3  
 31.9  
 (0.3)  
 18.7  
 (28.8)  
 9.7  
 96.5 % 
 22.9 % 
*  
 49.3 % 

Periods include financial information previously reported under the Capital Management segment. 
Includes loss on assets held for sale of $0.6 million and $0.2 million SEC penalty in the previously reported Capital Management segment. 
Includes goodwill impairment charge of $1.6 million in the previously reported Capital Management segment. 

The  Wealth  Management  segment  reported  income  before  income  tax  of  $12.1  million  for  the  year  ended 
December 31, 2020, compared to $6.2 million, for the same period in 2019. The increase is primarily driven by an increase 
in average outstanding loan balances and a decrease in cost of funds, offset partially by increasing provision for loan losses 
and non-interest expense. During the year ended December 31, 2020, average loans increased $381.8 million and the cost 
of funds decreased to 0.48% from 1.25% compared to the year ended December 31, 2019. 

Mortgage 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Total interest income 
Total interest expense 
Provision for loan losses 

Net interest income, after provision for loan losses 

Non-interest income 
Total income 

Depreciation and amortization expense 
All other non-interest expense 
Income before income tax 

Total assets 

As of and For the Year Ended 
December 31,  

2020 

2019 

      $ Change 

      % Change 

  $ 

  $ 
  $ 

 —   $ 
 —  
 —  
 —  
 29,344  
 29,344  
 70  
 8,297  
 20,977   $ 
 175,239   $ 

 —   $ 
 —  
 —  
 —  
 10,675  
 10,675  
 218  
 6,417  
 4,040   $ 
 47,062   $ 

 —   
 —   
 —   
 —   
 18,669   
 18,669   
 (148)   
 1,880   
 16,937   
 128,177   

 — % 
 —  
 —  
 —  
 174.9  
 174.9  
 (67.9)  
 29.3  
 419.2 % 
 272.4 % 

The  Mortgage  segment  reported  income  before  income  tax  of  $21.0  million  for  the  year  ended 
December 31, 2020, compared to $4.0 million for the same period in 2019. The overall increase in non-interest income 
was primarily related to lower market rates driving an increase in refinance activity, a strong residential real estate market 
in our footprint and management’s commitment and ability to capitalize on the mortgage environment. During the years 
ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, our origination volume was $1.33 billion and $640.6 million, respectively. During 
the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company originated $875.8 million in refinance loans compared to $292.7 million 
the prior year. 

74 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
     
     
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
     
     
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
Financial Condition 

The table below presents our condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets as of the dates presented: 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Balance Sheet Data: 

Cash and cash equivalents 
Investments 
Gross loans 

Allowance for loan losses 

Loans, net of allowance 
Mortgage loans held for sale 
Goodwill & other intangible assets, net 
Company-owned life insurance 
Other assets 
Assets held for sale 

Total assets 
Deposits 
Borrowings 
Other liabilities 
Liabilities held for sale 
Total liabilities 
Total shareholders’ equity 
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity 

* 

Not meaningful 

December 31,  

2020 

2019 

      $ Change 

     % Change   

  $ 

 155,989 
 36,666 
    1,532,833 
 (12,539) 
    1,520,294 
 161,843 
 24,258 
 15,449 
 59,156 
 — 
  $   1,973,655 
  $   1,619,910 
 173,854 
 24,929 
 — 
    1,818,693 
 154,962 
  $   1,973,655 

 $ 

 78,638   $ 
 58,903  
 998,007  
 (7,875)  
 990,132  
 48,312  
 19,714  
 15,086  
 37,344  
 3,553  

 $   1,251,682   $ 
 $   1,086,784   $ 
 16,560  
 20,543  
 117  
     1,124,004  
 127,678  
 $   1,251,682   $ 

 77,351   
 (22,237)   
 534,826   
 (4,664)   
 530,162   
 113,531   
 4,544   
 363   
 21,812   
 (3,553)   
 721,973   
 533,126   
 157,294   
 4,386   
 (117)   
 694,689   
 27,284   
 721,973   

 98.4 % 
 (37.8)  
 53.6  
 59.2  
 53.5  
 235.0  
 23.0  
 2.4  
 58.4  
*  
 57.7 % 
 49.1 % 

 949.8  
 21.4  
*  
 61.8  
 21.4  
 57.7 % 

Cash  and  cash  equivalents  increased  by  $77.4  million,  or  98.4%,  to $156.0  million  as  of  December 31, 2020 
compared to December 31, 2019. The increase in liquidity was driven by organic growth in deposits related to new client 
relationships, increases in existing client accounts, and corporate initiatives to support current and future balance sheet 
growth. During the same period, investments decreased by $22.2 million due to accelerated prepayments on mortgage 
backed securities, or 37.8%, to $36.7 million as of December 31, 2020. The Company elected not to reinvest cash flows 
into the investment portfolio and instead increased cash balances to support loan growth due to low yield environment in 
the securities market. 

Loans  increased  by  $534.8  million,  or  53.6%,  to  $1.53  billion  as  of  December 31, 2020  compared  to 
December 31, 2019. The  increase  was  driven  by  three  primary  factors:  organic  growth,  PPP  loan  originations  and  the 
Branch Acquisition. We experienced growth in our all major loan categories with the largest growth coming in the Cash, 
Securities and Other category that includes $142.9 million in PPP loans. 

Mortgage loans held for sale increased $113.5 million, or 235.0%, to $161.8 million as of December 31, 2020 
compared to December 31, 2019. This increase corresponds to the increase in mortgage origination volume as noted in the 
Mortgage segment activity.  

Goodwill  and  other  intangible  assets,  net  increased  by  $4.5  million  as  of  December 31, 2020  compared  to 
December 31, 2019. The increase was driven by the recording of $4.5 million in goodwill and $0.1 million of core deposit 
intangibles related to the Branch Acquisition. 

Other  assets  increased  by  $21.8  million,  or  58.4%,  to  $59.2  million  as  of  December 31, 2020  compared  to 
December 31, 2019. This was primarily related to a $8.7 million increase in balances related to unfunded mortgage IRLC, 
a $3.6 million increase in accrued interest receivable as a result of payment moratoriums related to loan modifications and 
PPP loans and a $3.1 million contingent consideration asset recorded as a result of the sale of the LA fixed income team. 

Total  deposits  increased  $533.1  million,  or  49.1%,  to  $1.62  billion  as  of  December 31, 2020  compared  to 
December 31, 2019. The increase in total deposits from December 31, 2019 was attributable to organic growth and the 
Branch Acquisition. We experienced growth in all our major deposit categories with the largest increases coming from 
non-interest bearing accounts and money market deposit accounts. 

75 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
     
 
    
    
 
       
     
    
 
  
   
  
 
   
  
 
  
   
  
 
   
  
 
  
   
  
 
  
   
  
 
  
   
  
 
  
   
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
   
  
 
  
   
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
  
   
  
 
 
 
Money market deposit accounts increased $231.9 million, or 37.7%, to $847.4 million as of December 31, 2020 
compared  to  December 31, 2019.  Time  deposit  accounts  increased  $37.8  million,  or  28.0%,  to  $172.7  million  as  of 
December  31,  2020.  Negotiable  order  of  withdrawal  ("NOW")  accounts  increased  $21.1  million,  or  23.0%,  to $113.1 
million compared to December 31, 2019. This increase in money market deposit and NOW accounts was primarily due to 
continued organic growth in our market areas. 

Total borrowings increased $157.3 million, or 949.8%, to $173.9 million as of December 31, 2020 compared to 
December 31, 2019. The increase is primarily attributed to participation in the Paycheck Protection Program Loan Facility 
from the Federal Reserve in the amount of $134.6 million. Borrowing from this facility is expected to match fund the 
balances  of  PPP  loans.  During  the  year  ended  December  31,  2020,  the  Company  completed  the  issuance  and  sale  of 
subordinated notes in the aggregate principal amount of $18.0 million to support its capital objectives. 

Total shareholders’ equity increased $27.3 million, or 21.4%, to $155.0 million as of December 31, 2020. The 

increase is primarily due to an increase in net income. 

76 

Assets Under Management 

(Dollars in millions) 

Managed Trust Balance at Beginning of Period 

New relationships 
Closed relationships 
Contributions 
Withdrawals 
Market change, net 

Ending Balance 

Yield* 

Directed Trust Balance at Beginning of Period 

New relationships 
Closed relationships 
Contributions 
Withdrawals 
Market change, net 

Ending Balance 

Yield* 

Investment Agency Balance at Beginning of Period 

New relationships 
Closed relationships(2) 
Contributions 
Withdrawals 
Market change, net 

Ending Balance 

Yield* 

Custody Balance at Beginning of Period 

New relationships 
Closed relationships 
Contributions 
Withdrawals 
Market change, net 

Ending Balance 

Yield* 

401(k)/Retirement Balance at Beginning of Period 

New relationships 
Closed relationships 
Contributions 
Withdrawals 
Market change, net 

Ending Balance(1) 

Yield* 

Total Assets Under Management at Beginning of Period 

New relationships 
Closed relationships(2) 
Contributions 
Withdrawals 
Market change, net 

Total Assets Under Management 

Yield* 

Year Ended  
December 31,  

2020 

2019 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 1,750   
 17   
 (12)  
 98   
 (119)  
 156   
 1,890   
 0.17  % 

 989   
 18   
 (6)  
 42   
 (96)  
 4   
 951   
 0.08  % 

 2,009   
 179   
 (451)  
 268   
 (231)  
 66   
 1,840   

0.73  % 

 452   
 7   
 (4)  
 105   
 (82)  
 40   
 518   
0.03  % 

 988   
 23   
 (60)  
 133   
 (85)  
 57   
 1,056   

0.15  % 

 6,188   
 244   
 (533)  
 646   
 (613)  
 323   
 6,255   

0.30  % 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 1,380   
 49   
 (2)  
 38   
 (114)  
 399   
 1,750   
 0.17  % 

 789   
 139   
 —  
 32   
 (64)  
 93   
 989   
 0.07  % 

 1,846   
 109   
 (72)  
 145   
 (257)  
 238   
 2,009   
 0.66  % 

 356   
 11   
 (4)  
 84   
 (71)  
 76   
 452   
 0.03  % 

 864   
 7   
 (69)  
 84   
 (63)  
 165   
 988   
 0.20  % 

 5,235   
 315   
 (147)  
 383   
 (569)  
 971   
 6,188   
 0.31  % 

* 
(1) 
(2) 

Trust & investment management fees divided by period-end balance. 
AUM reported for the current period are one quarter in arrears. 
Sale of LA fixed income team resulted in closed accounts of $330.6 million. 

Assets  under  management  increased  $67.0  million,  or  1.1%,  to  $6.26  billion  for  the  year  ended 
December 31, 2020. Assets under management increased $953.0 million, or 18.2%, to $6.19 billion for the year December 
31,  2019. The  sale  of  the  LA  fixed  income  team  resulted  in  closed  accounts  of  $330.6 million  during  the  year  ended 
December 31, 2020.  Excluding the impact of the sale, the increase in 2020 is primarily attributable to net market gains. 

Available-for-sale securities 

Investments we intend to hold for an indefinite period of time, but not necessarily to maturity, are classified as 
available-for-sale and are recorded at fair value using current market information from a pricing service, with unrealized 

77 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
gains and losses excluded from earnings and reported in other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax. All our investments 
in securities were classified as available-for-sale for the periods presented below. The carrying values of our investment 
securities classified as available-for-sale are adjusted for unrealized gain or loss, and any gain or loss is reported on an 
after-tax basis as a component of other comprehensive income in shareholders’ equity.  

The following table summarizes the amortized cost and estimated fair value of our investment securities as of 

December 31, 2020: 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Investment securities available-for-sale: 

December 31, 2020 
      Gross 

      Gross 

  Amortized    Unrealized    Unrealized   

Cost 

  Gains 

  Losses 

Fair 
Value 

U.S. Treasury debt 
Corporate bonds 
Government National Mortgage Association ("GNMA") mortgage -
backed securities—residential 
Federal National Mortgage Association ("FNMA") mortgage-
backed securities—residential 
Corporate collateralized mortgage obligations ("CMO") and 
mortgage-backed securities ("MBS") 
Total securities available-for-sale 

  $ 

 250   $ 

 6,000  

 4   $ 
 55  

 —   $ 

 (11)  

 254 
 6,044 

    23,806  

 798  

 —  

    24,604 

 1,616  

 61  

 —  

 1,677 

 4,078  
  $  35,750   $ 

 62  
 980   $ 

 (53)  
 4,087 
 (64)   $  36,666 

The following table summarizes the amortized cost and estimated fair value of our investment securities as of 

December 31, 2019: 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Investment securities available-for-sale: 

U.S. Treasury debt 
GNMA mortgage -backed securities—residential 
FNMA mortgage-backed securities—residential 
Corporate CMO and MBS 

Total securities available-for-sale 

December 31, 2019 
      Gross 

      Gross 

  Amortized    Unrealized    Unrealized   

Cost 

  Gains 

  Losses 

Fair 
Value 

  $ 

 250   $ 

    45,490  
 2,935  
    10,425  
  $  59,100   $ 

 4   $ 

 157  
 11  
 40  
 212   $ 

 —   $ 

 254 
    45,312 
 (335)  
 2,917 
 (29)  
 (45)  
    10,420 
 (409)   $  58,903 

The following tables represent the book value of our contractual maturities and weighted average yield for our 
investment securities as of the dates presented. Contractual maturities may differ from expected maturities because issuers 
can have the right to call or prepay obligations without penalties. Our investments are taxable securities. Weighted average 
yields are not presented on a taxable equivalent basis. Securities not due at a single maturity date are included as after ten 
years. 

  One Year or Less 

One to Five Years 

Five to Ten Years 

After Ten Years 

Maturity as of December 31, 2020 

     Weighted   
  Amortized    Average   Amortized    Average   Amortized    Average   Amortized    Average    

     Weighted        

     Weighted        

     Weighted        

Cost 

  Yield 

Cost 

  Yield 

Cost 

  Yield 

Cost 

  Yield 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Available-for-sale: 
U.S. Treasury debt 
Corporate Bonds  
GNMA mortgage-backed securities - 
residential 
FNMA mortgage-backed securities - 
residential 
Corporate CMO and MBS 

Total available-for-sale 

  $ 

*                Not meaningful 

  $ 

 250    
 —  

 0.02  %   $ 
—    

 —   
 1,250   

—   %   $ 

 0.17   

 —   

—    

 —   

—    

 —  
 —   
 250    

—    
—    
 0.02  %   $ 

 —  
 —   
 1,250    

—    
—    
 0.17  %   $ 

78 

 —   
 —  

 —   

 —  
 43    
 43    

—   %   $ 
—    

 —   
 4,750   

—   % 

 0.60   

—    

 23,806    

 1.59   

 1,616   
—    
* 
 4,035    
—   %   $   34,207    

 0.10   
 0.31   
 2.60  % 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
       
 
       
 
 
 
 
    
       
       
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
       
 
       
 
 
 
 
    
       
       
       
   
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
       
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
    
     
     
 
     
     
 
     
     
 
     
    
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
 
  One Year or Less 

One to Five Years 

Five to Ten Years 

After Ten Years 

Maturity as of December 31, 2019 

     Weighted   
  Amortized    Average   Amortized    Average   Amortized    Average   Amortized    Average    

     Weighted        

     Weighted        

     Weighted        

(Dollars in thousands) 
Available-for-sale: 
U.S. Treasury debt 
GNMA mortgage-backed securities - 
residential 
FNMA mortgage-backed securities - 
residential 
Corporate CMO and MBS 

  $ 

Total available-for-sale 

  $ 

Cost 

  Yield 

Cost 

  Yield 

Cost 

  Yield 

Cost 

  Yield 

 —   

 —   

 —  
 —   
 —   

 — %   $ 

 250    

 0.01  %   $ 

 —  

 —   

 —  

 —  
 —  
 — %   $ 

 —  
 —   
 250    

 —  
 —  
 0.01  %   $ 

 —   

 —   

 —  
 52    
 52    

 — %   $ 

 —   

 — % 

 —  

 45,490    

 2.28   

 2,935   
 —  
 10,373    
 —  
 — %   $   58,798    

 0.14   
 0.66   
 3.08  % 

As of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, there were no holdings of securities of any one issuer, other 

than the U.S. Government and its agencies, in an amount greater than 10% of shareholders’ equity. 

Loan Portfolio 

Our primary source of interest income is derived through interest earned on loans to high net worth individuals 
and their related commercial interests. Our senior lending and credit team consists of seasoned, experienced personnel and 
we believe that our officers are well versed in the types of lending in which we are engaged. Underwriting policies and 
decisions  are  managed  centrally  and  the  approval  process  is  tiered  based  on  loan  size,  making  the  process  consistent, 
efficient and effective. The management team and credit culture demands prudent, practical, and conservative approaches 
to all credit requests in compliance with the loan policy guidelines to ensure strong credit underwriting practices. 

In  addition  to  originating  loans  for  our  own  portfolio,  we  conduct  mortgage  banking  activities  in  which  we 
originate and sell, servicing-released, whole loans in the secondary market. Our mortgage banking loan sales activities are 
primarily directed at originating single family mortgages that are priced and underwritten to conform to previously agreed-
upon  criteria  before  loan  funding  and  are  delivered  to  the  investor  shortly  after  funding.  The  level  of  future  loan 
originations,  loan  sales  and  loan  repayments  depends  on  overall  credit  availability,  the  interest  rate  environment,  the 
strength of the general economy, local real estate markets and the housing industry, and conditions in the secondary loan 
sale market. The amount of gain or loss on the sale of loans is primarily driven by market conditions and changes in interest 
rates, as well as our pricing and asset liability management strategies. As of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, 
we had mortgage loans held for sale of $161.8 million and $48.3 million, respectively, in residential mortgage loans we 
originated. 

Loan  balances  include  the  impacts  of  PPP  and  the  Branch  Acquisition.  See  Note  2  -  Acquisitions  of  the 

accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information. 

As  of  December 31, 2020,  the  Company  has  $142.9  million  in  PPP  loans  outstanding  with  $1.3  million  in 
remaining fees to be recognized. The remaining fees represent the net amount of the fees from the SBA for participation 
in the PPP less the loan origination costs on these loans. The current amortization of this income is being recognized over 
a two-year period, however if a loan receives full forgiveness from the SBA, the remaining income will be recognized 
upon receipt of the funds from the SBA. As of February 28, 2021, the Company had submitted to the SBA 509 loans for 
forgiveness with original loan amounts of $142.0 million and had received forgiveness and receipt of funds on 456 loans 
totaling $78.5 million all related to the first round of the PPP. For PPP balances not forgiven, the remaining net fee is 
extended and amortized over a 5 year payback period. 

79 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
       
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
    
     
     
 
     
     
 
     
     
 
     
    
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
The following table summarizes our loan portfolio by type of loan as of the dates indicated, in thousands: 

2020 

2019 

December 31,  
2018 

2017 

2016 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Cash, Securities and Other 
Construction and Development   
1-4 Family Residential 
Non-Owner Occupied CRE 
Owner Occupied CRE 
Commercial and Industrial 
Total loans held for 
investment(1) 
Mortgage loans held for sale 

      Amount 
  $   357,020   
 131,111   
 455,038   
 281,943   
 163,042   
 146,031   

  $  1,534,185   
  $   161,843   

% of 
Total       Amount       
 23.3  %   $  146,701   
    28,120   
 8.5   
   400,134   
 29.7   
   165,179   
 18.4   
   127,968   
 10.6   
   128,457   
 9.5   

% of 
Total       Amount       
 14.7  %   $  114,165   
    31,897   
 2.8   
   350,852   
 40.2   
   173,741   
 16.6   
   108,480   
 12.8   
   113,660   
 12.9   

% of 
Total       Amount       
 12.8  %   $  131,756   
    24,914   
 3.5   
   282,014   
 39.3   
   176,987   
 19.5   
    92,742   
 12.2   
   104,284   
 12.7   

% of 
Total       Amount       
 16.2  %   $  111,966   
    39,702   
 3.1   
   242,221   
 34.7   
   152,317   
 21.8   
    62,879   
 11.4   
    62,940   
 12.8   

% of 
Total      
 16.7  %   
 5.9   
 36.0   
 22.7   
 9.4   
 9.3   

 100.0  %   $  996,559   
$   48,312   

 100.0  %   $  892,795   
$   14,832   

 100.0  %   $  812,697   
$   22,940   

 100.0  %   $  672,025   
 8,053   
$ 

 100.0  %   

(1) 

Loans held for investment exclude deferred costs (fees) and unamortized premiums/ (unaccreted discounts), net of $(1.4) million, $1.4 million, 
$1.2 million, $1.0 million and $0.8 million as of December 31, 2020, 2019, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. 

  Cash, Securities and Other—consists of consumer and commercial purpose loans that are primarily secured 
by  securities  managed  and  under  custody  with  us,  cash  on  deposit  with  us  or  life  insurance  policies.  In 
addition, loans in this portfolio are collateralized with other sources of consumer collateral and an immaterial 
amount of each loan may be unsecured. This segment of our portfolio is affected by a variety of local and 
national economic factors affecting borrowers’ employment prospects, income levels, and overall economic 
sentiment. PPP loans that are fully guaranteed by the SBA are classified within this line item as of December 
31, 2020. 

  Construction  and  Development—consists  of  loans  to  finance  the  construction  of  residential  and  non-
residential properties. These loans are dependent on the strength of the industries of the related borrowers 
and the risks consistent with construction projects. 

 

1-4 Family Residential—consists of loans and home equity lines of credit secured by 1-4 family residential 
properties. These loans typically enable borrowers to purchase or refinance existing homes, most of which 
serve as the primary residence of the owner. In addition, some borrowers secure a commercial purpose loan 
with owner occupied or non-owner occupied 1-4 family residential properties.  Loans  in  this segment are 
dependent  on  the  industries  tied  to  these  loans  as  well  as  the  national  and  local  economies,  and  local 
residential and commercial real estate markets.   

  Commercial  Real  Estate,  Owner  Occupied  and  Non-Owner  Occupied—consists  of  commercial  loans 
collateralized by real estate. These loans may be collateralized by owner occupied or non-owner occupied 
real estate, as well as multi-family residential real estate. These loans are dependent on the strength of the 
industries of the related borrowers and the success of their businesses.  

  Commercial and Industrial—consists of commercial and industrial loans, including working capital lines of 
credit, permanent working capital term loans, business asset loans, acquisition, expansion and development 
loans, and other loan products, primarily in our target markets. This portfolio primarily consists of term loans 
and lines of credit which are dependent on the strength of the industries of the related borrowers and the 
success of their businesses. MSLP loans are included in this category as of December 31, 2020. 

80 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
    
    
    
    
    
 
The contractual maturity ranges of loans in our loan portfolio and the amount of such loans with fixed and floating 
interest rates in each maturity range, excluding deferred costs (fees), and unamortized premiums/ (unaccreted discounts), 
as of the date indicated are summarized in the following tables: 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Cash, Securities and Other 
Construction and Development 
1-4 Family Residential 
Non-Owner Occupied CRE 
Owner Occupied CRE 
Commercial and Industrial 

Total loans 

Amounts with fixed rates 
Amounts with floating rates 

Total loans 

(1)  

Includes PPP loans. 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Cash, Securities and Other 
Construction and Development 
1-4 Family Residential 
Non-Owner Occupied CRE 
Owner Occupied CRE 
Commercial and Industrial 

Total loans 

Amounts with fixed rates 
Amounts with floating rates 

Total loans 

Loan Modifications 

As of December 31, 2020 

      One Year       One Through       After 

or Less 

Five Years    Five Years   

Total 

  $   90,053   $  259,611 (1) $ 

 78,900  
 41,212  
 25,801  
 8,355  
 47,397  

 50,703  
 78,359  
    175,476  
 54,403  
 68,607  

 7,356   $   357,020 
 131,111 
 1,508  
 455,038 
   335,467  
 281,943 
 80,666  
 163,042 
   100,284  
 146,031 
 30,027  
  $  291,718   $  687,159   $  555,308   $  1,534,185 
  $   76,131   $  469,155   $  205,548   $   750,834 
 783,351 
  $  291,718   $  687,159   $  555,308   $  1,534,185 

    218,004  

   349,760  

   215,587  

      One Year       One Through       After 

As of December 31, 2019 

   Five Years     Five Years   

Total 

or Less 
  $   66,634   $ 

 9,126  
 32,300  
 13,286  
 9,540  
 37,341  

 68,326   $   11,741   $  146,701 
 28,120 
 2,041  
 16,953  
   400,134 
   270,948  
 96,886  
   165,179 
 38,436  
    113,457  
   127,968 
 85,567  
 32,861  
   128,457 
 13,094  
 78,022  
  $  168,227   $  406,505   $  421,827   $  996,559 
  $   58,289   $  251,378   $  128,452   $  438,119 
   558,440 
  $  168,227   $  406,505   $  421,827   $  996,559 

    155,127  

   109,938  

   293,375  

As a result of the COVID-19 pandemic, a loan modification program was designed and implemented to assist our 
clients experiencing financial stress resulting from the economic impacts caused by the global pandemic. The Company 
was  offering  loan  extensions,  temporary  payment  moratoriums,  and  financial  covenant  waivers  for  commercial  and 
consumer borrowers impacted by the pandemic who have a pass risk rating and have not been delinquent over 30 days on 
payments in the last two years.  

As of December 31, 2020, the Company’s loans include  two modified loans, including acquired loans, across 

multiple industries in the amount of $2.1 million, representing 0.13% of total loans. 

The following presents loans modifications as a result of COVID-19 as of December 31, 2020 (dollars in thousands): 

Cash, Securities and Other 
Construction and Development 
1-4 Family Residential 
Non-Owner Occupied CRE 
Owner Occupied CRE 
Commercial and Industrial 

Total Loans 

# of Loans 
Modified 

 —  
 —  
 1  
 —  
 1  
 —  
 2  

Outstanding 
Balance of 
Modified Loans  
 —  
$ 
 —  
 346  
 —  
 1,716  
 —  
 2,062  

$ 

% of Total 
Loan Balance 
Modified 

 — % 
 —  
 0.02  
 —  
 0.11  
 —  
 0.13 % 

Total Loans 

$ 

 357,020  
 131,111  
 455,038  
 281,943  
 163,042  
 146,031  
$   1,534,185  

81 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
      
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The CARES Act provides banks optional, temporary relief from accounting for certain loan modifications as a 
TDR. The modifications must be related to the adverse effects of COVID-19, and certain other criteria are required to be 
met in order to apply the relief. Interagency guidance from Federal Reserve and the FDIC confirmed with the FASB that 
short-term modifications made on a good faith basis in response to COVID-19 to borrowers who were current prior to any 
relief, are not to be considered TDRs. We believe our loan modification program meets that definition. In accordance with 
that guidance, the Company is recognizing interest income on all loans modified for temporary payment moratoriums, 
primarily for a period of 180 days or less. 

The Company had eighty-nine loans across multiple industries in the amount of $160.8 million of loans that took 
part in the Company’s COVID loan modification program. No loans in the loan modification program were delinquent 
according to Bank policy as of December 31, 2020. Two loans, in the aggregate amount of $2.1 million, were still in the 
modification period as of December 31, 2020. 

All loans modified in response to COVID-19 are classified as performing and pass rated as of December 31, 2020. 
These loans are included in the allowance for loan loss general reserve in accordance with ASC 450-20. Management has 
increased our loan level reviews and portfolio monitoring to address the changing environment. The Company continues 
to meet regularly with clients who could be more highly impacted by the recent COVID-19 pandemic. These are borrowers 
in industries we believe may be more impacted by the pandemic, for instance those loans where there may be a greater 
than 50% probability of a downgrade, covenant violation or 20% reduction in collateral position. Management believes 
the diversity of the loan portfolio is prudent and remains consistent with the credit culture and goals of the Bank. 

Interest accrued during the modification term on modified loans is deferred to the end of the loan term. As of 
December 31, 2020, no allowance for loan loss was deemed necessary on the accrued interest balances related to loan 
modifications. 

Non-Performing Assets 

Non-performing  assets  include  non-accrual  loans,  TDRs,  loans  past  due  90  days  or  more  and  still  accruing 
interest,  and  OREO.  The  accrual  of  interest  on  loans  is  discontinued  at  the  time  the  loan  becomes  90  or  more  days 
delinquent unless the loan is well secured and in the process of collection. Past due status is based on the contractual terms 
of  the  loan.  In  all  cases,  loans  are  placed  on  non-accrual  status  or  charged  off  if  collection  of  interest  or  principal  is 
considered doubtful. 

OREO represents assets acquired through, or in lieu of, foreclosure. The amounts reported as OREO are supported 
by  recent  appraisals,  with  the  appraised  values  adjusted,  where  applicable,  for  expected  transaction  fees  likely  to  be 
incurred upon sale  of the property. We incur recurring expenses relating  to OREO  in the form of  maintenance, taxes, 
insurance and legal fees, among others, until the OREO parcel is disposed. While disposition efforts with respect to our 
OREO are generally ongoing, if these properties are appraised at lower-than-expected values or if we are unable to sell the 
properties at the prices for which we expect to be able to sell them, we may incur additional losses. During the year ended 
December 31, 2020, we incurred $0.2 million in losses as a result of sales contracts in place which were lower than the 
carrying value. 

The  amount  of  lost  interest  for  non-accrual  loans  was  $0.2  million  and  $0.4  million  for  the  year  ended 

December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively. 

We  had  $4.3  million  in  non-performing  assets  as  of  December 31, 2020  compared  to  $12.9  million  as  of 
December 31, 2019. The $8.6 million decrease in our non-performing assets was primarily related to the payoff of a $5.1 
million Commercial and Industrial loan, a $0.8 million paydown on another Commercial and Industrial loan, and $2.8 
million paydown on a Cash, Securities, and Other loan during the year ended December 31, 2020. 

82 

 
The following table presents information regarding non-performing loans as of the dates indicated: 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Non-accrual loans by category (1) 
Cash, Securities and Other 
Construction and Development 
1-4 Family Residential 
Non-Owner Occupied CRE 
Owner Occupied CRE 
Commercial and Industrial 

Total non-accrual loans 
TDRs still accruing  
Accruing loans 90 or more days past due 
Total non-performing loans 

OREO 

Total non-performing assets 

Ratio of non-performing loans to total loans(2) 
Ratio of non-performing assets to total assets 
Allowance as a percentage of non-performing loans 

$ 

$ 

2020 

2019 

As of December 31,  
2018 

2017 

2016 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 50   
 —   
 —   
 —   
 479   
 3,529   
 4,058   
 —   
 —   
 4,058   
 194   
 4,252   

 2,803   
 —   
 —   
 —   
 —   
 4,412   
 7,215   
 5,055   
 —   
 12,270   
 658   
 12,928   

 11,252   
 —   
 —   
 —   
 —   
 1,735   
 12,987   
 4,848   
 1,217   
 19,052   
 658   
 19,710   

 —   
 —   
 1,171   
 —   
 —   
 1,835   
 3,006   
 —   
 1,217   
 4,223   
 658   
 4,881   

$ 
 0.26  %      
 0.22   
 308.99  %      

$ 
 1.23  %      
 1.03   

$ 
 2.13  %      
 1.82   

 64.18  %      

 39.11  %      

$ 
 0.52  %      
 0.50   
 172.55  %      

 —   
 —   
 —   
 —   
 —   
 3,607   
 3,607   
 —   
 —   
 3,607   
 2,836   
 6,443   

 0.54  %   
 0.70   
 179.60  %   

(1)  As of December 31, 2020, two non-accrual loans, totaling $0.5 million, were not also classified as a TDR. As of December 31, 2019, all non-
accrual loans were also classified as TDRs. See Note 5 – Loans and the Allowance for Loan Losses to the Consolidated Financial Statements. 
Excludes mortgage loans held for sale of $161.8 million, $48.3 million, $14.8 million, $22.9 million and $8.1 million as of December 31, 2020, 
2019, 2018, 2017, and 2016, respectively. 

(2) 

Potential Problem Loans 

We categorize loans into risk categories based on relevant information about the ability of the borrowers to service 
their debt, such as: current financial information, historical payment experience, credit documentation, public information, 
and current economic trends, among other factors. We analyze loans individually by classifying the loans by credit risk on 
a quarterly basis, which are segregated into the following definitions for risk ratings: 

Special Mention— Loans categorized as special mention have a potential weakness or borrowing relationships 
that require  more than the usual amount of  management attention.  Adverse industry conditions, deteriorating financial 
conditions,  declining  trends,  management  problems,  documentation  deficiencies  or  other  similar  weaknesses  may  be 
evident. Ability to meet current payment schedules may be questionable, even though interest and principal are still being 
paid as agreed. The asset has potential weaknesses that may result in deteriorating repayment prospects if left uncorrected. 
Loans in this risk grade are not considered adversely classified. 

Substandard—Substandard loans are considered  "classified" and are inadequately protected by the current net 
worth  and  paying  capacity  of  the  obligor  or by  the  collateral  pledged,  if  any.  Loans  so  classified  have  a  well-defined 
weakness or weaknesses that jeopardizes the liquidation of the debt. They are characterized by the distinct possibility that 
the Bank will sustain some loss if the deficiencies are not corrected. Loans in this category may be placed on non-accrual 
status and may individually be evaluated for impairment if indicators of impairment exist. 

Doubtful—Loans  graded  doubtful  are  considered  "classified"  and  have  all  the  weaknesses  inherent  in  those 
classified as Substandard with the added characteristic that the weaknesses make collection or liquidation in full, on the 
basis  of  currently  known  facts,  conditions  and  values,  highly  questionable  and  improbable.  However,  the  amount  or 
certainty of eventual loss is not known because of specific pending factors. 

Loans not meeting any of the three criteria above are considered to be pass-rated loans. 

83 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
     
     
     
 
  
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
     
   
   
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
As  of  December 31, 2020  and  December 31, 2019  non-performing  loans  of  $4.1  million  and  $12.3  million, 
respectively, were included in the substandard category in the table below. The following tables present, by class and by 
credit quality indicator, the recorded investment in our loans as of the dates indicated: 

As of December 31, 2020 

As of December 31, 2019 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Cash, Securities and Other 
Construction and Development 
1-4 Family Residential 
Non-Owner Occupied CRE 
Owner Occupied CRE 
Commercial and Industrial 

Pass 
  $   356,970    $ 
 131,111   
 451,918   
 275,627   
 161,850   
 140,432   

 —   $ 
 —  
 —  
    6,316   
 —  
 —  

Total 

  $  1,517,908    $   6,316    $ 

Allowance for Loan Losses 

      Special         
  Mention   Substandard  

     Special        
  Mention   Substandard  

Total 

Pass 

Total 
 357,020    $  143,898    $ 
 131,111   
 455,038   
 281,943   
 163,042   
 146,031   

 50    $ 
 —  
 3,120   
 —  
 1,192   
 5,599   
 9,961    $  1,534,185    $  973,472    $  1,158    $ 

 —   $ 
 —  
 —  
    1,158   
 —  
 —  

    28,120   
   395,224   
   164,021   
   127,968   
   114,241   

 2,803    $  146,701 
    28,120 
 —  
   400,134 
 4,910   
   165,179 
 —  
   127,968 
 —  
 14,216   
   128,457 
 21,929    $  996,559 

The allowance for loan losses is established through a provision for  loan losses, which is a noncash charge to 
earnings.  Loan  losses  are  charged  against  the  allowance  when  management  believes  that  a  loan  balance  is  confirmed 
uncollectable. Subsequent recoveries, if any, are credited to the allowance for loan losses.  

The allowance for loan losses is evaluated on a regular basis by management and is based upon management’s 
periodic review of the collectability of the loans in light of historical experience, the nature and dollar volume of the loan 
portfolio, adverse situations that may affect the borrower’s ability to repay, the estimated value of any underlying collateral 
and prevailing economic conditions. Allocations of the allowance for loan losses may be made for specific loans, but the 
entire allowance for loan losses is available for any loan that, in management’s judgment, should be charged off. 

We are closely monitoring the changing dynamics in the economy and the client impact driven by the COVID-
19  pandemic.  We  have  intensified  our  portfolio  management,  focusing  on  higher  impacted  industries  and  commercial 
property types. Our clientele is generally comprised of high net-worth individuals and commercial borrowers with strong 
credit profiles and multiple sources of repayment. The portion of our credit exposure to the highest risk industries impacted 
by  COVID-19,  such  as  accommodations,  transportation  and  restaurants,  is  less  than  3.0%  of  our  loan  portfolio.  The 
Company has increased our loan level reviews and portfolio monitoring to address the changing environment and continues 
to engage in more frequent communication with these borrowers to better understand the impact on our borrower’s cash 
flows and respond proactively. While the length of time some of these businesses are unable to operate or operate at full 
capacity  is  unknown,  it  could  have  a  significant  impact  on  many  factors  that  impact  our  borrowers  and  our  reserve 
requirement. During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company increased its allowance for loan losses to account 
for the additional variability surrounding the loan modifications made during the year and increased economic uncertainty 
related  to  the  COVID-19  pandemic.  Management  will  continue  to  closely  monitor  the  loan  portfolio  and  analyze  the 
economic data to assess the impact on the allowance for loan loss. We believe the allowance for loan losses is adequate as 
of December 31, 2020. 

84 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
      
 
 
      
 
      
 
 
      
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
The  following  table  presents  summary  information  regarding  our  allowance  for  loan  losses  for  the  periods 

indicated: 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Average loans outstanding(1)(2) 
Gross loans outstanding at end of period(3) 
Allowance for loan losses at beginning of period 
Provision for loan losses 
Charge-offs: 

2020 
  $  1,318,648  
  $  1,532,833  
 7,875  
  $ 
 4,682  

Year Ended December 31,  
2018 
$  849,263  
$  893,966  
 7,287  
$ 
 180  

2019 
$  936,821  
$  998,007  
 7,451  
$ 
 662  

2017 
$  740,903  
$  813,689  
 6,478  
$ 
 788  

2016 
$  647,228  
$  672,815  
 5,956  
$ 
 985  

Cash, Securities and Other 
Construction and Development 
1-4 Family Residential 
Non-Owner Occupied CRE 
Owner Occupied CRE 
Commercial and Industrial 
Total charge-offs 

Recoveries: 

Cash, Securities and Other 
Construction and Development 
1-4 Family Residential 
Non-Owner Occupied CRE 
Owner Occupied CRE 
Commercial and Industrial 
Total recoveries 
Net charge-offs (recoveries) 
Allowance for loan losses at end of period 
Ratio of allowance to end of period loans(4) 
Ratio of net charge-offs to average loans(5) 

 31  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 31  

 248  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 248  

 16  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 16  

 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  

 13  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 13  
 18  
 12,539  

$ 
 0.82 %     
 — %     

 10  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 10  
 238  
 7,875  

$ 
 0.79 %     
 0.03 %     

 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 16  
 7,451  

$ 
 0.83 %     
 — %     

 10  
 —  
 11  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 21  
 (21)  
 7,287  

$ 
 0.90 %     
 — %     

  $ 

 124  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 687  
 811  

 17  
 163  
 33  
 135  
 —  
 —  
 348  
 463  
 6,478  

 0.96 %   
 0.07 %   

(1)  Average balances are average daily balances. 
(2) 

Excludes average outstanding balances of mortgage loans held for sale of $80.5 million, $39.4 million, $21.8 million, $12.7 million and $19.0 
million for the years ended for December 31, 2020, 2019, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. 
Excludes mortgage loans held for sale of $161.8 million, $48.3 million, $14.8 million, $22.9 million, and $8.1 million as of December 31, 2020, 
2019, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. 
End of period loans at December 31, 2020 includes $127.2 million in acquired loans and $142.9 million in PPP loans of which $12.9 million are 
acquired  PPP  loans.  No  reserve  is  allocated  for  those  loans.  Excluding  these  loans  would  result  in  an increase  of  the  ratio  for  the  year  ended 
December 31, 2020 
For percentages shown as a dash, the ratio of net charge-offs to average loans is negligible or immaterial. 

(3) 

(4) 

(5) 

The following table represents the allocation of the allowance for loan losses among loan categories and other 
summary information. The allocation for loan losses by category should neither be interpreted as an indication of future 
charge-offs,  nor  as  an  indication  that  charge-offs  in  future  periods  will  necessarily  occur  in  these  amounts  or  in  the 
indicated proportions. The allocation of a portion of the allowance for loan losses to one category of loans does not preclude 
its availability to absorb losses in other categories. 

2020 

2019 

As of December 31,  
2018 

2017 

2016 

      Amount       %(1)    Amount       %(1)    Amount       %(1)    Amount       %(1)   

(Dollars in thousands) 
Cash, Securities and Other 
Construction and development 
1-4 Family Residential 
Non-Owner Occupied CRE 
Owner Occupied CRE 
Commercial and Industrial 
Total allowance for loan losses 

     Amount       %(1) 
  $   2,579    
 932    
 3,233    
 2,004    
 1,159    
 2,632    
  $  12,539    

 23.3  %   $   1,058    
 200    
 8.5   
    2,850    
 29.7   
    1,176    
 18.4   
 911    
 10.6   
    1,680    
 9.5   
 100.0  %   $   7,875    

 14.7  %   $ 
 2.8   
 40.2   
 16.6   
 12.8   
 12.9   

 764    
 232    
    2,552    
    1,264    
 789    
    1,850    
 100.0  %   $   7,451    

 12.8  %   $   1,066    
 202    
 3.5   
    2,283    
 39.3   
    1,433    
 19.5   
 751    
 12.2   
    1,552    
 12.7   
 100.0  %   $   7,287    

 16.2  %   $ 
 3.1   
 34.7   
 21.8   
 11.4   
 12.8   

 846    
 301    
    1,833    
    1,153    
 476    
    1,869    
 100.0  %   $   6,478    

 16.7  %   
 5.9   
 36.0   
 22.7   
 9.4   
 9.3   
 100.0  %   

(1)  Represents the percentage of loans to total loans in the respective category. 

85 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
     
     
     
     
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
Deferred Tax Assets, Net 

Deferred tax assets, net represent the differences in timing of when items are recognized for GAAP purposes and when 
they are recognized for tax purposes, as well as our net operating losses. As a result of the Tax Cuts and Jobs Act of 2017, 
our deferred tax assets, net, are valued based on the amounts that are expected to be recovered in the future utilizing the 
tax rates in effect at the time recognized. As a result of book and tax basis differences, our deferred tax assets, net for year 
ended December 31, 2020 increased $1.0 million from December 31, 2019. This increase was primarily driven by higher 
provision for loan losses along with higher incentive accruals. The increase was partially offset by a $0.4 million valuation 
allowance related to the California net operating loss carry forward following the completion of the sale of our LA fixed 
income team. 

Deposits 

Our deposit products include money market accounts, demand deposit accounts, time-deposit accounts (typically 
certificates  of  deposit),  NOW  accounts  (interest  checking  accounts),  and  saving  accounts.  Our  accounts  are  federally 
insured by the FDIC up to the legal maximum amount.  

Total  deposits  increased  by  $533.1  million,  or  49.1%,  to  $1.62  billion  as  of  December 31, 2020  from 
December 31, 2019.  Total  average  deposits  for  the  year  ended  December 31, 2020  were  $1.36  billion,  an  increase  of 
$338.3  million,  or  33.1%,  compared  to  $1.02  billion  as  of  December 31, 2019.  The  increase  in  total  deposits  from 
December 31, 2019 was attributable to organic growth and the Branch Acquisition.  Organic growth was due to our general 
deposit  growth  initiatives,  the  cross-selling  of  products,  the  skills  of  our  sales  and  service  team,  as  well  as  additional 
deposits added from our trust and investment management relationships for which we also provide deposit products. The 
decrease in average rates in 2020 was driven primarily by the lower interest rate environment. 

The following table presents the average balances and average rates paid on deposits for the periods below: 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Deposits 

Money market deposit accounts 
NOW accounts 
Certificates and other time deposits > $250k 
Certificates and other time deposits < $250k 

Total time deposits 

Savings accounts 

Total interest-bearing deposits 

Noninterest-bearing accounts 

Total deposits 

As of and For the Year Ended December 31,  

2020 

2019 

      Average 
Balance 

      Average       
Rate 

Average 
Balance 

      Average 

Rate 

  $ 

 719,946   
 92,383   
 59,996   
 98,231   
 158,227   
 5,552   
 976,108   
 383,271   
  $  1,359,379   

 0.46 %   $ 
 0.25  
 1.69  
 1.28  
 1.44  
 0.08  
 0.59  

 548,776   
 77,071   
 52,593   
 117,585   
 170,178   
 2,961   
 798,986   
 222,058   
 0.43 %   $  1,021,044   

 1.57 % 
 0.32  
 2.10  
 1.96  
 2.01  
 0.20  
 1.53  

 1.20 % 

Average  noninterest-bearing  deposits  to  average  total  deposits  was  28.2%  and  21.7%  for  the  year  ended 

December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively. 

Our  average  cost  of  funds  was  0.48%  and  1.25%  during  the  year  ended  December 31, 2020  and  2019, 
respectively. The decrease was driven by a 94 basis point reduction in interest bearing deposit costs consistent with the 
lower interest rate environment. 

Total money market accounts as of December 31, 2020 were $847.4 million, an increase of $231.9 million, or 
37.7%, compared to $615.6 million as of December 31, 2019. NOW accounts increased $21.1 million, or 23.0%, to $113.1 
million compared to December 31, 2019. 

Total  time  deposits  as  of  December 31, 2020  were  $172.7  million,  an  increase  of  $37.8  million,  or  28.0%, 
compared to December 31, 2019. The increase in deposits from December 31, 2019 was attributable to organic growth 
and the Branch Acquisition. 

86 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
    
     
     
 
     
    
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
    
  
    
 
The  following  table  represents  the  amount  of  certificates  of  deposit  by  time  remaining  until  maturity  as  of 

December 31, 2020: 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Time, $250,000 and over 
Other 
Total 

Borrowings 

As of December 31, 2020 
Maturity Within: 

Three 
Months or 
Less 

Three to Six 
Months 

Six to 12 
Months 

After 12 
Months 

$ 

$ 

5,529  
18,318  
23,847  

$ 

$ 

8,114  
20,905  
29,019  

$ 

$ 

30,073  
42,297  
72,370  

$ 

$ 

29,685  
17,761  
47,446  

$ 

Total 
73,401 
99,281 
$  172,682 

We have short-term and long-term borrowing sources available to supplement deposits and meet our liquidity 
needs.  As  of  December 31, 2020  and  December 31, 2019,  borrowings  totaled  $173.9  million  and  $16.6  million, 
respectively.  

During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company completed the issuance and sale of subordinated notes 
totaling $18.0 million. The increase in other borrowings is primarily attributed to participation in the Paycheck Protection 
Program Loan Facility from the Federal Reserve with a period end balance of $134.6 million. Borrowing from this facility 
is expected to match fund the balances of PPP loans. The table below presents balances of each of the borrowing facilities 
as of the dates indicated: 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Borrowings 

FHLB borrowings 
Federal Reserve borrowings 
Subordinated notes 

Total 

FHLB  

December 31,  
2020 

December 31,  
2019 

  $ 

 15,000   $ 

 134,563  
 24,291  

  $ 

 173,854   $ 

 10,000 
 — 
 6,560 
 16,560 

We  have  a  blanket  pledge  and  security  agreement  with  FHLB  that  requires  certain  loans  and  securities  to  be 
pledged as collateral for any outstanding borrowings under the agreement. The collateral pledged as of December 31, 2020 
and  December 31, 2019 amounted to $668.6 million and $515.5 million, respectively. Based on this collateral and the 
Company’s  holdings  of  FHLB  stock,  the  Company  was  eligible  to  borrow  an  additional  $441.8  million  as  of 
December 31, 2020. 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Short-term borrowings: 

Maximum outstanding at any month-end during the period 
Balance outstanding at end of period 
Average outstanding during the period 
Average interest rate during the period 
Average interest rate at the end of the period 

As of and for the 
Year Ended 
December 31,  
2020 

$ 

$ 

 28,000  
 15,000  
 15,880  

 0.75 % 
 0.32 % 

The Bank has borrowing capacity associated with three unsecured federal funds lines of credit up to $10.0 million, 
$19.0 million, and $25.0 million. As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, there were no amounts outstanding on any of the 
federal funds lines. 

As of December 31, 2019, we had a Restated Revolving Credit Note with a correspondent lending partner and 
the borrowing capacity associated with this facility was $5.0 million with no balance outstanding. The Company renewed 
the Restated Revolving Credit Note under a new Business Loan Agreement and associated Promissory Note on October 

87 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
     
     
       
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
  
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
  
 
  
 
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
28, 2020 to be effective as of June 30, 2020. As of December  31, 2020, the Promissory Note had a borrowing capacity 
under this facility of $5.0 million and had no balance outstanding. 

Our borrowing facilities include various financial and other covenants, including, but not limited to, a requirement 
that  the  Bank  maintains  regulatory  capital  that  is  deemed  "well  capitalized"  by  federal  banking  agencies.  As  of 
December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, the Company was in compliance with the covenant requirements.  

Liquidity and Capital Resources 

Liquidity  resources  primarily  include  interest-bearing  and  noninterest-bearing  deposits  which  primarily 
contribute  to  our  ability  to  raise  funds  to  support  asset  growth,  acquisitions,  and  meet  deposit  withdrawals  and  other 
payment obligations. Access to purchased funds primarily include the ability to borrow from FHLB, other correspondent 
banks and the use of brokered deposits.  

The  following  table  illustrates,  during  the  periods  presented,  the  composition  of  our  funding  sources  and  the 

average assets in which those funds are invested as a percentage of average total assets for the period indicated. 

Sources of Funds: 
Deposits: 

Noninterest-bearing 
Interest-bearing 

FHLB and Federal Reserve borrowings 
Subordinated notes 
Other liabilities 
Shareholders’ equity 

Total 

Uses of Funds: 
Total loans 
Available-for-sale securities 
Mortgage loans held for sale 
Interest-bearing deposits in other financial institutions 
Noninterest-earning assets 

Total 

Average noninterest-bearing deposits to total average deposits 
Average loans to total average deposits 
Average interest-bearing deposits to total average deposits 

  Average Percentage for the Year Ended   

December 31,  

2020 

2019 

 23.10 %   
 58.83  
 7.40  
 0.83  
 1.29  
 8.55  
 100 %   

 78.87 %   
 2.74  
 4.85  
 7.82  
 5.72  
 100 %   
 28.19 %   
 97.00  
 71.81 %   

 18.78 %   
 67.58  
 1.03  
 0.55  
 1.65  
 10.41  

 100 %   

 78.58 %   
 4.49  
 3.34  
 6.85  
 6.74  
 100 %   
 21.75 %   
 91.75  
 78.25 %   

Our primary source of funds is interest-bearing and noninterest-bearing deposits, and our primary use of funds is 

loans. We do not expect a change in the primary source or use of our funds in the foreseeable future. 

Capital Resources 

Total  shareholders’  equity  increased  $27.3  million,  or  21.4%,  to  $155.0  million  as  of  December 31, 2020 
compared to December 31, 2019. The increase is primarily due to net income of $24.5 million, $2.5 million of stock-based 
compensation charges, and other comprehensive income, net of tax of $0.8 million. During the year ended December 31, 
2020, the Bank’s capital was also positively impacted by $3.7 million following the closure of the Capital Management 
segment as a result of the Bank assuming the remaining Goodwill of First Western Capital Management. These increases 
were partially offset by stock repurchases of $0.4 million and $0.3 million of share awards settled. 

On November 3, 2020, the Company announced that its board of directors authorized the repurchase of up to 
400,000 shares of the Company’s common stock, no par value, from time to time, within one year (the "2020 Repurchase 
Plan") and that the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System advised the Company that it has no objection to the 
Company’s 2020 Repurchase Plan. The Company may repurchase shares in privately negotiated transactions, in the open 

88 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
     
 
 
 
 
 
  
     
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
market, including pursuant to any trading plan that may be adopted in accordance with Rule 10b5-1 promulgated by the 
Securities and Exchange Commission, or otherwise in a manner that complies with applicable federal securities laws. The 
2020 Repurchase Plan does not obligate the Company to acquire a specific dollar amount or number of shares and it may 
be extended, modified or discontinued at any time without notice. 

 During  the  year  ended  December 31, 2020,  the  Company  repurchased  23,105  shares  at  an  average  price  of 

$16.59. See Note 12 – Shareholders’ Equity for a breakout of repurchased shares by repurchase plan. 

We are subject to various regulatory capital adequacy requirements at a consolidated level and the bank level. 
These  requirements  are  administered  by  federal  banking  agencies.  Failure  to  meet  minimum  capital  requirements  can 
initiate  certain  mandatory  and  possibly  additional  discretionary  actions  by  regulators  that,  if  undertaken,  could  have  a 
direct material effect on our consolidated financial statements. Under capital adequacy guidelines and, additionally for 
banks,  the  regulatory  framework  for  prompt  corrective  action,  we  must  meet  specific  capital  guidelines  that  involve 
quantitative  measures  of  our  assets,  liabilities,  and  certain  off-balance  sheet  items  as  calculated  under  regulatory 
accounting practices.  

Capital levels are viewed as important indicators of an institution’s financial soundness by banking regulators. 
Generally, FDIC-insured depository institutions and their holding companies are required to maintain minimum capital 
relative to the amount and types of assets they hold. As of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, respectively, our 
holding company and Bank were in compliance  with all applicable regulatory capital requirements, and the Bank  was 
classified  as  "well  capitalized,"  for  purposes  of  the  prompt  corrective  action  regulations.  As  we  continue  to  grow  our 
operations  and  maintain  capital  requirements,  our  regulatory  capital  levels  may  decrease  depending  on  our  level  of 
earnings. During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company made a $10.0 million capital injection into the Bank as 
a result of the growth due to the acquisition. We continue to monitor growth and control our capital activities in order to 
remain in compliance with all applicable regulatory capital standards. 

The following table presents our regulatory capital ratios for the dates noted. 

(Dollars in thousands) 
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets 

Bank 
Consolidated Company 

Common Equity Tier 1(CET1) to risk-weighted assets 

Bank 
Consolidated Company 
Total capital to risk-weighted assets 

Bank 
Consolidated Company 

Tier 1 capital to average assets 

Bank 
Consolidated Company 

December 31, 2020 

      Amount 

      Ratio 

December 31, 2019 

Amount 

      Ratio 

  $ 

 133,963   
 131,507   

 10.22 %   $ 

 9.96  

 99,461   
 105,821   

 10.67 % 
 11.31  

 133,963   
 131,507   

 146,853   
 168,957   

 10.22  
 9.96  

 11.20  
 12.80  

 99,461   
 105,821   

 107,509   
 120,429   

 10.67  
 11.31  

 11.53  
 12.87  

 133,963   
 131,507   

  $ 

 7.62  
 7.45 %   $ 

 99,461   
 105,821   

 8.09  
 8.58 % 

Contractual Obligations and Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements 

We enter into credit-related financial instruments with off-balance sheet risk in the normal course of business to 
meet  the  financing  needs  of  our  clients.  These  financial  instruments  include  commitments  to  extend  credit.  Such 
commitments involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit and interest rate risk in excess of the amount recognized in 
the Consolidated Balance Sheets. Commitments may expire without being utilized. Our exposure to loan loss is represented 
by the contractual amount of these commitments, although material losses are not anticipated. We follow the same credit 
policies in making commitments as we do for on-balance sheet instruments.  

89 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
      
  
    
     
       
 
     
    
 
  
 
  
 
  
   
  
 
  
   
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
   
  
 
  
   
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
   
  
 
  
   
  
 
  
 
  
 
The  following table presents  future  contractual obligations to make future payments for the periods indicated 

(amounts in thousands):  

1 Year 
or Less 

      More than 

1 Year but Less 
than 3 Years 

As of December 31, 2020 
      More than 

  3 Years but Less 

than 5 Years 

5 Years 
or More 

FHLB and Federal Reserve 
Subordinated notes 
Time deposits 
Minimum lease payments 
Total 

$ 

$ 

 —  
 —  
 125,238   
 3,323   
 128,561   

$ 

$ 

 149,563   
 —  
 43,180   
 6,176   
 198,919   

$ 

$ 

 —  
 —  
 4,241   
 4,568   
 8,809   

$ 

$ 

$ 
 —  
 24,291  (1)    
 23   
 867   
 25,181   

$ 

(1)  Reflects contractual maturity dates of December 31, 2026, March 31, 2030, and December 1, 2030. 

Total 

 149,563 
 24,291 
 172,682 
 14,934 
 361,470 

The following tables present financial instruments whose contract amounts represent credit risk, as of the dates 

indicated. 

December 31,  
2020 

December 31,  
2019 

Unused lines of credit 
Standby letters of credit 
Commitments to make loans to sell 
Commitments to make loans 

     Fixed Rate       Variable Rate      Fixed Rate      Variable Rate 
  $   78,506   $   360,883   $  32,896   $   290,653 
 24,197 
 — 
 — 

 1,933  
   370,512  
  $   24,225   $ 

 17,524  
 —  
 25,316   $ 

 1,759  
   47,354  

 —   $ 

We  may  enter  into  contracts  for  services  in  the  conduct  of  ordinary  business  operations,  which  may  require 
payment for services to be provided in the future and may contain penalty clauses for early termination of the contracts. 
We do not believe these off-balance sheet arrangements have or are reasonably likely to have a material effect on our 
financial  condition,  revenues  or  expenses,  results  of  operations,  liquidity,  capital  expenditures,  or  capital  resources. 
However, there can be no assurance that such arrangements will not have an effect on future operations. 

Critical Accounting Policies 

Our  accounting  policies  and  procedures  are  described  in  Note  1  -  Organization  and  Summary  of  Significant 

Accounting Policies in the accompanying Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements. 

ITEM 7A. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK 

Interest Rate Sensitivity and Market Risk 

Market risk is the risk of loss in a financial instrument arising from adverse changes in market prices and rates, 
foreign currency exchange rates, commodity prices and equity prices. Our market risk arises primarily from interest rate 
risk inherent in lending, investing and deposit taking activities. To that end, management actively monitors and manages 
interest rate risk exposure. We do not have any market risk sensitive instruments entered into for trading purposes. 

Management  uses  various  asset/liability  strategies  to  manage  the  re-pricing  characteristics  of  our  assets  and 
liabilities designed to ensure that exposure to interest rate fluctuations is limited within established guidelines of acceptable 
levels of risk-taking. 

The board of directors monitors interest rate risk by analyzing the potential impact on the net economic value of 
equity and net interest income from potential changes in interest rates, and considers the impact of alternative strategies or 
changes in balance sheet structure. We manage our balance sheet in part to maintain the potential impact on economic 
value of equity and net interest income within acceptable ranges despite changes in interest rates. 

Our exposure to interest rate risk is reviewed at least quarterly by the board of directors. Interest rate risk exposure 
is measured using interest rate sensitivity analysis to determine the change in economic value of equity in the event of 
hypothetical changes in interest rates. If potential changes to net economic value of equity and net interest income resulting 

90 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
       
 
       
 
       
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
from hypothetical interest rate changes are not within the limits established by our board of directors, the board of directors 
may direct management to adjust the asset and liability mix to bring interest rate risk within board-approved limits. 

The  following tables  summarize  the  sensitivity in net interest income and fair  value of  equity as of the dates 

indicated, using a parallel ramp scenario. 

As of December 31, 2020 

As of December 31, 2019 

Change in Interest Rates (Basis Points) 
300 
200 
100 
Base 
−100 

      Percent Change        Percent Change        Percent Change        Percent Change    
 in Fair Value of    
Equity 

 in Fair Value of   
Equity 

in Net Interest 
Income 

in Net Interest 
Income 

 9.04 %   
 5.77  
 2.73  
 —  
 (2.83) %   

 19.52 %   
 16.02  
 9.58  
 —  
 (27.89) %   

 (5.76) %   
 (2.97)  
 (1.18)  
 —  
 (0.16) %   

 (9.33) % 
 (3.45)  
 (0.13)  
 —  
 (9.99) % 

The  model  simulations  as  of  December 31, 2020  imply  that  our  balance  sheet  is  slightly  more  asset  sensitive 

compared to our balance sheet as of December 31, 2019, but maintains a fairly neutral position.  

Although the simulation model is useful in identifying potential exposure to interest rate changes, actual results 
for net interest income and economic value of equity may differ. There are a variety of factors that can impact the outcomes 
such  as  timing  and  magnitude  of  interest  rate  changes,  asset  and  liability  mix,  pre-payment  speeds,  deposit  beta 
assumptions,  and  decay  rates  that  differ  from  our  projections.  Additionally,  the  results  do  not  account  for  actions 
implemented to manage our interest rate risk exposure. 

Impact of Inflation 

Our consolidated financial statements and related notes included within this Form 10-K have been prepared in 
accordance with GAAP, which requires the measurement of financial position and operating results in terms of historical 
dollars, without considering changes in the relative value of money over time due to inflation or recession. 

Our assets and liabilities are substantially monetary in nature. Therefore, changes in interest rates can significantly 
impact our performance beyond the general effects of inflation. Interest rates do not necessarily move in the same direction 
or magnitude as prices of general goods and services, while other operating expenses can be correlated with the impact of 
general levels of inflation. 

. 

91 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
ITEM 8: FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA 

Our  financial  statements  and  accompanying  notes,  including  the  Report  of  Independent  Registered  Public 

Accounting Firm, are set forth on pages F-1 to F-51 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. 

Audited Financial Statements 

Description 
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm  
Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2020 and 2019  
Consolidated Statements of Income for the Years Ended December 31, 2020 and 2019  
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for the Years Ended December 31, 2020 and 
2019 
Consolidated Statements of Shareholders’ Equity for the Years Ended December 31, 2020 and 
2019 
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended December 31, 2020 and 2019  
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements  

      Page Number 
F-1 
F-2 
F-3 

F-4 

F-5 
F-6 
F-7 

92 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM 

Shareholders and the Board of Directors 
First Western Financial, Inc. 
Denver, Colorado 

Opinion on the Financial Statements 

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of First Western Financial, Inc. (the "Company") as of 
December 31, 2020 and 2019, the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, shareholders’ equity, 
and cash flows for the  years  ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, and the related notes (collectively referred to as the 
"financial statements"). In our opinion, the financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position 
of the Company as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for the years ended 
December 31, 2020 and 2019, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. 

Basis for Opinion 

These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion 
on the Company's financial statements based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the Public 
Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) ("PCAOB") and are required to be independent with respect to the 
Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and 
Exchange Commission and the PCAOB. We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those 
standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements 
are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud.  

Our audits included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether 
due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a 
test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating 
the  accounting  principles  used  and  significant  estimates  made  by  management,  as  well  as  evaluating  the  overall 
presentation of the financial statements. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion. 

/s/ Crowe LLP 

We have served as the Company’s auditor since 2013. 

Denver, Colorado 
March 12, 2021 

F-1 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
FIRST WESTERN FINANCIAL, INC. 
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS  
(in thousands, except share amounts) 

December 31,  
2020 

December 31,  
2019 

ASSETS 
Cash and cash equivalents: 
Cash and due from banks 
Interest-bearing deposits in other financial institutions 

Total cash and cash equivalents 

Available-for-sale securities, at fair value 
Correspondent bank stock, at cost 
Mortgage loans held for sale 
Loans, net of allowance of $12,539 and $7,875 
Premises and equipment, net 
Accrued interest receivable 
Accounts receivable 
Other receivables 
Other real estate owned, net 
Goodwill and other intangible assets, net 
Deferred tax assets, net 
Company-owned life insurance 
Other assets 
Assets held for sale 

Total assets 

LIABILITIES 
Deposits: 

Noninterest-bearing 
Interest-bearing 

Total deposits 

Borrowings: 

Federal Home Loan Bank Topeka and Federal Reserve borrowings 
Subordinated notes 
Accrued interest payable 
Other liabilities 
Liabilities held for sale 

Total liabilities 

SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY 
Preferred stock - no par value; 10,000,000 shares authorized; 0 issued and outstanding   
Convertible preferred stock - no par value; 150,000 shares authorized; 0 shares issued 
and outstanding  

Common stock - no par value; 90,000,000 shares authorized; 7,951,773 and 7,940,168  
shares issued and outstanding as of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, 
respectively 
Additional paid-in capital 
Retained earnings (accumulated deficit) 
Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) 

Total shareholders’ equity 
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 2,405  
 153,584  
 155,989  

 36,666  
 2,552  
 161,843  
 1,520,294  
 5,320  
 6,618  
 4,865  
 1,422  
 194  
 24,258  
 6,056  
 15,449  
 32,129  
 —  
 1,973,655  

 481,457  
 1,138,453  
 1,619,910  

 149,563  
 24,291  
 453  
 24,476  
 —  
 1,818,693  

 —  

 —  

$ 

$ 

 4,180 
 74,458 
 78,638 

 58,903 
 585 
 48,312 
 990,132 
 5,218 
 3,048 
 5,238 
 1,006 
 658 
 19,714 
 5,047 
 15,086 
 16,544 
 3,553 
 1,251,682 

 240,068 
 846,716 
 1,086,784 

 10,000 
 6,560 
 299 
 20,244 
 117 
 1,124,004 

 — 

 — 

 —  
 144,703  
 9,579  
 680  
 154,962  
 1,973,655  

$ 

 — 
 142,797 
 (14,955) 
 (164) 
 127,678 
 1,251,682 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements. 

F-2 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
  
 
  
 
   
  
 
     
 
   
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
    
  
   
 
  
    
  
   
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
    
  
   
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
    
  
   
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
FIRST WESTERN FINANCIAL, INC. 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME 
 (in thousands, except per share amounts) 

Year Ended December 31,  
2019 
2020 

Interest and dividend income: 

Loans, including fees 
Investment securities 
Federal funds sold and other 

Total interest and dividend income 

Interest expense: 

Deposits 
Other borrowed funds 

Total interest expense 

Net interest income 

Less: provision for loan losses 

Net interest income, after provision for loan losses 

Non-interest income: 

Trust and investment management fees 
Net gain on mortgage loans 
Bank fees 
Risk management and insurance fees 
Income on company-owned life insurance 
Net gain on sale of securities 
Net gain on sale of assets 

Total non-interest income 

Total income before non-interest expense 

Non-interest expense: 

Salaries and employee benefits 
Occupancy and equipment 
Professional services 
Technology and information systems 
Data processing 
Marketing 
Amortization of other intangible assets 
Goodwill impairment 
Net loss on assets held for sale 
Provision for other real estate owned 
Other 

Total non-interest expense 

Income before income taxes 

Income tax expense 

Net income available to common shareholders 
Earnings per common share: 

Basic 
Diluted 

  $ 

 51,998   $ 
 878  
 458  
 53,334  

 5,794  
 1,438  
 7,232  
 46,102  
 4,682  
 41,420  

 19,022  
 29,276  
 1,320  
 1,199  
 363  
 —  
 —  
 51,180  
 92,600  

 34,785  
 6,009  
 5,035  
 4,035  
 4,000  
 1,478  
 14  
 —  
 553  
 176  
 3,452  
 59,537  
 33,063  
 8,529  
 24,534   $ 

 3.11   $ 
 3.08   $ 

  $ 

  $ 
  $ 

 42,045 
 1,274 
 1,732 
 45,051 

 12,263 
 727 
 12,990 
 32,061 
 662 
 31,399 

 18,935 
 10,585 
 1,173 
 1,205 
 377 
 119 
 183 
 32,577 
 63,976 

 31,810 
 5,562 
 3,519 
 3,973 
 3,065 
 1,292 
 374 
 1,572 
 — 
 — 
 2,617 
 53,784 
 10,192 
 2,183 
 8,009 

 1.02 
 1.01 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements. 

F-3 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
  
 
     
 
   
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
    
  
   
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
    
  
   
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
    
  
   
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
FIRST WESTERN FINANCIAL, INC. 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME 
(in thousands) 

Net income 
Other comprehensive income items, net of tax effect: 

Net change in unrealized gains on available-for-sale securities 
Reclassification adjustment for realized gains included in earnings 

Total other comprehensive income 

Comprehensive income 

Year Ended December 31,  
2019 
2020 

$ 

$ 

 24,534  

$ 

 844  
 —  
 844  
 25,378  

$ 

 8,009 

 1,262 
 94 
 1,356 
 9,365 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements. 

F-4 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
FIRST WESTERN FINANCIAL, INC. 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY 
 (in thousands, except share amounts) 

Balance, December 31, 2018 

Net income 
Other comprehensive income, net of tax 
Settlement of share awards 
Adoption of ASU 2018-02 
Share repurchase 
Stock-based compensation 
Balance, December 31, 2019 

Net income 
Other comprehensive income, net of tax 
Settlement of share awards 
Share repurchase 
Stock-based compensation 
Balance, December 31, 2020 

Shares 

Common 
Stock 

Additional 
Paid-In 
Capital 

      Retained   
Earnings 

      Accumulated        
Other 

(Accumulated   Comprehensive  
Income (Loss)  

Deficit) 

 7,968,420    $ 

 141,359    $ 

 (23,199)   $ 

 (1,285)   $ 

 —   
 —   
 15,446   
 —   
 (43,698)  
 —   

 7,940,168    $ 

 —   
 —   
 34,710   
 (23,105)  
 —   

 7,951,773    $ 

 —   
 —   
 (110)  
 —   
 (743)  
 2,291   
 142,797    $ 

 —   
 —   
 (261)  
 (377)  
 2,544   
 144,703    $ 

 8,009   
 —   
 —   
 235   
 —   
 —   
 (14,955)   $ 

 24,534   
 —   
 —   
 —   
 —   
 9,579    $ 

 —   
 1,356   
 —   
 (235)  
 —   
 —   
 (164)   $ 

 —   
 844   
 —   
 —   
 —   
 680    $ 

Total 
 116,875 

 8,009 
 1,356 
 (110) 
 — 
 (743) 
 2,291 
 127,678 

 24,534 
 844 
 (261) 
 (377) 
 2,544 
 154,962 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements. 

F-5 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
      
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
FIRST WESTERN FINANCIAL, INC. 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS 
(in thousands) 

Cash flows from operating activities 

Net income 

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash used in operating activities: 

Year Ended December 31,  
2019 
2020 

$ 

 24,534   

$ 

 8,009 

Depreciation and amortization 
Deferred income tax benefits, net of valuation allowance 
Stock-based compensation 
Provision for loan losses 
Net amortization of investment securities 
Stock dividends received on correspondent bank stock 
Increase in cash surrender value of company-owned life insurance 
Net gain on mortgage loans 
Origination of mortgage loans held for sale 
Proceeds from mortgage loans 
Gain on sale of securities 
Gain on sale of assets 
Loss on assets held for sale 
Loss on impairment of goodwill 
Provision for other real estate owned 
Accounts receivable 
Accrued interest receivable and other assets 
Accrued interest payable and other liabilities 
Net cash used in operating activities 

Cash flows from investing activities 

Activity in available-for-sale securities: 
Maturities, prepayments, and calls 
Sales 
Purchases 

Purchases of correspondent bank stock 
Redemption of correspondent bank stock 
Purchases of premises and equipment 
Proceeds from sale of premises and equipment 
Proceeds from sale of other real estate owned 
Net cash paid on acquisitions (Note 2) 
Loan and note receivable originations and principal collections, net 

Net cash used in investing activities 

Cash flows from financing activities 

Net change in deposits 
Proceeds from subordinated notes 
Repurchase of common stock 
Settlement of restricted stock 
Recognition of capitalized subordinated notes issuance costs 
Payments to Federal Reserve borrowings 
Proceeds from Federal Reserve borrowings 
Payments to Federal Home Loan Bank Topeka borrowings 
Proceeds from Federal Home Loan Bank Topeka borrowings 

Net cash provided by financing activities 

Net change in cash and cash equivalents 
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year 
Cash and cash equivalents, end of year 
Supplemental cash flow information: 

Interest paid on deposits and borrowed funds 
Income tax payment, net of refunds received 
Cash paid for amounts included in the measurement of lease liabilities 

Supplemental noncash disclosures: 

Reclass of held for sale assets, net of liabilities 
Contingent asset resulting from sale of held for sale assets 
Adoption of ASU 2018-02 - Reclassification of stranded tax effects 
Change in unrealized gain on available for sale securities  
Lease right-of-use-asset obtained in exchange for lease liabilities 

 1,105   
 (1,300)  
 2,544   
 4,682   
 442   
 (17)  
 (363)  
 (29,276)  
 (1,331,989)  
 1,238,881   
 —   
 (43)  
 553   
 —   
 176   
 355   
 (4,473)  
 858   
 (93,331)  

 28,639   
 —   
 (6,000)  
 (1,950)  
 —   
 (1,205)  
 10   
 288   
 (61,316)  
 (414,486)  
 (456,020)  

 470,046   
 18,000   
 (377)  
 (261)  
 (269)  
 (69,750)  
 204,313   
 (30,000)  
 35,000   
 626,702   

 77,351   
 78,638   
 155,989   

 7,078   
 11,763   
 5,659   

 (2,990)  
 3,062   
 —   
 1,113   
 3,600   

$ 

$ 

$ 

 1,671 
 (1,216) 
 2,291 
 662 
 226 
 (29) 
 (377) 
 (10,585) 
 (640,575) 
 615,961 
 (119) 
 (183) 
 — 
 1,572 
 — 
 (728) 
 (522) 
 2,429 
 (21,513) 

 9,598 
 7,506 
 (31,063) 
 (1,286) 
 3,218 
 (415) 
 — 
 — 
 — 
 (103,937) 
 (116,379) 

 149,026 
 — 
 (743) 
 (110) 
 — 
 — 
 — 
 (72,346) 
 67,346 
 143,173 

 5,281 
 73,357 
 78,638 

 12,922 
 2,476 
 5,351 

 3,436 
 — 
 235 
 1,831 
 16,580 

   $ 

$ 

$ 

See Note 2 - Acquisitions regarding noncash transactions included in the acquisition. 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements. 

F-6 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
 
 
  
 
     
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
    
 
   
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
    
  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
FIRST WESTERN FINANCIAL, INC. 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 

NOTE 1 - ORGANIZATION AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES 

Business and Basis of Presentation: The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of First Western 
Financial, Inc. ("FWFI"), incorporated in Colorado on July 18, 2002, and its direct and indirect wholly-owned subsidiaries 
listed below (collectively referred to as the "Company", "we", "us", or "our"). 

FWFI is a bank holding company with financial holding company status registered with the Board of Governors 
of the  Federal Reserve System. FWFI  wholly owns the  following subsidiaries: First Western Trust Bank (the  "Bank") 
Ryder, Stilwell Inc. ("RSI"), and First Western Capital Management Company ("FWCM"). The Bank wholly owns the 
following subsidiaries, which are therefore indirectly wholly-owned by FWFI: First Western Merger Corporation ("Merger 
Corp."), and RRI, LLC ("RRI"). FWCM became inactive during the current year. RSI and RRI are also not active operating 
entities. 

The  Company  provides  a  fully-integrated  suite  of  wealth  management  services  including  private  banking, 
personal trust,  investment  management,  mortgage  loans, and institutional asset  management services to individual and 
corporate clients principally in Colorado (metro Denver, Aspen, Boulder, Fort Collins and Vail Valley), Arizona (Phoenix 
and  Scottsdale),  California  (Century  City)  and  Wyoming  (Jackson  Hole  and  Laramie).  The  Company’s  revenues  are 
generated from its full range of product offerings as noted above, but principally from net interest income (the interest 
income  earned  on  the  Bank’s  assets  net  of  funding  costs),  fee-based  wealth  advisory,  investment  management,  asset 
management and personal trust services, and net gains earned on mortgage loans. 

The  consolidated  financial  statements  have  been  prepared in  conformity  with  accounting  principles  generally 
accepted in the United States of America ("GAAP") for financial information, pursuant to the rules and regulations of the 
U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission ("SEC"), and where applicable, reporting practices prescribed for the banking 
and investment advisory industries.  

Consolidation:  The  Company’s  policy  is  to  consolidate  all  majority-owned  subsidiaries  in  which  it  has  a 
controlling financial interest and variable-interest entities where the Company is deemed to be the primary beneficiary. 
All material intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation. 

On May 15, 2020, the Company completed a branch purchase and assumption transaction ("Branch Acquisition") 
with Simmons Bank ("Simmons"). Management concluded that the acquisition represented a business combination, which 
is  accounted  for  using  the  acquisition  method,  with  the  results  of  operations  included  in  the  Company’s  consolidated 
financial statements as of the acquisition date. For additional information, see Note 2. 

Use of Estimates: To prepare financial statements in conformity with GAAP, management makes estimates and 
assumptions  based  on  available  information.  These  estimates  and  assumptions  affect  the  amounts  reported  in  the 
consolidated financial statements and the disclosures provided, and actual results could differ. Information available which 
could affect these judgments include, but are not limited to, changes in interest rates, changes in the performance of the 
economy, including the impact of the COVID-19 pandemic, and changes in the financial condition of borrowers. Material 
estimates that are particularly susceptible to significant change include: the determination of the allowance for loan losses, 
the evaluation of goodwill impairment, and the fair value of financial instruments.  

The Company could experience a material adverse effect on its business as a result of the impact of the COVID-
19 pandemic, and the resulting governmental actions to curtail its spread. It is at least reasonably possible that information 
which was available at the date of the financial statements will change in the near term due to the COVID-19 pandemic 
and  that  the  effect  of  the  change  would  be  material  to  the  financial  statements.  The  extent  to  which  the  COVID-19 
pandemic will impact our estimates and assumptions is highly uncertain. 

Concentration of Credit Risk: Most of the Company’s lending activity is to clients located in and around metro 
Denver, Colorado; Phoenix and Scottsdale, Arizona; and Jackson Hole and Laramie, Wyoming. The Company does not 

F-7 

 
believe  it  has  significant  concentrations  in  any  one  industry  or  customer.  As  of  December 31, 2020  and 
December 31, 2019, 66.9% and 71.7%, respectively, of the Company’s loan portfolio was secured by real estate collateral. 
Declines in real estate values in the primary markets the Company operates in could negatively impact the Company. 

Cash  and  Cash  Equivalents:  Cash  and  cash  equivalents  include  cash  on  hand,  deposits  at  other  financial 
institutions with original maturities fewer than 90 days, and federal funds sold. Net cash flows are reported for customer 
loan and deposit transactions, interest bearing deposits  in other  financial institutions, and federal  funds purchased and 
repurchase agreements. 

Investment  Securities:  Investments  we  intend  to  hold  for  an  indefinite  period  of  time,  but  not  necessarily  to 
maturity, are classified as available-for-sale and are recorded at fair value using current market information from a pricing 
service, with unrealized gains and losses excluded from earnings and reported in other comprehensive income (loss), net 
of  tax.  As  of  December 31, 2020  and  2019,  all  investment  securities  were  classified  as  available-for-sale.  As  of 
December 31, 2020, equity mutual funds have been recorded at fair value within the Other assets line of the Consolidated 
Balance Sheets with changes recorded in the Other line of the Consolidated Statements of Income. 

The Company invests in projects to create affordable housing. These investments are classified as Other assets 
on the Consolidated Balance Sheets. Investments in affordable housing projects that qualify for low-income housing tax 
credits  ("LIHTC")  are  accounted  for  using  the  proportional  amortization  method.  Under  the  proportional  amortization 
method, the initial cost of the investment is amortized in proportion to the tax credits and other benefits received and 
recognized as a component of applicable income tax expense in the Consolidated Statements of Income. 

Net purchase premiums and discounts are recognized in interest income using the interest method over the terms 
of  the  securities,  without  anticipating  prepayments,  except  for  mortgage-backed  securities  where  prepayments  are 
anticipated. Declines in the fair value of available-for-sale securities below their cost that are deemed to be other-than-
temporary are recorded in earnings as realized losses in Non-interest income.  

Management evaluates securities for other-than-temporary impairment ("OTTI") on a quarterly basis, or more 
frequently when economic or market conditions warrant such an evaluation. For securities in an unrealized loss position, 
management considers the extent and duration of the unrealized loss, and the financial condition and near-term prospects 
of the issuer. Management also assesses whether it intends to sell, or it is more likely than not that it will be required to 
sell, a security in an unrealized loss position before recovery of its amortized cost basis. If either of the criteria regarding 
intent or requirement to sell is met, the entire difference between amortized cost and fair value is recognized as impairment 
through earnings. For debt securities that do not meet the aforementioned criteria, the amount of impairment is split into 
two components as follows: 1) OTTI related to loss on securities, which must be recognized in the income statement and 
2) OTTI related to other factors, which is recognized in other comprehensive income (loss). The credit loss is defined as 
the difference between the present value of the cash flows expected to be collected and the amortized cost basis.  As of 
December 31, 2020 and 2019, no securities were determined to be other-than-temporarily impaired.  

Gains and losses on the sale of securities are recorded on the trade date and are determined using the specific 

identification method. 

Correspondent Bank Stock: Correspondent bank stock includes stock in both the Federal Home Loan Bank of 
Topeka  ("FHLB")  and  Bankers’  Bank  of  the  West  ("BBW"),  which  are  considered  restricted  securities  because  the 
Company  may  be  required  to  hold  the  stock  in  order  to  maintain  the  correspondent  banking  relationship  with  these 
institutions.  No  ready  market  exists  for  the  FHLB  stock  and  therefore,  no  quoted  market  values  exist.  For  financial 
reporting  purposes,  the  FHLB  stock  is  carried  at  cost,  classified  as  a  restricted  security  and  periodically  evaluated  for 
impairment based on ultimate recovery of par value. The BBW stock is carried at fair value. No impairment was recorded 
as of December 31, 2020 and 2019. Both cash and stock dividends are reported as income when received. 

Mortgage  Loans  Held  for  Sale:  Mortgage  loans  originated  and  intended  for  sale  in  the  secondary  market  are 
carried at fair value. Net unrealized losses, if any, are recorded and charged to earnings. Servicing rights are released when 
the associated mortgage loans are sold. Gains and losses on sales of mortgage loans are based on the difference between 
the selling price and the carrying value of the related loan sold.  

F-8 

 
 
 
 
Loans: Loans the Company has the intent and ability to hold for the foreseeable future, until maturity,  or until 
payoff are reported at their outstanding unpaid principal balances, adjusted for charge-offs and recoveries, net of deferred 
costs  (fees)  and  unamortized  premiums/  (unaccreted  discounts),  and  the  allowance  for  loan  losses.  Interest  income  is 
accrued on unpaid principal balances. Fees received at origination, net of certain direct origination costs for providing loan 
commitments and letters of credit that result in loans, are deferred and amortized to interest income over the life of the 
related loan or until payoff, at which time the remaining unamortized fee is recorded as interest income. Fees, net of certain 
direct origination costs on commitments and letters of credit, are amortized to interest income over the commitment period. 

Past Due Loans: The accrual of interest on loans is discontinued at the time the loan becomes 90 days delinquent 
unless the loan is well secured and in the process of collection. Past due status is based on the contractual terms of the 
loan. In all cases, loans are placed on nonaccrual status or charged off if collection of interest or principal is considered 
doubtful.  

Interest accrued but not collected is charged off against interest income at the time a loan is placed on non-accrual 
status. The interest collected on non-accrual loans is accounted for using the cost-recovery method, until qualifying for 
return to accrual. Under the cost-recovery method, interest income is not recognized until the loan balance is reduced to 
zero. Loans can be returned to accrual status  when there is a sustained period of repayment performance (usually six-
months or longer) and the collectability of future payments is reasonably assured.  

Troubled Debt Restructurings: A troubled debt restructuring ("TDR") is a loan the Company, for reasons related 

to a borrower’s financial difficulties, grants a concession to the borrower the Company would not otherwise consider.  

The loan terms which have been modified or restructured due to a borrower’s financial difficulty, include but are 
not limited to (i) a reduction in the stated interest rate of the loan, (ii) an extension of the maturity date of the loan at an 
interest rate below market, or (iii) a reduction of the accrued interest.  

Loan modifications granted by the Company are reviewed on a case-by-case basis to determine if they should be 

considered a restructured loan. 

COVID-19  Loan  Modifications:  As  a  result  of  the  COVID-19  pandemic,  a  loan  modification  program  was 
designed and implemented to assist our clients experiencing financial stress resulting from the economic impacts caused 
by  the  global  pandemic.  The  Company  was  offering  loan  extensions,  temporary  payment  moratoriums,  and  financial 
covenant waivers for commercial and consumer borrowers impacted by the pandemic who have a pass risk rating and have 
not been delinquent over 30 days on payments in the last two years, primarily for a period of 180 days or less.  

During 2020, the Company’s loan portfolio included 89 loans totaling $160.8 million, which participated in the 
Company’s COVID-19 loan modification program. As of December 31, 2020, only two loans remain in their payment 
deferral term, including acquired loans, in the amount of $2.1 million, representing 0.13% of total loans. 

COVID-19  and  CARES  Act:  On  March  11,  2020  the  World  Health  Organization  declared  the  outbreak  of 
COVID-19  a  global  pandemic,  which  continues  to  spread  throughout  the  United  States  and  the  around  the  world.  In 
response  to  the  COVID-19  pandemic,  the  President  signed  the  Coronavirus  Aid,  Relief  and  Economic  Security  Act 
("CARES Act") into law on March 27, 2020. The objective of the CARES Act is to prevent a severe economic downturn 
using various measures, including economic stimulus to significantly impacted industry sectors. We continue to monitor 
the impact of COVID-19 closely, as well as any effects that may result from the CARES Act and other government actions. 
However, the extent to which the COVID-19 pandemic will impact our operations and financial results is highly uncertain. 

The CARES Act created the paycheck protection program ("PPP"), which is administered by the Small Business 
Administration ("SBA"). The PPP is intended to provide loans to small businesses to pay their employees, rent, mortgage 
interest and utilities. The loans may be forgiven conditioned upon the client providing payroll documentation evidencing 
their compliant use of funds and otherwise complying with the terms of the program. The Bank is an approved SBA lender 
and supported the community and clients by originating PPP loans during the year ended December 31, 2020. A second 
round of PPP funding was made available by the SBA in January 2021 and the Company is originating loans under the 

F-9 

 
 
 
 
 
 
new round of funding. PPP loans are classified in the Cash, Securities and Other portion of the loan portfolio. See Note 5 
- Loans and the Allowance for Loan Losses for further discussion on our PPP loans. 

The  CARES  Act provides banks optional, temporary relief from accounting  for certain loan  modifications as 
TDRs. The modifications must be related to the adverse effects of COVID-19, and certain other criteria are required to be 
met in order to apply the relief. Interagency guidance from Federal Reserve and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation 
("FDIC") confirmed with the FASB that short-term modifications made on a good faith basis in response to COVID-19 to 
borrowers who were current prior to any relief, are not to be considered a TDR. We believe our loan modification program 
meets that definition and have not classified any of these modifications as a TDR as of December 31, 2020. In accordance 
with that guidance, the Company is recognizing interest income on all loans modified for temporary payment moratoriums. 
See Note 5 - Loans and the Allowance for Loan Losses for further discussion on our loan modification program. 

All loans modified in response to COVID-19 are classified as performing and pass rated as of December 31, 2020. 
These loans are included in the allowance for loan loss general reserve in accordance with ASC 450-20. Management has 
increased our loan level reviews and portfolio monitoring to address the changing environment. The Company continues 
to meet regularly with clients who could be more highly impacted by the recent COVID-19 pandemic. These are borrowers 
in industries we believe may be more impacted by the pandemic, for instance those loans where there may be a greater 
than 50% probability of a downgrade, covenant violation or 20% reduction in collateral position. Management believes 
the diversity of the loan portfolio is prudent and remains consistent with the credit culture and goals of the Bank. 

Interest accrued during the modification term on modified loans is deferred to the end of the loan term. As of 
December 31, 2020, no allowance for loan loss was deemed necessary on the accrued interest balances related to loan 
modifications. 

The Company is a participant in the Federal Reserve’s Main Street Lending Program ("MSLP") to support lending 
to small and medium-sized for profit businesses and nonprofit organizations that were in sound financial condition before 
the onset of the COVID-19 pandemic. The Company may sell a 95% participation in a new MSLP loan to the Main Street 
Special Purpose Vehicle ("SPV") at par value. The Company must retain 5% of the MSLP loan until (i) it matures or (ii) 
neither the Main Street SPV nor a Governmental Assignee holds an interest in MSLP Loan in any capacity, whichever 
comes  first.  See  Note  5  -  Loans  and  the  Allowance  for  Loan  Losses  for  further  discussion  on  our  participation  in  the 
program. 

Allowance for Loan Losses: The Company’s reserve for loan losses is an estimate of the probable incurred loan 
losses and is comprised of (i) the allowance for loan losses and (ii) the reserve for unfunded commitments. The reserve for 
unfunded commitments is included in  Other liabilities in the accompanying  Consolidated Balance Sheets and the loan 
balances  in  the  accompanying  Consolidated  Balance  Sheets  are  reported  net  of  the  allowance  for  loan  losses.  The 
allowance for loan losses is established through a provision for loan losses, which is a noncash charge to earnings. Loan 
losses are charged against the allowance when management believes the uncollectibility of a loan balance is confirmed. 
Subsequent recoveries, if any, are credited to the allowance for loan losses.  

The allowance for loan losses is evaluated on a regular basis by management and is based upon management’s 
periodic review of the collectability of the loans in light of historical experience, the nature and dollar volume of the loan 
portfolio, adverse situations that may affect the borrower’s ability to repay, the estimated value of any underlying collateral 
and prevailing economic conditions. Allocations of the allowance may be made for specific loans, but the entire allowance 
is available for any loan that, in management’s judgment, should be charged off. This evaluation is inherently subjective 
as it requires estimates that are susceptible to significant revision as more information becomes available.  

We are closely monitoring the changing dynamics in the economy and the client impact driven by the COVID-
19  pandemic.  We  have  intensified  our  portfolio  management,  focusing  on  higher  impacted  industries  and  commercial 
property  types.  The  portion  of  our  credit  exposure  to  the  highest  risk  industries  impacted  by  COVID-19,  such  as 
accommodations, transportation and restaurants, is less than 3.0% of our loan portfolio. The Company has increased our 
loan level reviews and portfolio monitoring to address the changing environment and continues to engage in more frequent 
communication  with  these  borrowers  to  better  understand  the  impact  on  our  borrower’s  cash  flows  and  respond 
proactively. While the length of time some of these businesses are unable to operate or operate at full capacity is unknown, 

F-10 

 
 
 
it could have a significant impact on many factors that impact our borrowers and our reserve requirement. During the year 
ended December 31, 2020, the Company increased its allowance to account for the additional variability surrounding the 
loan modifications and increased economic uncertainty related to the COVID-19 pandemic. Management will continue to 
closely monitor the loan portfolio and analyze the economic data to assess the impact on the allowance for loan losses. 

A loan is considered impaired when, based on current information and events, it is probable the Company will be 
unable to collect the scheduled payments of principal or interest when due according to the contractual terms of the loan 
agreement. 

TDR  and  non-accrual  loans  are  separately  evaluated  for  impairment  and  included  in  the  separately  identified 
impairment  disclosures.  If  cash  flow  dependent,  TDR  and  non-accrual  loans  will  be  measured  at  the  present  value  of 
estimated future cash flows using the loan’s effective rate at inception. If a TDR or non-accrual loan is considered to be a 
collateral dependent loan, the loan is reported, net, at the fair value of the collateral. For TDR and non-accrual loans that 
subsequently default, the Company determines the amount of reserve in accordance with the accounting policy for the 
allowance for loan losses on loans individually identified as impaired. 

Factors considered by management in determining impairment include payment status, collateral value, and the 
probability of collecting all scheduled principal and interest payments. Loans that experience insignificant payment delays 
and  payment  shortfalls  generally  are  not  classified  as  impaired.  Management  determines  the  significance  of  payment 
delays and payment shortfalls on a case-by-case basis, taking into consideration all of the circumstances surrounding the 
loan and the borrower, including the length of the delay, the reasons for the delay, the borrower’s prior payment record, 
and the amount of the shortfall in relation to the principal and interest owed. 

The allowance  for loan losses is comprised of specific loan loss reserves and general loan loss reserves. The 
impairment of a specific loan is measured based either on (i) the present value of expected future cash flows discounted at 
the loan’s effective interest rate, or (ii) the fair value of the underlying collateral, less costs to sell, if the repayment is 
expected to be provided predominantly by the sale of the underlying collateral. Specific impairments are measured on a 
loan-by-loan basis if risk characteristics are unique to an individual borrower. The general loan loss reserve covers non-
impaired loans and is established by evaluating the incurred loss on homogenous pools of loans, not specifically reviewed 
for impairment as noted above, that have common risk characteristics. The general loan loss reserve is based on historical 
loss experiences adjusted for nine qualitative factors on all loans in the portfolio not considered impaired. Certain factors 
are applied to each pool and certain factors are applied to all non-individually reviewed loans. The nine qualitative factors 
the Company considers are:  

1.  Changes  in  relevant  economic  and  business  conditions  and  developments  that  affect  the 

collectability of the portfolio, including the condition of various market segments.  

2.  Levels and trends in net charge-offs.  
3.  The  existence  and  effect  of  any  concentrations  of  credit  and  changes  in  the  level  of  such 

concentrations.  

4.  Changes in the nature or volume of the loan portfolio and in the terms of loans.  
5.  Changes in the experience, ability, and depth of lending management and other relevant staff.  
6.  Changes in the volume and severity of past due loans.  
7.  Changes in the quality of the loan review system and associated grading changes.  
8.  Change in the level of overdrafts. 
9.  Levels and status of loans modified as a result of COVID-19. 

The following portfolio segments have been identified: 

  Cash, Securities and Other—consists of consumer and commercial purpose loans that are primarily secured 
by  securities  managed  and  under  custody  with  us,  cash  on  deposit  with  us  or  life  insurance  policies.  In 
addition, loans in this portfolio are collateralized with other sources of consumer collateral and an immaterial 
amount of each loan may be unsecured. This segment of our portfolio is affected by a variety of local and 
national economic factors affecting borrowers’ employment prospects, income levels, and overall economic 

F-11 

 
 
  
  
 
 
sentiment. PPP loans that are fully guaranteed by the SBA are classified within this line item as of December 
31, 2020. 

  Construction  and  Development—consists  of  loans  to  finance  the  construction  of  residential  and  non-
residential properties. These loans are dependent on the strength of the industries of the related borrowers 
and the risks consistent with construction projects.  

 

1-4 Family Residential—consists of loans and home equity lines of credit secured by 1-4 family residential 
properties. These loans typically enable borrowers to purchase or refinance existing homes, most of which 
serve as the primary residence of the owner. In addition, some borrowers secure a commercial purpose loan 
with owner occupied or non-owner occupied 1-4 family residential properties.  Loans  in  this segment are 
dependent  on  the  industries  tied  to  these  loans  as  well  as  the  national  and  local  economies,  and  local 
residential and commercial real estate markets. 

  Commercial  Real  Estate  ("CRE"),  Owner  Occupied  and  Non-Owner  Occupied—consists  of  commercial 
loans  collateralized  by  real  estate.  These  loans  may  be  collateralized  by  owner  occupied  or  non-owner 
occupied real estate, as well as multi-family residential real estate. These loans are dependent on the strength 
of the industries of the related borrowers and the success of their businesses.  

  Commercial and Industrial—consists of commercial and industrial loans, including working capital lines of 
credit, permanent working capital term loans, business asset loans, acquisition, expansion and development 
loans, and other loan products, primarily in our target markets. This portfolio primarily consists of term loans 
and lines of credit which are dependent on the strength of the industries of the related borrowers and the 
success of their businesses. This category includes MSLP loans as of December 31, 2020.  

The reserve for unfunded commitments represents the estimate  for probable loan losses inherent in  unfunded 
commitments to extend credit. Unfunded commitments to extend credit include commercial and standby letters of credit, 
unused lines of credit, and unfunded loan commitments expected to be funded.  

The  process  used  to  determine  the  reserve  for  unfunded  commitments  is  consistent  with  the  process  for 
determining the allowance for loan losses, adjusted for estimated funding probabilities. Changes to the level of the reserve 
for unfunded commitments are recognized through the provision for loan losses for off-balance sheet credit exposures, 
included in the non-interest Other expense line of the Consolidated Statements of Income. 

Transfers of Financial Assets: Transfers of financial assets are accounted for as sales, when control over the assets 
has been relinquished. Control over transferred assets is deemed to be surrendered when the assets have been isolated from 
the Company, the transferee obtains the right (free of conditions that constrain it from taking advantage of that right) to 
pledge or exchange the transferred assets, and the Company does not maintain effective control over the transferred assets 
through an agreement to repurchase them before their maturity. Prior to participating in the MSLP, the Company obtained 
a true sale opinion with regards to the legal isolation condition of the contract. Legal counsel determined that given the 
facts  and  circumstances  provided,  consistent  with  the  FDIC  rule  entitled  “Treatment  of  financial  assets  transferred  in 
connection with a securitization or participation”, 12 C.F.R. §360.6, that the MSLP documents would be considered a true 
sale to the buyer.  As such, Management concludes the MSLP loans qualify for sales accounting treatment and are true 
sales contracts under GAAP. 

Premises and Equipment: Premises and equipment are carried at cost, net of accumulated depreciation, with the 
exception of artwork, which is carried at cost. Leasehold improvements are depreciated using the straight-line method and 
recognized  over  the  shorter  of  the  lease  term  or  estimated  useful  lives  of  the  assets,  ranging  from  7  to  15  years. 
Furniture/equipment and software are depreciated using the straight-line method and recognized over the estimated useful 
lives of the assets, ranging from 3 to 7 years.  

Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets: Goodwill represents the excess of purchase price over the fair value of net 
identifiable tangible and intangible assets acquired in business combinations. The Company has acquired other identifiable 
intangible  assets,  primarily  consisting  of  customer  relationships,  non-competition  agreements  and  recorded  goodwill 

F-12 

through  its  acquisition  of  financial  services  companies.  Goodwill  and  other  indefinite-lived  intangible  assets  are  not 
amortized, but are tested for impairment at the reporting unit level at least annually by applying a fair value-based test 
using discounted estimated future net cash flows. The Company has selected October 31 as the date to perform its annual 
impairment tests. Impairment exists when the carrying amount of the goodwill and other intangible assets exceeds their 
implied fair values. Impairment losses, if any, are recognized as a charge to non-interest expense and an adjustment to the 
carrying  value  of  the  goodwill  or  other  intangible  assets.  Subsequent  reversals  of  impairment  charges  are  prohibited. 
Goodwill is the only intangible asset with an indefinite life on the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets. Other definite-
lived  intangible  assets,  including  customer  relationship  intangibles,  are  amortized  on  a  straight-line  basis  over  periods 
representing the estimated remaining lives of the assets of one to fifteen years, and are evaluated for impairment when 
events  or  changes  in  circumstances  indicate  the  carrying  values  of  such  assets  may  not  be  recoverable.  As  of 
December 31, 2020, the Company believes the carrying value of its goodwill not to be impaired and other intangible assets 
to be recoverable.  

Accounts  Receivable:  Accounts  receivable  primarily  represents  the  billed  but  unpaid  fees  from  trust  and 
investment advisory services owed by clients, which are typically calculated as a percentage of average invested balances. 
The  majority  of  the  Company’s  investment  advisory  clients  are  billed  quarterly  in  arrears  based  on  the  daily  average 
balance in the client’s trust or investment accounts for that quarter.  

Other Receivables: Other accounts receivable represents compensation paid to employees that is contingent on 
future employment and recognized in the Consolidated Statements of Income over the estimated service period, sales of 
investments and assets in which the Company has obtained a firm commitment as of the balance sheet dates, and fees due 
from the SBA related to PPP.  

Leases:  Leases  represent  a  contract  that  conveys  the  right  to  control  the  use  of  identified  property,  plant,  or 
equipment (an identified asset) for a period of time in exchange for consideration. The Company leases certain identified 
assets  from  third  parties.  Leases  in  which  the  Company  is  determined  to  be  the  lessee  are  primarily  operating  leases. 
Effective  January  1,  2019,  operating  leases  are  included  in  the  Other  assets  and  Other  liabilities  line  items  of  the 
Consolidated Balance Sheets and lease expense for lease payments is recognized on a straight-line basis over the lease 
term. Right-of-use (“ROU”) assets and liabilities are recognized at the lease commencement date based on the present 
value of lease payments over the lease term. An ROU asset represents the right to use the underlying asset for the lease 
term and also includes any direct costs and payments made prior to lease commencement and excludes lease incentives. 
When an implicit rate is not available, an incremental borrowing rate based on the information available at commencement 
date  is used in determining the present value of the lease  payments.  A lease  term  may  include an option  to extend or 
terminate the lease when it is reasonably certain the option will be exercised. Short-term leases of 12 months or less are 
excluded from accounting guidance; as a result, the lease payments are recognized on a straight-line basis over the lease 
term and the leases are not reflected on the Company’s Consolidated Balance Sheets. Renewal and termination options are 
considered when determining short-term leases. Leases are accounted for on an individual lease level.  

Other Real Estate Owned: Assets acquired through, or in lieu of, loan foreclosure are held for sale and are initially 
recorded at fair value, less selling costs, at the  date  of foreclosure, establishing a new cost basis in the asset. Physical 
possession of residential real estate property collateralizing a residential mortgage loan occurs when legal title is obtained 
upon  completion  of  foreclosure  or  when  the  borrower  conveys  all  interest  in  the  property  to  satisfy  the  loan  through 
completion of a deed in lieu of foreclosure or through similar legal agreement. Subsequent to foreclosure, valuations are 
periodically performed by management, with any subsequent declines in value recorded as a charge to expense through an 
impairment recorded directly against the other real estate owned assets. Changes in the valuation allowance are recorded 
as provision for losses on other real estate owned. Revenue and expenses from operations related to other real estate owned 
are included in the provision on other real estate owned line of the Consolidated Statements of Income.  

Company-Owned  Life  Insurance:  The  Company  has  purchased  life  insurance  policies  on  certain  current  and 
former officers and key employees. Company-owned life insurance is recorded at the amount that can be realized under 
the  insurance  contract  at  the  balance  sheet  date,  which  is  the  cash  surrender  value  adjusted  for  other  charges  or  other 
amounts due that are probable at settlement.  

F-13 

Mortgage Banking Derivatives: Commitments to fund mortgage loans (interest rate locks and forward delivery 
commitments) to be sold in the secondary market for the future delivery of these loans are accounted for as free standing 
derivatives. The fair value of the interest rate lock is recorded at the time the commitment to fund the mortgage loan is 
executed and is adjusted for the expected exercise of the commitment before the loan is funded. In order to hedge the 
change in interest rates resulting from its commitments to fund the loans, the Company enters into forward commitments 
for future delivery of mortgage loans when interest rate locks are entered into. Fair values of these mortgage derivatives 
are estimated based on changes in mortgage interest rates from the date the interest on the loan is locked. Changes in the 
fair values of these derivatives are included in the Net gains on mortgage loans line of the Consolidated Statements of 
Income. 

Stock-Based Compensation: The Company has stock-based compensation plans that provide for the granting of 
stock options, restricted stock awards, restricted stock units and performance stock units to associates and non-associate 
directors who perform services for the Company. The Company estimates the fair value of its stock option awards on the 
date of grant using the Black-Scholes option-pricing model. The Company determines the fair value of the restricted and 
performance stock units as well as restricted stock awards based on the estimated market value of the underlying shares at 
the date of grant.  

Compensation cost is recognized over the required service period, generally defined as the vesting period. For 
awards with graded vesting, compensation cost is recognized on a straight-line basis over the requisite service period for 
the entire award. The Company’s policy is to recognize forfeitures as they occur. 

Income Taxes: Income tax expense is the total of the current year income tax due and the change in the deferred 
tax assets and liabilities. Deferred income tax assets and liabilities are determined using the liability method. Under this 
method, the net deferred tax asset or liability is determined based on the tax effects of temporary differences between the 
book and tax basis of the various balance sheet assets and liabilities and gives current recognition to changes in tax rates 
and laws. A valuation allowance, if needed, reduces deferred tax assets to the amount expected to be realized.  

The Company recognizes tax benefits from uncertain tax positions when it is more-likely-than-not, based on the 
technical merits of the position, the tax position will be sustained upon examination, including the resolution of any appeals 
or litigation. Tax benefits recognized in the consolidated financial statements from such a position are measured as the 
largest benefit that has a greater than fifty percent likelihood of being realized upon resolution. 

The Company may from time to time be assessed interest or penalties by major tax jurisdictions, although any 
such assessments have historically been minimal and immaterial to financial results. The Company classifies interest and 
penalties, if any, as a component of income tax expense.  

Comprehensive Income: Comprehensive income consists of net income and other comprehensive income. Other 
comprehensive income includes unrealized gains and losses on securities available-for-sale, net of taxes, which is also 
recognized as a separate component of equity.  

Earnings  per  Common  Share:  Earnings  per  common  share  is  computed  by  dividing  net  income  available  to 
common shareholders by the weighted average number of shares outstanding during each period. See Note 13 – Earnings 
Per  Common  Share  for  the  common  share  equivalents  that  have  been  included  and  excluded  from  the  calculation  of 
earnings per common share. 

Loan Commitments and Related Financial Instruments: Financial instruments include  off-balance sheet credit 
instruments, such as unused lines of credit, commitments to make loans and commercial and standby letters of credit. The 
face amount for these items represents the exposure to loss, before considering customer collateral or ability to repay. Such 
financial instruments are recorded when they are funded.  

Loss  Contingencies:  Loss  contingencies,  including  claims  and  legal  actions  arising  in  the  ordinary  course  of 
business, are recorded as liabilities when the likelihood of loss is probable and an amount or range of loss can be reasonably 
estimated. Management does not believe there are such matters that will have a material effect on the consolidated financial 
statements. 

F-14 

Deposits:  Deposit  products  include  money  market  accounts,  demand  deposit  accounts,  time-deposit  accounts 
(typically certificates of deposit), NOW accounts (interest checking accounts), and savings accounts. Our accounts are 
federally insured by the FDIC up to the legal maximum amount. 

Borrowings:  Short-term  and  long-term  borrowing  sources  utilized  to  supplement  deposits  and  meet  liquidity 
needs. A blanket pledge and security agreement is in place  with FHLB that requires certain loans and securities to be 
pledged  as  collateral  for  any  outstanding  borrowings  under  the  agreement.  Our  borrowing  facilities  include  various 
financial and other covenants, including, but not limited to, a requirement that the Bank maintains regulatory capital that 
is deemed "well capitalized" by federal banking agencies. 

Fair  Value  of  Financial  Instruments:  Fair  values  of  financial  instruments  are  estimated  using  relevant  market 
information  and  other  assumptions,  as  more  fully  disclosed  in  Note 17  –  Fair  Value.  Fair  value  estimates  involve 
uncertainties  and  matters  of  significant  judgment  regarding  interest  rates,  credit  risk,  prepayments,  and  other  factors, 
especially in the absence of broad markets for particular items. Changes in assumptions or in market conditions could 
significantly affect these estimates.  

Revenue  Recognition:  In  accordance  with  the  Financial  Accounting  Standards  Board  ("FASB"),  Revenue 
Contracts  with  Customers  ("Topic  606"),  trust  and  investment  management  fees  are  earned  by  providing  trust  and 
investment services to customers. The Company’s performance obligation under these contracts is satisfied over time as 
the  services  are  provided.  Fees  are  recognized monthly  based  on  the  average monthly  value  of  the  assets  under 
management and the corresponding fee rate based on the terms of the contract. Performance based incentive fees earned 
with respect to investment management contracts for the year ended December 31, 2019 were immaterial. No performance 
based incentive fees were earned for the year ended December 31, 2020. Receivables are recorded on the Consolidated 
Balance Sheets in the Accounts receivable line item. Income related to trust and investment management fees, bank fees, 
and risk management and insurance fees on the Consolidated Statements of Income for the years ended December 31, 2020 
and 2019 are considered in scope of Topic 606. 

Transition of LIBOR to an Alternative Reference Rate: In July 2017, the United Kingdom's Financial Conduct 
Authority, which regulates the  London Interbank Offered Rate ("LIBOR") announced that after 2021 it will no longer 
persuade or compel banks to submit rates for the calculation of LIBOR. In response, the Federal Reserve Board and the 
Federal Reserve Bank of New York convened the Alternative Reference Rates Committee to identify a set of alternative 
reference  interest  rates  for  possible  use  as  market  benchmarks.  This  committee  has  proposed  the  Secured  Overnight 
Financing Rate ("SOFR") as its recommended alternative to U.S. dollar LIBOR, and the Federal Reserve Bank of New 
York began publishing SOFR rates in the second quarter of 2018. SOFR  is based on a broad segment of the overnight 
Treasury repurchase  market and is intended to be a measure  of the cost of borrowing cash overnight collateralized by 
Treasury securities. 

Certain of the Company’s assets and liabilities are indexed to LIBOR, with exposure extending past December 
31,  2021.  The  Company  is  currently  evaluating  and  planning  for  the  eventual  replacement  of  the  LIBOR  benchmark 
interest rate, including the possibility of SOFR as the dominant replacement. In general, the transition away from LIBOR 
may result in increased market risk, credit risk, operational risk and business risk for the Company. The Company has 
developed  a  LIBOR  transition  plan,  which  addresses  governance,  risk  management,  legal,  operational,  systems  and 
operations,  fallback  language,  and  other  aspects  of  planning. The  Company  has  prepared  a  timeline  to  transition  from 
LIBOR before the end of 2021. 

Restrictions on Cash: During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve 
System reduced reserve requirement ratios to zero percent. This action eliminated reserve requirements for all depository 
institutions. 

Reclassifications:  Certain  items  in  prior  year  financial  statements  were  reclassified  to  conform  to  the  current 

presentation. Such reclassifications had no impact on net income or total shareholders’ equity.  

Recently adopted accounting pronouncements: The following reflect recent accounting pronouncements that have 

been adopted by the Company during the Company’s fiscal year ended December 31, 2020. 

F-15 

In  August  2018,  the  FASB  issued  ASU  2018-13,  Fair  Value  Measurement—Changes  to  the  Disclosure 
Requirements  for  Fair  Value  Measurement  (Topic  820)  ("ASU  2018-13").  ASU  2018-13  modifies  the  disclosure 
requirements on fair value measurements by requiring that Level 3 fair value disclosures include the range and weighted 
average of significant unobservable inputs used to develop those fair value measurements. For certain unobservable inputs, 
an entity may disclose other quantitative information in  lieu of the weighted average if the entity determines that other 
quantitative information would be a more reasonable and rational method to reflect the distribution of unobservable inputs 
used to develop Level 3 fair value measurements. ASU 2018-13 was effective for the Company on January 1, 2020 and 
did not have a material impact on the Company’s financial statement disclosures. 

In April 2020, the FASB issued ASU 2020-04, "Reference Rate Reform (Topic 848): Facilitation of the Effects 
of  Reference  Rate  Reform  on  Financial  Reporting." ("ASU  2020-04"),  ASU  2020-04  is  intended  to  provide  relief  for 
companies preparing for discontinuation of interest rates based on LIBOR. The ASU provides optional expedients and 
exceptions for applying GAAP to contract modifications and hedging relationships, subject to meeting certain criteria, that 
reference LIBOR or other reference rates expected to be discontinued. ASU 2020-04 also provides for a one-time sale 
and/or transfer to available-for-sale or trading to be made for held-to-maturity debt securities that both reference an eligible 
reference rate and were classified as held-to-maturity before January 1, 2020. ASU 2020-04 was effective for all entities 
as of March 12, 2020 and through December 31, 2022. Companies can apply the ASU as of the beginning of the interim 
period  that  includes  March  12,  2020  or  any  date  thereafter.  The  guidance  requires  companies  to  apply  the  guidance 
prospectively to contract modifications and hedging relationships while the one-time election to sell and/or transfer debt 
securities classified as held-to-maturity may be made any time after March 12, 2020. ASU 2020-04 was effective for the 
Company on March 12, 2020 and did not have a material impact on the Company’s financial statement disclosures. 

Recently issued accounting pronouncements, not yet adopted: The following reflects pending pronouncements 

with an update to the expected impact since the end of the Company’s fiscal year ended December 31, 2020. 

In  February  2016,  the  FASB  issued  ASU  2016-13,  Financial  Instruments—Credit  Losses  (Topic  326) 
Measurement  of  Credit  Losses  on  Financial  Instruments,  as  amended  ("ASU  2016-13").  ASU  2016-13  replaces  the 
incurred loss model with an expected loss model, which is referred to as the current expected credit loss ("CECL") model. 
The CECL model is applicable to the measurement of credit losses on the financial assets measured at amortized cost, 
including loan receivables, held-to-maturity debt securities, and reinsurance receivables. It also applies to off-balance sheet 
credit exposures not accounted for as insurance (loan commitments, standby letters of credit, financial guarantees, and 
other similar instruments) and net investments in leases recognized by a lessor. For all other assets within the scope of 
CECL, a cumulative-effect adjustment will be recognized in retained earnings and the allowance for loan losses as of the 
beginning of the first reporting period in which the guidance is effective. ASU 2016-13 was set to be effective for most 
public companies on January 1, 2020. However, at the October 16, 2019 FASB meeting, the FASB voted unanimously to 
delay the effective date of CECL adoption for smaller reporting companies ("SRCs") to January 1, 2023.  

During the year ended December 31, 2020, the CECL committee of the Company continued to work through its 
implementation  plan.  The  Company  has  integrated  historical  and  current  loan  level  data  as  required  by  CECL  and  is 
working with its third-party vendor solution to begin evaluating the methodologies available under the CECL model on 
its  loan  portfolios.  The  Company  also  continues  to  evaluate  documentation  requirements,  internal  control  structure, 
relevant data sources, and system configurations. The Company has completed a successful integration of the required 
fields and historical data for key loan, client and collateral data within the third-party solution and has been able to run 
parallels of our current allowance for loan losses calculation in the software to compare to our internal calculation and 
reconcile known differences. The Company has started the process of selecting the methodologies to be used for each 
segment of its loan portfolio and started preliminarily testing to determine the impact of each methodology. Currently, we 
are  unable  to  estimate  the  impact  the  adoption  of  this  update  will  have  on  the  consolidated  financial  statements  and 
disclosures. However, the Company expects the impact of the adoption will be significantly influenced by the composition 
and characteristics of its loan portfolios along with economic conditions prevalent as of the date of adoption. The Company 
expects to implement the new standard beginning January 1, 2023. 

In January 2017, the FASB issued ASU 2017-04, Intangibles—Goodwill and Other (Topic 350): Simplifying the Test for 
Goodwill Impairment ("ASU 2017-04"), which amended existing guidance to simplify the subsequent measurement of 
goodwill by eliminating Step 2 from the goodwill impairment test. The amendments require an entity to perform its annual, 

F-16 

 
or  interim,  goodwill  impairment  test  by  comparing  the  fair  value  of  a  reporting  unit  with  its  carrying  amount  and 
recognizing an impairment charge of the amount by which the carrying amount exceeds the reporting unit’s fair value, not 
to  exceed  the  total  amount  of  goodwill  allocated  to  that  reporting  unit.  ASU  2017-04  was  set  to  be  effective  for  the 
Company on January 1, 2021. However, ASU 2019-10 amended the mandatory effective date for ASU 2014-07 to January 
1, 2023 for SRC’s, with earlier adoption permitted. This update is not expected to have a significant impact on the financial 
statements and disclosures. 

NOTE 2 – ACQUISITIONS 

On February 10, 2020, the Company entered into a branch purchase and assumption agreement with Simmons 
Bank, a subsidiary of Simmons First National Corporation, to acquire all of the Simmons’ Colorado locations, including 
three branches and one loan production office located in Denver, as well as certain deposits, loans and other assets and 
liabilities. The transaction closed on May 15, 2020 with an aggregate purchase price of $61.6 million, including a deposit 
premium of 6.06%. 

During the third quarter 2020, the Company closed two of the branches and the loan production office acquired 

in the Branch Acquisition. 

Goodwill of $4.5 million was recognized in the transaction and represents expected synergies and cost savings 

resulting from combining the expanded footprint and expertise of the associates. 

The following table summarizes the estimated fair values of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed in the 
May 15, 2020 transaction with Simmons, and reflects all adjustments made to the fair value of the opening balance sheet 
through December 31, 2020 (in thousands): 

Fair value of consideration transferred 

Cash consideration 

Total fair value of consideration transferred 

Assets acquired 

Cash and due from banks 
Loans, net 
Core deposit intangible(1) 
Accrued income and other assets 

Total assets acquired 

Liabilities assumed 

Deposits 
Accrued expenses and other liabilities 

Total liabilities assumed 
Net assets acquired 
Goodwill recognized 

May 15, 
2020 

 61,599 
 61,599 

 283 
 119,552 
 53 
 382 
 120,270 

 63,080 
 96 
 63,176 
 57,094 
4,505 

$ 

$ 

_____________________________________ 
(1)  

The core deposit intangible was determined to have an estimated life of 10 years. 

The fair value of net assets acquired includes fair value adjustments to loans as of the acquisition date. The fair 
value adjustments were determined using discounted expected cash flows. Loans had a fair value of $119.6 million and a 
contractual balance of $120.6 million as of May 15, 2020. The discount on the loans acquired in this transaction due to 
anticipated credit loss, as well as considerations for market interest rates, totaled $1.1 million, representing 0.9% of their 
contractual  balances.  No  allowance  for  loan  losses  related  to  acquired  loans  was  recorded  as  a  result  of  the  Branch 
Acquisition. Loans acquired included short-term modifications made on a good faith basis by Simmons, in response to 

F-17 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
COVID-19. All of the modification were given additional review prior to the closing of the purchase and management 
determined that loans were performing prior to modification and were not considered impaired at purchase. There were 
no loans acquired that were considered to be purchased credit impaired ("PCI") loans. 

The composition of the acquired loan portfolio as of May 15, 2020 is detailed in the table below (in thousands): 

Cash, Securities and Other(1) 
Construction and Development 
1-4 Family Residential 
Non-Owner Occupied CRE 
Owner Occupied CRE 
Commercial and Industrial 
Total gross loans 
_____________________________________ 
(1)  
Includes $12.9 million in PPP loans. 

May 15, 
2020 

 13,457 
 40,407 
 7,252 
 545 
 321 
 58,660 
 120,642 

$ 

$ 

The Company incurred $0.9 million in expenses related to the acquisition during the year ended December 31, 
2020.  Acquisition  expenses,  including  professional  fees,  are  included  in  the  Total  non-interest  expense  line  of  the 
Consolidated Statements of Income. 

NOTE 3 - INVESTMENT SECURITIES 

The following presents the amortized cost and fair value of securities available-for-sale, with gross unrealized 
gains and losses recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income as of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019 
(in thousands): 

December 31, 2020 
Investment securities available-for-sale: 

U.S. Treasury debt 
Corporate bonds 
Government National Mortgage Association ("GNMA") 
mortgage-backed securities – residential 
Federal National Mortgage Association ("FNMA") mortgage-
backed securities – residential 
Corporate collateralized mortgage obligations ("CMO") and 
mortgage-backed securities ("MBS") 
Total securities available-for-sale 

December 31, 2019 
Investment securities available-for-sale: 

U.S. Treasury debt 
GNMA mortgage-backed securities – residential 
FNMA mortgage-backed securities – residential 
CMO and MBS 

Total securities available-for-sale 

Amortized   
Cost 

Gross 
Unrealized   
Gains 

Gross 
Unrealized   
Losses 

Fair 
Value 

  $ 

 250   $ 

 6,000  

 4   $ 
 55  

 —   $ 

 (11)  

 254 
 6,044 

 23,806  

 798  

 1,616  

 4,078  

 61  

 62  

  $ 

 35,750   $ 

 980   $ 

 —  

 —  

 24,604 

 1,677 

 (53)  
 (64)   $ 

 4,087 
 36,666 

Amortized   
Cost 

Gross 
Unrealized   
Gains 

Gross 
Unrealized   
Losses 

Fair 
Value 

  $ 

 250   $ 

 4   $ 

 45,490  
 2,935  
 10,425  
 59,100   $ 

 157  
 11  
 40  

 212   $ 

  $ 

 —   $ 

 (335)  
 (29)  
 (45)  
 (409)   $ 

 254 
 45,312 
 2,917 
 10,420 
 58,903 

Net  amortization  of  premiums  and  discounts  related  to  mortgage  securities  during  each  of  the  years  ended 

December 31, 2020 and 2019 was $0.4 million and $0.2 million, respectively, and is included in net interest income.  

F-18 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
       
 
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
       
 
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
     
 
     
 
     
 
   
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
As  of  December 31, 2020,  the  amortized  cost  and  estimated  fair  value  of  available-for-sale  securities  have 
contractual  maturity  dates  shown  in  the  table  below  (in  thousands).  Expected  maturities  will  differ  from  contractual 
maturities because borrowers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties. 
Securities not due at a single maturity date are shown separately.  

December 31, 2020 
Due within one year 
Due between one year and five years 
Due between five years and ten years 
Securities (agency, CMO, and MBS) 

Total 

      Amortized 

Cost 

  $ 

  $ 

 250   $ 

 1,250  
 4,750  
 29,500  
 35,750   $ 

Fair 
Value 

 254 
 1,245 
 4,799 
 30,368 
 36,666 

In 2014, the Company began investing in a small business investment company ("SBIC") fund administered by 
the Small Business Administration. During the years ended 2020 and 2019, the Company invested $0.5 million and $0.4 
million, respectively, in SBIC. As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, the Company held a balance of $2.1 million and $1.6 
million, respectively, with SBIC, which is included in Other assets in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets. The 
Company may be obligated to invest up to an additional $0.9 million in future SBIC investments. 

As  of  December 31, 2020  and  December 31, 2019,  securities  with  carrying  values  totaling  $3.7 million  and 

$5.5 million, respectively, were pledged to secure various public deposits and credit facilities of the Company. 

As of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, there were no holdings of securities of any one issuer, other 

than the U.S. Government sponsored entities and agencies, in an amount greater than 10% of shareholders’ equity. 

As  of  December 31, 2020  and  December 31, 2019,  seven  securities  and  twenty-six  securities  were  in  an 
unrealized loss position, with unrealized losses totaling $0.1 million and $0.4 million, respectively. Two of the securities 
in an unrealized loss position as of December 31, 2020 have been in a continuous unrealized loss position for more than 
twelve months, and the remaining have been in a continuous unrealized loss position for less than twelve months. The 
unrealized loss positions were caused primarily by interest rate changes and market assumptions about prepayments of 
principal and interest on the underlying mortgages. Because the decline in market value is attributable to market conditions, 
not credit quality, and because the Company has the ability and intent to hold these investments until a recovery of fair 
value, which may be near or at maturity, the Company does not consider these investments to be other-than-temporarily 
impaired as of December 31, 2020. 

The  following 

losses  as  of  December 31, 2020  and 
December 31, 2019, aggregated by  major security type and length of time  in a continuous  unrealized loss position (in 
thousands, before tax): 

table  summarizes  securities  with  unrealized 

December 31, 2020 
Corporate bonds 
Corporate CMO and MBS 

Total 

December 31, 2019 
GNMA mortgage-backed securities - residential 
FNMA mortgage-backed securities - residential 
Corporate CMO and MBS 

Total 

      Less than 12 Months 

  Unrealized   
  Losses 

      12 Months or Longer       
  Unrealized   
  Losses 

Fair 
  Value 

Fair 
  Value 

Total 

  Unrealized 
      Losses 

 (11)  
 (40)  
 (51)   $ 

 —  
 566  
 566   $ 

 3,489  
    1,446  

 —  
 (13)  
 (13)   $   4,935   $ 

 (11) 
 (53) 
 (64) 

Fair 
Value 
 3,489  
 880  

  $  4,369   $ 

Total 

  Unrealized 

      Losses 

Fair 
      Value 
 (142)   $  32,653   $ 
 (29)  
 —  

 2,347  
 7,780  

 (171)   $  42,780   $ 

 (335) 
 (29) 
 (45) 
 (409) 

      Less than 12 Months 

Fair 
      Value 
  $  28,203   $ 

  Unrealized   
  Losses 

      12 Months or Longer       
  Unrealized   
  Losses 

Fair 
  Value 
 (193)   $  4,450   $ 

 —  
 7,780  
  $  35,983   $ 

 —  
 (45)  
 (238)   $  6,797   $ 

 2,347  
 —  

F-19 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
The Company did  not sell any securities during the  year ended December 31, 2020. The Company sold  $7.5 
million of securities, realized $0.1 million of gains, and realized no losses, from the sale of securities using the specific 
identification method for the year ended December 31, 2019. 

NOTE 4 – CORRESPONDENT BANK STOCK 

The following presents the Company’s investments in correspondent bank stock, as of the dates noted (in 

thousands): 

FHLB 
BBW 
Total 

December 31,  

2020 

2019 

  $ 

  $ 

 2,522   $ 
 30  
 2,552   $ 

 559 
 26 
 585 

NOTE 5 - LOANS AND THE ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN LOSSES 

The following presents a summary of the Company’s loans as of the dates noted (in thousands): 

Cash, Securities and Other(1) 
Construction and Development 
1-4 Family Residential 
Non-Owner Occupied CRE 
Owner Occupied CRE 
Commercial and Industrial(2) 

Total loans held for investment 

Deferred costs (fees) and unamortized premiums/(unaccreted discounts), net 
Allowance for loan losses 
Loans, net 
______________________________________ 
(1) Includes PPP loans of $142.9 million as of December 31, 2020. 
(2) Includes MSLP loans of $6.6 million as of December 31, 2020. 

December 31,  
2020 
 357,020   $ 
 131,111  
 455,038  
 281,943  
 163,042  
 146,031  
 1,534,185  
 (1,352)  
 (12,539)  
 1,520,294   $ 

December 31,  
2019 
 146,701 
 28,120 
 400,134 
 165,179 
 127,968 
 128,457 
 996,559 
 1,448 
 (7,875) 
 990,132 

  $ 

  $ 

As of December 31, 2020, total loans held for investment include $127.2 million of performing loans purchased 

as part of the Branch Acquisition. See Note 2 – Acquisitions for more information. 

The CARES Act created the PPP, which is administered by the SBA. The PPP is intended to provide loans to 
small businesses to pay their employees, rent, mortgage interest and utilities. The loans may be forgiven conditioned upon 
the client providing payroll documentation evidencing their compliant  use of  funds and  otherwise complying  with the 
terms of the program. The Bank is an approved SBA lender and as of December 31, 2020, the Cash, Securities and Other 
portion of the loan portfolio included $142.9 million of PPP loans, or 40.0% of the total category.  

The Company is a participant in the Federal Reserve’s MSLP to support lending to small and medium-sized for 
profit businesses and nonprofit organizations that were in sound financial condition before the onset of the COVID-19 
pandemic. As of December 31, 2020, the Company’s Commercial and Industrial loans included six MSLP loan with the 
net carrying amount of $6.6 million, or 4.5% of the total category. 

Loan Modifications 

As a result of the COVID-19 pandemic, a loan modification program was designed and implemented to assist our 
clients experiencing financial stress resulting from the economic impacts caused by the global pandemic. The Company 
offered loan extensions, temporary payment moratoriums, and financial covenant waivers for commercial and consumer 

F-20 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
borrowers impacted by the pandemic who have a pass risk rating and have not been delinquent over 30 days on payments 
in the last two years. 

During  2020,  the  Company’s  loan  portfolio  included  89  loans  which  were  modified  during  the  year,  totaling 
$160.8 million. Two of these loans were still in their deferral period as of December 31, 2020 in the amount of $2.1 million. 

The following presents loans in their deferral period under the Company’s COVID-19 loan modification program 

as of December 31, 2020 (dollars in thousands): 

Cash, Securities and Other 
Construction and Development 
1-4 Family Residential 
Non-Owner Occupied CRE 
Owner Occupied CRE 
Commercial and Industrial 

Total Loans 

Total Loans 

$ 

 357,020  
 131,111  
 455,038  
 281,943  
 163,042  
 146,031  
$   1,534,185  

# of Loans 
Modified 

 —  
 —  
 1  
 —  
 1  
 —  
 2  

Outstanding 
Balance of 
Modified Loans  
 —  
$ 
 —  
 346  
 —  
 1,716  
 —  
 2,062  

$ 

% of Total 
Loan Balance 
Modified 

 — % 
 —  
 0.02  
 —  
 0.11  
 —  
 0.13 % 

The CARES Act provides banks optional, temporary relief from accounting for certain loan modifications as a 
TDR. The modifications must be related to the adverse effects of COVID-19, and certain other criteria are required to be 
met in order to apply the relief. Interagency guidance from Federal Reserve and the FDIC confirmed with the FASB that 
short-term modifications made on a good faith basis in response to COVID-19 to borrowers who were current prior to any 
relief, are not to be considered TDRs. We believe our loan modification program meets that definition. In accordance with 
that guidance, the Company is recognizing interest income on all loans modified for temporary payment moratoriums, 
primarily for a period of 180 days or less. 

All loans modified in response to COVID-19 are classified as performing and pass rated as of December 31, 2020. 
These loans are included in the allowance for loan loss general reserve in accordance with ASC 450-20. Management has 
increased our loan level reviews and portfolio monitoring to address the changing environment. The Company continues 
to meet regularly with clients who could be more highly impacted by the recent COVID-19 pandemic. These are borrowers 
in accommodations, transportation and restaurant industries, which we believe may be more impacted by the pandemic, 
and those loans where there may be a greater than 50% probability of a downgrade, covenant violation or 20% reduction 
in collateral position. The portion of our credit exposure to the highest risk industries impacted by COVID-19, such as 
accommodations, transportation and restaurants, is less than 3.0% of our loan portfolio. Management believes the diversity 
of the loan portfolio is prudent and remains consistent with the credit culture and goals of the Bank. 

F-21 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest accrued during the modification term on modified loans is deferred to the end of the loan term. As of 
December 31, 2020, no allowance for loan loss was deemed necessary on the accrued interest balances related to loan 
modifications. 

The  following  presents,  by  class,  an  aging  analysis  of  the  recorded  investments  (excluding  accrued  interest 
receivable, deferred costs (fees), and unamortized premiums/ (unaccreted discounts) which are not material) in loans past 
due as of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019 (in thousands): 

December 31, 2020 
Cash, Securities and Other 
Construction and Development 
1-4 Family Residential 
Non-Owner Occupied CRE 
Owner Occupied CRE 
Commercial and Industrial 

Total 

December 31, 2019 
Cash, Securities and Other 
Construction and Development 
1-4 Family Residential 
Non-Owner Occupied CRE 
Owner Occupied CRE 
Commercial and Industrial 

Total 

      60-89 
Days 

      30-59 
Days 

      Total 
Loans 

      90 or 
  More Days  

Total 
Recorded 
Investment 
  Past Due   Past Due   Past Due    Past Due   
 800   $   356,220   $   357,020 
 —   $ 
  $ 
 131,111 
 —  
 455,038 
 —  
 281,943 
 —  
 163,042 
 —  
 —  
 146,031 
 —   $   3,577   $   6,362   $  1,527,823   $  1,534,185 

 752   $ 
 —  
   1,283  
 —  
 479  
 271  
  $  2,785   $ 

 48   $ 
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 3,529  

 131,111  
 453,755  
 281,943  
 162,563  
 142,231  

 —  
 1,283  
 —  
 479  
 3,800  

Current 

      30-59 
Days 

      60-89 
Days 

90 or 

  More Days  

  Past Due    Past Due   
 525   $ 
  $ 
 —  
    5,688  
 —  
 —  
 —  

 —   $ 
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
    3,110  

  $   6,213   $   3,110   $ 

Past Due    Past Due   

Current 

      Total 
Loans 

      Total 
  Recorded 
Investment 
 525   $  146,176   $  146,701 
 —   $ 
 28,120 
 28,120  
 —  
   400,134 
   394,446  
 —  
   165,179 
   165,179  
 —  
   127,968 
   127,968  
 —  
 907  
   128,457 
   124,440  
 907   $  10,230   $  986,329   $  996,559 

 —  
 5,688  
 —  
 —  
 4,017  

As of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, the Company did not have any loans which were more than 

90 days delinquent and accruing interest. 

 Non-Accrual Loans and Troubled Debt Restructurings 

The following presents the recorded investment in non-accrual loans by class as of the dates noted (in thousands): 

Cash, Securities and Other 
Owner Occupied CRE 
Commercial and Industrial 

Total 

  December 31,   

2020 

December 31,  
2019 

  $ 

  $ 

 50   $ 

 479  
 3,529  
 4,058   $ 

 2,803 
 — 
 4,412 
 7,215 

Non-accrual loans classified as TDR accounted for $3.6 million of the recorded investment as of December 31, 
2020  and  $7.2  million  as  of  December 31, 2019,  respectively.  Non-accrual  loans  are  classified  as  impaired  loans  and 
individually evaluated for impairment. 

F-22 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
      
 
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
      
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
The following presents a summary of the unpaid principal balance of loans classified as TDRs as of the dates 

noted (in thousands): 

Accruing 

Commercial and Industrial 

Non-accrual 

Cash, Securities, and Other 
Commercial and Industrial 

Total  
Allowance for loan losses associated with TDR 

Net recorded investment 

December 31,    
2020 

December 31,  
2019 

$ 

 —  

$ 

 5,055 

 48  
 3,529  
 3,577  
 (1,619)  
 1,958  

$ 

 2,803 
 4,412 
 12,270 
 (833) 
 11,437 

$ 

As  of  December  31,  2019,  the  Company  extended  additional  principal  allowed  under  the  commitment  to  a 
Commercial and Industrial borrower for operational needs, subsequent to the loan being classified as a TDR, in the amount 
of $0.2 million. This loan was fully paid off as of December 31, 2020.  

The Company modified one loan into a TDR during the year ended December 31, 2020. The Borrower was having 
difficulty making payments in accordance with the original contract terms. The Company restructured the loan including 
receiving a large paydown and extended the maturity and lowered the interest rate as a result of the Borrower’s financial 
difficulties. The loan paid off in full as of December 31, 2020. 

The  Company  modified  one  borrower  relationship  with  two  loans  into  a  TDR  for  the  year  ended 
December 31, 2019.  The  borrower,  who  has  loans  that  are  classified  as  Commercial  and  Industrial,  was  not  making 
payments in accordance with the original contract terms. The modification included an extension of the maturity date that 
the Company would not have otherwise considered as a result of the Borrower’s financial difficulties. The extension of 
maturity was for a period of approximately nine months. These two loans are currently on non-accrual and the borrower 
was not making payments as agreed for the year ended December 31, 2020. 

TDRs  are  reviewed  individually  for  impairment  and  are  included  in  the  Company’s  specific  reserves  in  the 
allowance for loan losses. If charged off, the amount of the charge off is included in the Company’s charge off factors, 
which impact the Company’s reserves on non-impaired loans. 

F-23 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
The  following  table  presents  impaired  loans  by  portfolio  and  related  valuation  allowance  as  of  the  periods 

presented (in thousands): 

December 31, 2020 
      Unpaid 
  Contractual  
Principal   
Balance 

      Allowance   
for 
Loan 
Losses 

Total 
  Recorded   
Investment  

      Allowance 

December 31, 2019 
      Unpaid 
  Contractual  
Principal   
Balance 

for 
Loan 
Losses 

Total 
  Recorded   
Investment  

Impaired loans with a valuation allowance: 
Cash, Securities, and Other 
Commercial and Industrial 

Total 

Impaired loans with no related valuation allowance: 
Cash, Securities, and Other 
Owner Occupied CRE 
Commercial and Industrial 

Total 

Total impaired loans: 
Cash, Securities, and Other 
Owner Occupied CRE 
Commercial and Industrial 

Total 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

 2    $ 

 2    $ 

 3,419   
 3,421    $ 

 3,419   
 3,421    $ 

 2   $ 

 1,619  
 1,621   $ 

 —   $ 

 —   $ 

 4,412   
 4,412    $ 

 4,412   
 4,412    $ 

 — 
 833 
 833 

 48    $ 
 479   
 110   
 637    $ 

 48    $ 
 479   
 110   
 637    $ 

 —   $ 
 —  
 —  
 —   $ 

 2,803    $ 
 —  
 5,055   
 7,858    $ 

 2,803    $ 
 —  
 5,055   
 7,858    $ 

 — 
 — 
 — 
 — 

 50    $ 

 479   
 3,529   
 4,058    $ 

 50    $ 

 479   
 3,529   
 4,058    $ 

 2 
 — 
 1,619 
 1,621 

 $ 

 $ 

 2,803    $ 
 —  
 9,467   
 12,270    $ 

 2,803    $ 
 —  
 9,467   
 12,270    $ 

 — 
 — 
 833 
 833 

The  recorded  investment  in  loans  in  the  previous  tables  excludes  accrued  interest,  deferred  costs  (fees)  and 
unamortized premiums/ (unaccreted discounts) which are not material. Interest income, if any, was recognized on the cash 
basis on non-accrual loans. 

The average balance of impaired loans and interest income recognized on impaired loans during the years ended 

December 31, 2020 and 2019 are included in the table below (in thousands): 

Impaired loans with a valuation allowance: 
Cash, Securities, and Other 
Commercial and Industrial 
Total 

Impaired loans with no related valuation allowance: 
Cash, Securities, and Other 
Owner Occupied CRE 
Commercial and Industrial 
Total 

Total impaired loans: 
Cash, Securities, and Other 
Owner Occupied CRE 
Commercial and Industrial 

Total 

December 31,  

2020 

2019 

Average 
Recorded 
Investment    Recognized   

Interest 
Income 

Average 
Recorded 
Investment    Recognized 

Interest 
Income 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

 1    $ 

 3,453   
 3,454    $ 

 1,180    $ 
 96   
 4,893   
 6,169    $ 

 1,181    $ 
 96   
 8,346   
 9,623    $ 

 —  
 —  
 —  

 —  
 —  
 336  
 336  

 — 
 — 
 336 
 336 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 $ 

 $ 

 —   $ 

 1,686   
 1,686    $ 

 6,217    $ 
 —  
 4,499   
 10,716    $ 

 6,217    $ 
 —  
 6,185   
 12,402    $ 

 — 
 — 
 — 

 — 
 — 
 427 
 427 

 — 
 — 
 427 
 427 

F-24 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
      
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
 
  
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
 
  
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
Allowance for Loan Losses 

Allocation of a portion of the allowance for loan losses to one category of loans does not preclude its availability 
to absorb losses in other categories. The following presents the activity in the Company’s allowance for loan losses by 
portfolio class for the periods presented (in thousands): 

 Construction  
Cash, 
  Securities  
and  
     and Other  Development   Residential  

1-4 
Family 

  Non-Owner   Owner     Commercial  
  Occupied    Occupied  

and  
  Industrial   

CRE 

CRE 

Total 

Changes in allowance for loan losses for the year 
ended December 31, 2020 

Beginning balance 
Provision for loan losses 
Charge-offs 
Recoveries 
Ending balance 

  $ 

  $ 

 1,058   $ 
 1,539     
 (31)    
 13     
 2,579   $ 

 200    $ 
 732      
 —      
 —      
 932    $ 

 2,850    $ 
 383      
 —      
 —      
 3,233    $ 

 1,176    $ 
 828      
 —      
 —      
 2,004    $ 

 911    $ 
 248      
 —      
 —      
 1,159    $ 

 1,680    $ 
 952      
 —      
 —      
 2,632    $ 

 7,875 
 4,682 
 (31) 
 13 
 12,539 

Allowance for loan losses as of 
December 31, 2020 allocated to loans evaluated 
for impairment: 
Individually 
Collectively 
Ending balance 

  $ 

  $ 

 2   $ 
 2,577     
 2,579   $ 

 —    $ 
 932      
 932    $ 

 —    $ 
 3,233      
 3,233    $ 

 —    $ 
 2,004      
 2,004    $ 

 —    $ 
 1,159      
 1,159    $ 

 1,619    $ 
 1,013      
 2,632    $ 

 1,621 
 10,918 
 12,539 

Loans as of December 31, 2020, evaluated for 
impairment: 
Individually 
Collectively 
Ending balance 

  $ 

 50   $ 
    356,970     
  $  357,020   $ 

 —    $ 

 —    $ 
 —    $ 
 281,464       163,042      
 131,111        455,038      
 131,111    $   455,038    $   281,943    $  163,042    $ 

 479    $ 

 3,529    $ 

 4,058 
 142,502       1,530,127 
 146,031    $  1,534,185 

  Construction  
  Cash, 
and 
  Securities  
     and Other   Development   Residential  

1-4 
Family 

  Non-Owner   Owner    Commercial   
  Occupied    Occupied  

CRE 

CRE 

and 
Industrial   

Total 

Changes in allowance for loan losses for the year 
ended December 31, 2019 

Beginning balance 
Provision for (recovery of) loan losses 
Charge-offs 
Recoveries 
Ending balance 

  $ 

  $ 

 764    $ 
 532      
 (248)     
 10      
 1,058    $ 

 232    $ 
 (32)  
 —   
 —   
 200    $ 

 2,552    $ 
 298   
 —   
 —   
 2,850    $ 

 1,264    $ 
 (88)  
 —   
 —   
 1,176    $ 

 789    $ 
 122      
 —      
 —      
 911    $ 

 1,850    $ 
 (170)  
 —   
 —   
 1,680    $ 

 7,451 
 662 
 (248) 
 10 
 7,875 

Allowance for loan losses as of 
December 31, 2019 allocated to loans evaluated 
for impairment: 
Individually 
Collectively 
Ending balance 

  $ 

  $ 

 —    $ 
 1,058      
 1,058    $ 

 —    $ 

 200   
 200    $ 

 —    $ 

 2,850   
 2,850    $ 

 —    $ 

 1,176   
 1,176    $ 

 —    $ 
 911      
 911    $ 

 833    $ 
 847   
 1,680    $ 

 833 
 7,042 
 7,875 

Loans as of December 31, 2019, evaluated for 
impairment: 
Individually 
Collectively 
Ending balance 

  $ 

 2,803    $ 
    143,898      
  $  146,701    $ 

 —    $ 

 —    $ 
 28,120   
   127,968      
 28,120    $   400,134    $   165,179    $  127,968    $ 

    400,134   

 165,179   

 —    $ 

 —    $ 

 9,467    $   12,270 
 118,990   
   984,289 
 128,457    $  996,559 

The  Company  categorizes  loans  into  risk  categories  based  on  relevant  information  about  the  ability  of  the 
borrowers to service their debt such as: current financial information, historical payment experience, credit documentation, 
public  information,  and  current  economic  trends,  among  other  factors.  The  Company  analyzes  loans  individually  by 
classifying the loans by credit risk on a quarterly basis. The Company uses the following definitions for risk ratings: 

Special Mention—Loans classified as special mention have a potential weakness or borrowing relationships that 
require  more  than  the  usual  amount  of  management  attention.  Adverse  industry  conditions,  deteriorating  financial 
conditions,  declining  trends,  management  problems,  documentation  deficiencies  or  other  similar  weaknesses  may  be 

F-25 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
   
    
    
    
    
    
 
 
  
      
       
       
       
       
       
   
 
  
 
 
 
   
    
    
    
    
    
 
 
  
      
       
       
       
       
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    
  
 
  
 
  
 
    
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
    
  
 
  
 
  
 
    
  
 
 
 
  
       
    
  
    
  
    
  
       
    
  
   
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
    
  
 
  
 
  
 
    
  
 
 
 
  
       
    
  
    
  
    
  
       
    
  
   
 
  
 
evident. Ability to meet current payment schedules may be questionable, even though interest and principal are still being 
paid as agreed. The asset has potential weaknesses that may result in deteriorating repayment prospects if left uncorrected. 
Loans in this risk grade are not considered adversely classified. 

Substandard—Substandard loans are considered  "classified" and are inadequately protected by the current net 
worth  and  paying  capacity  of  the  obligor  or by  the  collateral  pledged,  if  any.  Loans  so  classified  have  a  well-defined 
weakness or weaknesses that jeopardizes the liquidation of the debt. They are characterized by the distinct possibility that 
the bank will sustain some loss if the deficiencies are not corrected. Loans in this category may be placed on non-accrual 
status and may individually be evaluated for impairment if indicators of impairment exist. 

Doubtful—Loans  graded  Doubtful  are  considered  "classified"  and  have  all  the  weaknesses  inherent  in  those 
classified as Substandard with the added characteristic that the weaknesses make collection or liquidation in full, on the 
basis  of  currently  known  facts,  conditions  and  values,  highly  questionable  and  improbable.  However,  the  amount  of 
certainty of eventual loss is not known because of specific pending factors. 

Loans not meeting any of the three criteria above are considered to be pass-rated loans. The following presents, 
by class and by credit quality indicator, the recorded investment in the Company’s loans as  of December 31, 2020 and 
December 31, 2019 (in thousands): 

December 31, 2020 
Cash, Securities and Other 
Construction and Development 
1-4 Family Residential 
Non-Owner Occupied CRE 
Owner Occupied CRE 
Commercial and Industrial 

Total 

December 31, 2019 
Cash, Securities and Other 
Construction and Development 
1-4 Family Residential 
Non-Owner Occupied CRE 
Owner Occupied CRE 
Commercial and Industrial 

Total 

  $ 

Special  
      Mention 

Pass 
 356,970   $ 
 131,111  
 451,918  
 275,627  
 161,850  
 140,432  

Total 
      Substandard         
 357,020 
 50   $ 
 131,111 
 —  
 455,038 
 3,120  
 281,943 
 —  
 163,042 
 1,192  
 5,599  
 146,031 
 9,961   $  1,534,185 

 —   $ 
 —  
 —  
 6,316  
 —  
 —  
 6,316   $ 

  $  1,517,908   $ 

Special  
      Mention 

Pass 
 143,898   $ 
 28,120  
 395,224  
 164,021  
 127,968  
 114,241  
 973,472   $ 

      Substandard 

 —   $ 
 —  
 —  
 1,158  
 —  
 —  
 1,158   $ 

 2,803   $ 
 —  
 4,910  
 —  
 —  
 14,216  
 21,929   $ 

Total 
 146,701 
 28,120 
 400,134 
 165,179 
 127,968 
 128,457 
 996,559 

  $ 

  $ 

The Company had no loans graded doubtful as of the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019. 

NOTE 6 – PREMISES AND EQUIPMENT, NET 

The following presents a summary of the cost and accumulated depreciation of premises and equipment as of 

December 31 (in thousands): 

Leasehold improvements, including artwork 
Equipment and software 

Gross premise and equipment 
Less: accumulated depreciation 
Premises and equipment, net 

  $ 

  $ 

2020 

 9,440   $ 
 5,504  
 14,944  
 (9,624)  
 5,320   $ 

2019 
 10,174 
 4,658 
 14,832 
 (9,614) 
 5,218 

F-26 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
       
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
During  the  year  ended  December  31,  2020,  the  Company  retired  leasehold  improvements,  equipment  and 
software in the amount of $1.1 million for an immaterial loss. During the year ended December 31, 2019, the Company 
retired leasehold improvements, equipment and software in the amount of $2.5 million that were fully depreciated and no 
longer in service.  

Depreciation  expense  for  premises  and  equipment  for  the  years  ended  December 31, 2020  and  2019  totaled 

$1.1 million and $1.3 million, respectively. 

NOTE 7 – GOODWILL AND OTHER INTANGIBLE ASSETS 

Changes in the carrying amount of goodwill were as follows as of December 31 (in thousands): 

2020 

2019 

Beginning balance 
Impairment(1) 
Reclass to held for sale(1) 
Acquisition activity 
Ending balance 
______________________________________ 
(1) Item related to sale of Capital Management segment assets, previously reported separately as the Capital Management segment. 

 19,686   $ 
 — 
 — 
 4,505 

 24,191   $ 

$ 

$ 

 24,811 
 (1,572) 
 (3,553) 
 — 
 19,686 

During the  year ended  December 31, 2020, the Company  recorded $4.5 million of goodwill as a result of the 
Branch  Acquisition  on  May  15,  2020.  For  additional  information  on  goodwill  and  other  intangible  related  to  the 
acquisition, see Note 2 – Acquisitions. 

In 2019, an interim goodwill analysis resulted in the recognition of a goodwill impairment loss of $1.6 million. 
Additionally, the goodwill associated with Capital Management segment assets  was allocated based on the relative fair 
value, and $3.6 million was reclassified to assets held for sale in 2019. The sale of these assets was completed on November 
13, 2020. For changes related to the portion of goodwill reclassified to assets held for sale between segments, see Note 18 
– Intangible Assets and Other Liabilities Classified as Held for Sale and Note 19 – Segment Reporting. 

Goodwill is tested annually for impairment on October 31 or earlier upon the occurrence of certain events. The 
Company identified a triggering event as a result of the economic impact of COVID-19 as of September 30, 2020 and 
performed a Step 1 quantitative analysis. Step 1 of the two-step goodwill impairment analysis includes the determination 
of the carrying value of the reporting unit, including the existing goodwill, and estimating the fair value of the reporting 
unit. If the carrying amount of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, we are not required to perform the second step to the 
impairment test. Our Step 1 goodwill impairment analysis as of September 30, 2020 and October 31, 2020 both indicated 
that the Step 2 analysis was unnecessary.  

As of December 31, 2020, the Company’s reporting units had positive equity and the Company elected to perform 
a qualitative assessment to determine if it was more likely than not that the fair value of the reporting unit exceeded its 
carrying  value  including  goodwill.  The  qualitative  assessment  indicated  that  it  was  not  more  likely  than  not  that  the 
carrying  value  of  the  reporting  unit  exceeded  its  fair  value.  Therefore,  the  Company  did  not  complete  the  two-step 
impairment test. 

The following presents the Company’s intangible assets and related accumulated amortization as of December 31 

(in thousands): 

Other intangibles 
Less: accumulated amortization on other intangibles 
Other intangible assets, net 

2020 

2019 

  $ 

  $ 

 4,593   $ 
 (4,526)  

 67   $ 

 4,540 
 (4,512) 
 28 

F-27 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
  
  
During the year ended December 31, 2019, the Company retired intangible assets in the amount of $4.8 million 

that were fully amortized and no longer in service.  

Amortization expense on definite-lived customer relationship and non-compete intangible assets was immaterial 
for the year ended December 31, 2020 and $0.4 million for the year ended December 31,2019. The following presents the 
expected amortization expense on definite-lived intangible assets existing as of December 31, 2020 (in thousands): 

Year 
2021 
Thereafter 
Total 

NOTE 8 - LEASES 

  $ 

  $ 

Expense 

 17 
 50 
 67 

Leases in which the  Company is determined to be the lessee are primarily operating leases comprised of real 
estate property and office space for our corporate headquarters and profit centers with terms that extend to 2032. Certain 
properties contain portions that are subleased with terms that ended in 2020 that were related to the Capital Management 
segment.  In  accordance  with  ASC  842,  operating  leases  are  required  to  be  recognized  as  a  right-of-use  asset  with  a 
corresponding lease liability. 

The  following  table  presents  the  classification  of  the  right-of-use  asset  and  corresponding  liability  within  the 
Consolidated Balance Sheets. The Company elected to not include short-term leases with initial terms of twelve months 
or less, on the Consolidated Balance Sheets (in thousands): 

Lease Right-of-Use Assets 

Operating lease right-of-use assets 

Classification 
Other assets 

Lease Liabilities 

Operating lease liabilities 

Classification 
Other liabilities 

December 31,    
2020 

December 31,  
2019 

$ 

$ 

 11,341  

$ 

 10,308 

 13,970  

$ 

 13,480 

The  Company’s  operating  lease  agreements  typically  include  an  option  to  renew  the  lease  at  the  Company’s 
discretion. To the extent the Company is reasonably certain it will exercise the renewal option at the inception of the lease, 
the Company will include the extended term in the calculation of the right-of-use asset and lease liability. ASC 842 requires 
the use of the rate implicit in the lease when it is readily determinable. As this rate is typically not readily determinable, at 
the inception of the lease, the Company uses its collateralized incremental borrowing rate over a similar term. The amount 
of the right-of-use asset and lease liability are impacted by the discount rate  used to calculate the present value of the 
minimum lease payments over the term of the lease. 

Weighted-Average Remaining Lease Term 

Operating leases 

Weighted-Average Discount Rate 

Operating leases 

December 31,    
2020 

December 31, 
2019 

 4.79  years   

 4.91  years 

 3.04  % 

 3.71  % 

The Company’s operating leases contain fixed and variable lease components and it has elected to account for all 
classes  of  underlying  assets  as  a  single  lease  component.  Variable  lease  costs  primarily  represent  common  area 
maintenance and parking. The Company recognized lease costs in Occupancy and equipment expense in the accompanying 
Consolidated Statements of Income. The following table represents the Company’s net lease costs (in thousands): 

F-28 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Lease Costs 

Operating lease cost 
Variable lease cost 
Sublease income 

Lease costs, net 

Year Ended December 31,  

2020 

2019 

$ 

$ 

  $ 

 3,162 
 1,894 
 (232)     
  $ 
 4,824 

 3,186 
 1,513 
 (397) 
 4,302 

The following table presents a maturity analysis of the Company’s operating lease liabilities on an annual basis 

for each of the next five years and total amounts thereafter as of December 31, 2020. 

Year Ended December 31, 
2021 
2022 
2023 
2024 
2025 
Thereafter 

Total future minimum lease payments 
Less: imputed interest 
Present value of net future minimum lease payments 

NOTE 9 - DEPOSITS 

Operating Leases 

 3,323 
 3,239 
 2,937 
 2,785 
 1,783 
 867 

 14,934 
 (964) 

 13,970 

  $ 

  $ 

  $ 

The  following  presents  the  Company’s  interest  bearing  deposits  as  of  December  31,  2020  and  2019 

(in thousands): 

Money market deposit accounts 
Time deposits 
Negotiable order of withdrawal accounts 
Savings accounts 

Total interest-bearing deposits 

Aggregate time deposits of $250,000 or greater 

December 31,    
2020 
 847,430  
 172,682  
 113,052  
 5,289  
 1,138,453  
 73,401  

$ 

$ 
$ 

$ 

December 31,  
2019 
 615,575 
 134,913 
 91,921 
 4,307 
 846,716 
 61,596 

$ 
$ 

Deposits  acquired  through  acquisitions  during  the  year  ended  2020  totaled  $63.1  million.  See  Note  2  – 

Acquisitions for more information. 

Overdraft balances classified as loans totaled $0.1 million and an immaterial amount as of December 31, 2020 

and 2019, respectively. 

F-29 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
The following presents the scheduled maturities of all time deposits for the next five years ending December 31 

(in thousands): 

Year Ending December 31, 
2021 
2022 
2023 
2024 
2025 
Thereafter 
Total 

NOTE 10 - BORROWINGS 

Time Deposits 
 125,238 
 23,065 
 20,115 
 2,550 
 1,691 
 23 
 172,682 

$ 

$ 

The Bank has executed a blanket pledge and security agreement with the FHLB that requires certain loans and 
securities  be  pledged  as  collateral  for  any  outstanding  borrowings  under  the  agreement.  The  collateral  pledged  as  of 
December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019 amounted to $668.6 million and $515.5 million, respectively. Based on this 
collateral and the Company’s holdings of FHLB stock, the Company was eligible to borrow an additional $441.8 million 
as of December 31, 2020. Each advance is payable at its maturity date. 

The Company had the following required maturities on FHLB borrowings as of the dates noted (in thousands): 

Maturity Date 
August 26, 2020 
April 22, 2022 
May 5, 2023 
Total  

  December 31,    December 31,  

      Rate % 

2020 

 1.94  
 0.37  
 0.76  

     $ 

 —  
 5,000  
 10,000  
 15,000   $ 

2019 
 10,000 
 — 
 — 
 10,000 

To bolster the effectiveness of the SBA’s PPP, the Federal Reserve is supplying liquidity to participating financial 
institutions through term  financing collateralized by PPP loans to small businesses. The Paycheck Protection Program 
Liquidity Facility ("PPPLF") extends credit to eligible financial institutions that originate PPP loans, taking the loans as 
collateral  at  face  value.  As  of  December 31, 2020  the  Company  is  utilizing  $134.6  million  under  the  PPPLF  program 
which is included in the FHLB and Federal Reserve borrowings line of the Consolidated Balance Sheets. 

The Bank has borrowing capacity associated with three unsecured federal funds lines of credit up to $10.0 million, 
$19.0 million, and $25.0 million. As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, there were no amounts outstanding on any of the 
federal funds lines. 

As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, subordinated notes (the "2016 Sub Notes") issued to various investors totaled 
$6.6 million. The 2016 Sub Notes accrue interest at a rate of 7.25% per annum until December 31, 2021, at which time 
the rate will adjust each quarter to the then current 90 day LIBOR plus 587 basis points, mature on December 31, 2026, 
are redeemable at the option of the Company after January 1, 2022, and pay interest quarterly. 

 On March 17, 2020, the Company completed the issuance and sale of subordinated notes (the "March 2020 Sub 
Notes") totaling $8.0 million in aggregate principal amount. The issuance included $0.1 million of issuance costs resulting 
in a  net balance  of  $7.9  million as of  December 31, 2020 included in the  Subordinated  notes line of the  Consolidated 
Balance Sheets. The March 2020 Sub Notes accrue interest at a rate of 5.125% per annum until March 31, 2025, at which 
time  the  rate  will  adjust  each  quarter  to  the  then  current  three-month  LIBOR,  or  an  alternative  rate  determined  in 
accordance with the terms of the March 2020 Sub Notes, plus 450 basis points; mature on March 31, 2030; are redeemable 
at the option of the Company on or after March 31, 2025; and pay interest quarterly.  

On November 25, 2020, the Company completed the issuance and sale of subordinated notes (the "November 
2020 Sub Notes") totaling $10.0 million in aggregate principal amount. The issuance included $0.2 million of issuance 

F-30 

 
 
 
 
 
     
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
costs resulting in a net balance of $9.8 million as of December 31, 2020 included in the Subordinated notes line of the 
Consolidated  Balance  Sheets.  The  November  2020  Sub  Notes  accrue  interest  at  a  rate  of  4.25%  per  annum  until 
December 1,  2025,  at  which  time  the  rate  will  adjust  each  quarter  to  the  then  current  three-month  term  SOFR,  or  an 
alternative rate determined in accordance with the terms of the November 2020 Sub Notes, plus 402 basis points; mature 
on December 1, 2030; are redeemable at the option of the Company on or after December 1, 2025; and pay interest semi-
annually prior to December 1, 2025 and quarterly after December 1, 2025. 

For  the  years  ended  December  31,  2020  and  2019,  the  Company  recorded  $0.8  million  and  $0.5  million, 
respectively, of interest expense related to the collective subordinated notes. The subordinated notes are included in Tier 
2 capital under current regulatory guidelines and interpretations, subject to limitations. 

The Company’s borrowing facilities include various financial and other covenants, including, but not limited to, 
a requirement that the Bank maintains regulatory capital that is deemed  "well capitalized" by federal banking agencies 
(see Note 23 – Regulatory Capital Matters). As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, the Company was in compliance with 
the covenant requirements. 

The Company had a Restated Revolving Credit Note (the "Credit Note") with a correspondent lending partner 
which matured on June 30, 2020 and was renewed under a new Business Loan Agreement and associated Promissory Note 
(the  "Note") dated June  30,  2020. The  Note  is  secured  by  stock  of  the  Bank  and  bears  interest  at  the  one  month  ICE 
Benchmark  Administration  ("ICE")  LIBOR  plus  2.5%.  As  of  December  31,  2020  and  2019,  there  were  no  amounts 
outstanding and the borrowing capacity associated with both facilities was $5.0 million. 

NOTE 11 – COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES 

The Company is party to credit-related financial instruments with off-balance sheet risk in the normal course of 
business to meet the financing needs of its clients. These financial instruments include commitments to extend credit. Such 
commitments involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit and interest rate risk in excess of the amount recognized in 
the Consolidated Balance Sheets. Commitments may expire without being utilized. The Company’s exposure to loan loss 
is represented by the contractual amount of these commitments, although material losses are not anticipated. The Company 
follows the same credit policies in making commitments as it does for on-balance sheet instruments. 

The following presents the Company’s financial instruments whose contract amounts represent credit risk, as of 

the dates noted (in thousands): 

December 31, 2020 

December 31, 2019 

Unused lines of credit 
Standby letters of credit 
Commitments to make loans to sell 
Commitments to make loans 

      Fixed Rate       Variable Rate       Fixed Rate       Variable Rate 
  $   78,506   $   360,883   $   32,896   $   290,653 
 24,197 
 — 
 — 

 1,933  
   370,512  
  $   24,225   $ 

 17,524  
 —  
 25,316   $ 

 1,759  
 47,354  

 —   $ 

Unused lines of credit are agreements to lend to a client as long as there is no violation of any condition established 
in the contract. Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment 
of a fee. Several of the commitments may expire without being drawn upon. Therefore, the total commitment amounts do 
not necessarily represent future cash requirements. The amount of collateral obtained, if it is deemed necessary by the 
Company, is based on management’s credit evaluation of the client. 

Unused lines of credit under commercial lines of credit, revolving credit lines and overdraft protection agreements 
are commitments for possible future extensions of credit to existing clients. These lines of credit are uncollateralized and 
usually do not contain a specified maturity date and may not be drawn upon to the total extent to which the Company is 
committed. 

Standby letters of credit are conditional commitments issued by the Company to guarantee the performance of a 
client’s obligation to a third party. Those letters of credit are primarily issued to support public and private borrowing 

F-31 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
arrangements. Substantially all letters of credit issued have expiration dates within one year. The credit risk involved in 
issuing letters of credit is essentially the same as that involved in extending loan facilities to clients. The Company holds 
collateral supporting those commitments if deemed necessary. 

Commitments to make loans to sell are agreements to sell a loan to an investor in the secondary market for which 
the interest rate has been locked with the client provided there is no violation of any condition within the contract with 
either party. Commitments to make loans to sell have fixed interest rates. Since commitments may expire without being 
extended, total commitment amounts may not necessarily represent cash requirements. 

Commitments to make loans are agreements to lend to a client, provided there is no violation of any condition 
within the contract. Commitments to make loans generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses. Since 
commitments  may  expire  without  being  extended,  total  commitment  amounts  may  not  necessarily  represent  cash 
requirements. 

Litigation, Claims and Settlements 

The Company is, from time to time, involved in various legal actions arising in the normal course of business. 
While the ultimate outcome of any such proceedings cannot be predicted with certainty, it is the opinion of management, 
based on advice from legal counsel, that no proceedings exist, either individually or in the aggregate, which, if determined 
adversely to the Company, would have a material effect on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.  

Without admitting or denying the SEC’s findings, FWCM agreed on July 16, 2020 to settle claims that FWCM 
failed reasonably to supervise its investment adviser representatives who purchased securities sold in reliance on Rule 
144A under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "Securities Act"), for advisory clients when the clients were not 
qualified institutional buyers  in a  Rule 144A transaction, and to adopt and implement  written policies and procedures 
reasonably designed to prevent violations of the Investment Advisers Act of 1940 and the rules thereunder by the adviser 
and its supervised persons. The Company had since replaced the FWCM President and FWCM compliance team which 
were in place during that time. FWCM recognized and paid a fine of $0.2 million to the SEC in 2020.  

NOTE 12 – SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY 

Common Stock 

The Company’s common stock has no par value and each holder of common stock is entitled to one vote for each 

share (though certain voting restrictions may exist on non-vested restricted stock) held. 

On June 14, 2019, the Company announced that its board of directors had authorized a share repurchase plan (the 
"2019 Repurchase Plan") under which the Company may repurchase up to 300,000 shares of its common stock and that 
the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System advised the Company that it had no objection to the Company’s 
2019 Repurchase Plan. The 2019 Repurchase Plan authorizes the Company to purchase its common stock from time to 
time in privately negotiated transactions, in the open market, including pursuant to any trading plan that may be adopted 
in accordance with Rule 10b5-1 plan promulgated by the Securities and Exchange Commissions, or otherwise in a manner 
that complies with applicable federal securities laws. The 2019 Repurchase Plan was in effect for a one-year period, with 
the  timing of purchases and the  number of shares repurchased under the program dependent upon a  variety of  factors 
including price, trading volume, corporate and regulatory requirements and market conditions. The 2019 Repurchase Plan 
may be suspended or discontinued at any time without notice. During the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, the 
Company  repurchased  22,679  shares  at  an  average  price  of  $16.50  and  43,698  shares  at  an  average  price  of  $16.51, 
respectively, under the authorization of the 2019 Repurchase Plan. The 2019 Repurchase Plan expired in June 2020. 

On November 3, 2020, the Company announced that its board of directors authorized the repurchase of up to 
400,000 shares of the Company’s common stock, no par value, from time to time, within one year (the "2020 Repurchase 
Plan") and that the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System advised the Company that it has no objection to the 
Company’s 2020 Repurchase Plan. The Company may repurchase shares in privately negotiated transactions, in the open 
market, including pursuant to any trading plan that may be adopted in accordance with Rule 10b5-1 promulgated by the 

F-32 

 
 
Securities and Exchange Commission, or otherwise in a manner that complies with applicable federal securities laws. The 
2020 Repurchase Plan does not obligate the Company to acquire a specific dollar amount or number of shares and it may 
be extended, modified or discontinued at any time without notice. During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company 
repurchased 426 shares at an average price of $17.30 under the authorization of the 2020 Repurchase Plan. 

During the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, the Company sold no shares of common stock.  

Restricted Stock Awards 

In 2017, the Company issued 105,264 shares of common stock ("Restricted Stock Awards") with a value of $3.0 
million to the sole member of EMC Holdings, LLC ("EMC"), subject to forfeiture based on his continued employment 
with the Company. Half of the Restricted Stock Awards ($1.5 million or 52,632 shares) vests ratably over five-years. The 
remaining $1.5 million, or 52,632 shares, may be earned based on performance of the mortgage division of the Company.  
During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company recognized compensation expense of $0.1 million, representing 
the remaining 14,114 shares, related to the performance based awards.  During the year ended December 31, 2019, the 
Company recognized compensation expense of $0.6 million, representing 38,518 shares, related to the performance-based 
awards. The performance based awards fully vested in the second quarter of 2020. 

As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, the Restricted Stock Awards have a weighted-average grant date fair value 
of $28.50 per share. The Company has recognized compensation expense of $0.4 million and $0.9 million, respectively, 
for all the Restricted Stock Awards. As of December 31, 2020, the Company has $0.5 million of unrecognized stock-based 
compensation expense related to the shares issued, which is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of 
1.2 years. Restricted Stock Awards represented 40,614 shares that vested during the year ended December 31, 2020. 

Stock-Based Compensation Plans 

The 2008 Stock Incentive Plan (“the 2008 Plan”) was frozen in connection with the adoption of the 2016 Plan 
and no new awards may be granted under the 2008 Plan. As of December 31, 2020, there were a total of 458,947 shares 
available  for  issuance  under  the  First  Western  Financial,  Inc.  2016  Omnibus  Incentive  Plan  ("the  2016  Plan").  If  the 
Awards outstanding under the 2008 Plan or the 2016 Plan are forfeited, cancelled or terminated with no consideration paid 
to the Company, those amounts will increase the number of shares eligible to be granted under the 2016 Plan. 

Stock Options 

The Company did not grant any stock options during the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019. 

During  the  years  ended  December 31, 2020  and  2019,  the  Company  recognized  stock-based  compensation 
expense of $0.2 million and $0.3 million, respectively. As of December 31, 2020, the Company has an immaterial amount 
of unrecognized stock-based compensation expense related to stock options which are unvested. That cost is expected to 
be recognized over a weighted-average period of less than one year. 

F-33 

The following summarizes activity for nonqualified stock options for the year ended December 31, 2020: 

  Weighted   

  Weighted   
Average 
Average    Remaining    Aggregate 
Exercise    Contractual  
Intrinsic 

Number 
of 

      Options 

      Price 

      Term 

      Value 

Outstanding as of December 31, 2019 

Granted 
Exercised 
Forfeited or expired 

Outstanding as of December 31, 2020 
Options fully vested / exercisable as of December 31, 2020 

 —  
 —  
 —  

 419,197   $   29.02  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 419,197   $   29.02  
 414,727   $   29.04  

 2.5  
 2.5  

(1) 

(1) 

(a)  Nonqualified stock options outstanding at the end of the period and those fully vested / exercisable had immaterial aggregate intrinsic values. 

As of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, there were 414,727 and 394,020 options, respectively, that 
were exercisable. Exercise prices are between $20.00 and $40.00 per share, and the options are exercisable for a period of 
ten years from the original grant date and expire on various dates between 2022 and 2026. 

Restricted Stock Units 

Pursuant  to  the  2016 Plan,  the  Company  can  grant  associates  and  non-associate  directors  long-term  cash  and 
stock-based compensation. During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company granted certain associates restricted 
stock units which are earned over time or based on various performance measures and convert to common stock upon 
vesting, which are summarized here and expanded further below: 

The  following  summarizes  the  activity  for  the  Time  Vesting  Units,  the  Financial  Performance  Units  and  the 

Market Performance Units for the year ended December 31, 2020: 

Outstanding as of December 31, 2019 

Granted 
Vested 
Forfeited  

Outstanding as of December 31, 2020 

Time 
Vesting  
Units 
 209,444  
 132,775  
 (54,753)  
 (2,414)  
285,052  

Financial 
Performance   
Units 
 69,426  
 84,027  
 —  
 (1,023)  
152,430  

Market  
Performance 
Units 
 14,862 
 — 
 — 
 — 
14,862 

During  the  year  ended  December 31,  2020,  the  Company  issued  34,710  shares  of  common  stock  upon  the 
settlement of Time Vesting Units. The remaining 20,043 shares were surrendered with a combined market value at the 
dates of settlement of $0.3 million to cover employee withholding taxes. During the year ended December 31, 2019, the 
Company issued 15,446 shares of common stock upon the settlement of Time Vesting Units. The remaining 7,835 shares 
were surrendered with a combined market value at the dates of settlement of $0.1 million to cover employee withholding 
taxes. 

Time Vesting Units 

The  Time  Vesting  Units  are  granted  to  full-time  associates  and  board  members  at  the  date  approved  by  the 
Company’s board of directors. The Company granted 132,775 Time Vesting Units with a five-year service period during 
the year ended December 31, 2020, that vest in equal installments of 20% on the anniversary of the grant date, assuming 
continuous  employment  through  the  scheduled  vesting  dates.  The  Time  Vesting  Units  granted  in  2020  have  a 
weighted-average  grant-date  fair  value  of  $13.65  per  unit.  During  the  years  ended  December 31, 2020  and  2019,  the 
Company recognized compensation expense of $1.4 million and $1.0 million, respectively, for the Time Vesting Units. 

F-34 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
As  of  December 31, 2020,  there  was  $3.9 million  of  unrecognized  compensation  expense  related  to  the  Time  Vesting 
Units, which is expected to be recognized over a weighted-average period of 1.9 years. 

Financial Performance Units  

Financial Performance Units are granted to certain key associates and are earned based on the Company achieving 
various financial performance metrics. If the Company achieves the financial metrics, which include various thresholds 
from 0% up to 150%, then the Financial Performance Units will have a subsequent vesting period. 

The following presents the Company’s existing Financial Performance Units as of December 31, 2020 (dollars 

in thousands): 

Maximum 
issuable 
shares at 
current 
threshold 

Unrecognized 
compensation 
expense 

Weighted-
Average (1) 

Financial metric 
end date 

Vesting requirement 
end date 

 10,035    $ 

 79   

1.0 years    December 31, 2019    December 31, 2021 

 86,148   

150% 

 87,675   

 527   

 627   

3.1 years    December 31, 2021    December 31, 2023 

4.0 years    December 31, 2022    December 31, 2023 

Threshold 
accrual 
50% on half; 
100% on 
other half 
150% 

Grant Period 
Prior to May 1, 2019 

May 1, 2019 through April 30, 
2020 
May 1, 2020 through December 31, 
2020, excluding November 18, 
2020 
On November 18, 2020 

126% 

 29,268    $ 

 397   

3.9 years    December 31, 2022   

50% November 18, 
2023 & 2025 

________________ 
(1) Represents the expected unrecognized stock-based compensation expense recognition period. 

The following presents the Company’s Financial Performance Units activity for the years noted December 31 

(dollars in thousands): 

Grant Period 
Prior to May 1, 2019 
May 1, 2019 through April 30, 2020 
May 1, 2020 through December 31, 2020, excluding 
November 18, 2020 
On November 18, 2020 
________________ 
*Not meaningful 

Market Performance Units 

Units Granted 

2020 

2019 

Compensation expense recognized 

2020 

2019 

 — 
 1,866 

 58,993 
 23,168 

 — 
 62,569 

  $ 

 — 
 — 

  $ 

 64 
 312 

 156 
 17 

  $ 

  $ 

* 
 110 

 — 
 — 

Market Performance Units were granted to certain key associates and are earned based on growth in the value of 
the Company’s common stock, and were dependent on the Company completing an initial public offering of stock during 
a defined period of time. On July 23, 2018, the Company completed its initial public offering and the Market Performance 
Units  performance  condition  was  met.  Subsequent  to  the  performance  condition  there  is  also  a  market  condition  as  a 
vesting requirement for the Market Performance Units which affects the determination of the grant date fair value. The 
Company estimated the grant date fair value using various valuation assumptions. During years ended December 31, 2020 
and 2019, the Company recognized an immaterial amount of compensation expense for the Market Performance Units. As 
of December 31, 2020, there was $0.4 million of unrecognized compensation expense related to the Market Performance 
Units which is expected to be recognized over a weighted-average period of 1.5 years. 

If the Company’s common stock is trading at or above certain prices, over a performance period which ended on 
June 30, 2020, the Market Performance Units would have been determined to be earned and vest following the completion 

F-35 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
of a  subsequent service  period ending on June 30, 2022. The Company’s common stock did not trade  at or above the 
required prices over the performance period and as a result, no Market Performance Units are eligible to be earned. 

NOTE 13 - EARNINGS PER COMMON SHARE 

The table below presents the calculation of basic and diluted earnings per common share for the periods indicated 

(amounts in thousands, except share and per share amounts): 

Earnings per common share - Basic 
Numerator: 

Net income 
Net income available for common shareholders 

Denominator: 

Basic weighted average shares 
Earnings per common share - basic 

Earnings per common share - Diluted 
Numerator: 

Net income 
Net income available for common shareholders 

Denominator: 

Basic weighted average shares 
Diluted effect of common stock equivalents: 

Time Vesting Units  
Financial Performance Units 
Market Performance Units 

Total diluted effect of common stock equivalents 
Diluted weighted average shares 
Earnings per common share - diluted 

Year Ended December 31,  
2019 
2020 

  $ 
  $ 

 24,534    $ 
 24,534    $ 

 8,009 
 8,009 

 7,899,278   

  $ 

 3.11   $ 

 7,890,266 
 1.02 

  $ 
  $ 

 24,534    $ 
 24,534    $ 

 8,009 
 8,009 

 7,899,278  

 7,890,266 

  $ 

 32,995   $ 
 16,160  
 13,471  
 62,626  
 7,961,904   

  $ 

 3.08   $ 

 9,315 
 2,071 
 13,309 
 24,695 
 7,914,961 
 1.01 

Diluted  earnings  per  share  was  computed  without  consideration  to  potentially  dilutive  instruments  as  their 

inclusion would have been anti-dilutive.  

For  the  years  ended  December 31, 2020  and  2019,  potentially  dilutive  securities  excluded  from  the  diluted 

earnings per share calculation are as follows: 

Stock options 
Time Vesting Units 
Financial Performance Units 
Restricted Stock Awards 

Total potentially dilutive securities 

Year Ended December 31,  

2020 
 419,197  
 88,121  
 70,397  
 36,401  
 614,116  

2019 
   433,572 
 144,560 
 35,256 
 78,202 
   691,590 

F-36 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
       
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTE 14 - INCOME TAXES 

The components of the Company’s income tax expense as of December 31 (in thousands): 

Current: 
Federal 
State and local 

Total current tax expense 

Deferred: 
Federal 
State and local 
Valuation allowance 

Total deferred (benefit) tax 

Income tax expense 

2020 

2019 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 7,970  
 1,859  
 9,829  

 3,076 
 323 
 3,399 

 (1,392)  
 (280)  
 372  
 (1,300)  
 8,529  

 (1,338) 
 122 
 — 
 (1,216) 
 2,183 

$ 

The  following is a reconciliation of income  taxes reflected on the Consolidated Statements of Income for the 
years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019 with income tax expense computed by applying the United States federal income 
tax rate of 21% to income before income taxes (in thousands): 

Income tax expense computed at 21% statutory rate 
Differences: 

Permanent differences 
State taxes, net of federal expense 
Low income housing investment 
Valuation allowance 
Other, net(1) 

Income tax expense 

(1) 

Includes the impact of R&D tax credits. 

2020 

2019 

  $ 

 6,943   $ 

 2,140 

 (57)  
 1,150  
 (36)  
 372  
 157  
 8,529   $ 

 (30) 
 394 
 — 
 — 
 (321) 
 2,183 

  $ 

F-37 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
  
 
     
 
   
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
 
  
    
  
   
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
The following were the principal components of the Company’s deferred tax items as of December 31 (in 

thousands): 

Deferred tax assets: 

Net operating loss carryforwards 
Allowance for loan losses 
Deferred rent 
Stock-based compensation 
Provision on other real estate owned 
Other intangible assets 
Unrealized losses on securities, net 
Accrued bonuses 
Loan fees 
Other 

Total deferred tax assets 

Deferred tax liabilities: 

Goodwill 
Depreciation 
Unrealized gains on securities, net 
Other 

Total deferred tax liabilities 
Net operating loss valuation allowance  
Net deferred tax asset 

2020 

2019 

  $ 

 577   $ 

 3,054  
 635  
 1,613  
 484  
 615  
 —  
 898  
 244  
 553  
 8,673  

 545 
 1,925 
 797 
 1,400 
 438 
 723 
 55 
 474 
 352 
 685 
 7,394 

 (1,013)  
 (904)  
 (236)  
 (92)  
 (2,245)  
 (372)  
 6,056   $ 

 (1,354) 
 (961) 
 — 
 (32) 
 (2,347) 
 — 
 5,047 

  $ 

The net operating loss ("NOL") carryforwards expire in tax years 2028 through 2032. As of December 31, 2020, 
the Company has $6.5 million of California NOLs available for utilization. In general, a corporation’s ability to utilize its 
NOL carryforwards may be substantially limited due to ownership changes that have occurred or that could occur  in the 
future, as required by Section 382 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code"), as well as similar state 
provisions. These ownership changes may limit the amount of NOL carryforwards that can be utilized annually to offset 
future taxable income and tax. In general, an "ownership change," as defined by Section 382 of the Code, results from a 
transaction or series of transactions over a three-year period resulting in an ownership change of more than 50 percent of 
the capital (as defined) of a company by certain stockholders or public groups.  

During  2020,  as  a  result  of  divestitures,  the  Company  did  not  expect  to  realize  the  full  NOL.  As  such,  the 
Company recorded a $0.4 million valuation allowance related to the California NOLs. The Company identified no other 
material  uncertain  tax  positions  for  which  it  is  reasonably  possible  the  total  amount  of  unrecognized  tax  benefits  will 
significantly increase or decrease within 12 months. The Company and its subsidiaries file tax returns for the United States 
and  for  multiple  states  and  localities.  The  United  States  federal  income  tax  returns  of  the  Company  are  eligible  to  be 
examined for the years 2017 and forward. There are no federal or state tax examinations currently in progress. 

NOTE 15 – EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS 

The Company sponsors a 401(k) Plan, which is a defined contribution plan, in which substantially all associates 
are eligible to participate in and associates may contribute up to 100% of their compensation subject to certain limits based 
on federal tax laws. The Company may elect to make matching contributions as defined by the plan. For the years ended 
December 31, 2020 and 2019, the Company expensed matching contributions to the plan totaling $0.9 million and $0.7 
million,  respectively.  The  Company  did  not  pay  any  expenses  attributable  to  the  plan  during  the  years  ended 
December 31, 2020 and 2019. 

NOTE 16 – RELATED-PARTY TRANSACTIONS 

The  Bank  extends  credit  to  certain  covered  parties  including  Company  directors,  executive  officers  and  their 
affiliates.  As of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, there were no delinquent or non-performing loans to any 

F-38 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
  
 
     
 
   
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
    
  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
executive officer or director of the Company. These covered parties, along with principal owners, management, immediate 
family of management or principal owners, a parent company and its subsidiaries, trusts for the benefit of employees, and 
other parties, may be considered related parties. The following presents a summary of related-party loan activity as of the 
dates noted (in thousands): 

Balance, beginning of year 
Funded loans 
Payments collected 
Balance, end of year 

      December 31, 2020       December 31, 2019 
 2,659 
 5,675   $ 
  $ 
 11,618 
 (8,602) 
 5,675 

 17,348  
 (8,702)  
 14,321   $ 

  $ 

Deposits from related parties held by the Bank as of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019 totaled $26.2 

million and $28.5 million, respectively. 

The Company leases office spaces from entities controlled by one of the Company’s board members. During the 
years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, the Company incurred $0.2 million and $0.3 million, respectively, of expense 
related to these leases. 

The Company earned trust and investment management fees of $0.2 million from related parties during the years 
ended December 31, 2020 and 2019. Assets under management for those related parties totaled $92.1 million and $137.1 
million as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively.  

NOTE 17 - FAIR VALUE 

Fair value is the exchange price that would be received for an asset or paid to transfer a liability (exit price) in the 
principal or most advantageous market for the asset or liability in an orderly transaction between market participants on 
the measurement date. There are three levels of inputs that may be used to measure fair values: 

Level 1:  Quoted prices (unadjusted) for identical assets or liabilities in active markets that the entity has the ability to 

access as of the measurement date. 

Level 2:  Significant other observable inputs other than Level 1 prices such as quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities; 
quoted  prices  in  markets  that  are  not  active;  or  other  inputs  that  are  observable  or  can  be  corroborated  by 
observable market data. 

Level 3:  Significant unobservable inputs that reflect a company’s own assumptions about the assumptions that market 

participants would use in pricing an asset or liability. 

The Company used the following methods and significant assumptions to estimate fair value: 

Investment  Securities:  The  fair  values  for  investment  securities  are  determined  by  quoted  market  prices,  if 
available (Level 1). For securities where quoted prices are not available, fair values are calculated based on market prices 
of similar securities (Level 2). For securities where quoted prices or market prices of similar securities are not available, 
fair values are calculated using discounted cash flows or other market indicators (Level 3). 

Guarantee  asset  and  liability:  The  guarantee  asset  represents  the  fair  value  of  the  consideration  received  in 
exchange for the credit enhancement fee. The guarantee liability represents a financial guarantee to cover the second layer 
of any losses on loan sold to FHLB under the MPF 125 loan sales agreement. Significant inputs in the valuation analysis 
are Level 3, due to the nature of this asset and the lack of market quotes. The fair value of the guarantee asset is determined 
using a discounted cash flow model, for which significant unobservable inputs include assumed future prepayment rates 
and market discount rate (Level 3). An increase in prepayment rates or discount rate would generally reduce the estimated 
fair value of the guarantee asset. The guarantee liability is the fair value of the guarantee assets less amortization (Level 
3). 

F-39 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest  Rate  Lock  Commitments  ("IRLC")  and  Forward  Sale  Commitments  ("FSC"):  Fair  values  of  these 
mortgage derivatives are estimated based on changes in mortgage interest rates from the date the commitment related to 
the loan is locked. The fair value estimate is based on valuation models using market data from secondary market loan 
sales and direct contacts with third party investors as of the  measurement date and pull through assumptions (Level 3). 
The  FSC  fair  value  estimate  reflects  the  potential  pair  off  fee  associated  with  mandatory  trades  by  using  a  market 
differential and pair off penalty assessed by the investor (Level 3). 

IRLC and FSC’s are carried at fair value in the Company’s financial statements. Changes in the fair value of a 

IRLC and FSC’s are accounted for within the Consolidated Statements of Income. 

Other Real Estate Owned: Assets acquired through or instead of loan foreclosure  are initially recorded at fair 
value less costs to sell when acquired, establishing a new cost basis. They are subsequently accounted for at lower of cost 
or fair value less estimated costs to sell. Fair value is commonly based on recent real estate appraisals which are updated 
no  less  frequently  than  on  an  annual  basis.  Appraisals  may  utilize  a  single  valuation  approach  or  a  combination  of 
approaches including comparable sales and the income approach. Adjustments are routinely made in the appraisal process 
by  the  independent  appraisers  to  adjust  for  differences  between  comparable  sales  and  income  data  available.  Such 
adjustments can be significant and typically result in Level 3 classifications of the inputs for determining fair value. Other 
real estate owned is evaluated annually for additional impairment and adjusted accordingly. 

Impaired Loans: The fair value of impaired loans with specific allocations of the allowance for loan losses is 
generally  based  on  recent  appraisals.  These  appraisals  may  utilize  a  single  valuation  approach  or  a  combination  of 
approaches including comparable sales and the income approach. Adjustments are routinely made in the appraisal process 
by the independent appraisers to adjust for differences between the comparable sales and income data  available. Such 
adjustments  can  be  significant  and  typically  result  in  Level 3  classifications  of  the  inputs  for  determining  fair  value. 
Impaired loans are evaluated monthly for additional impairment and adjusted accordingly. 

Appraisals for both collateral-dependent impaired loans and other real estate owned are performed by certified 
general  appraisers  (for  commercial  properties)  or  certified  residential  appraisers  (for  residential  properties)  whose 
qualifications and licenses have been reviewed and verified by the Company. Once received, the Company reviews the 
assumptions  and  approaches  utilized  in  the  appraisal  as  well  as  the  overall  resulting  fair  value  in  comparison  with 
independent data sources such as recent market data or industry-wide statistics. 

The  following  presents  assets  and  liabilities  measured  on  a  recurring  basis  as  of  December 31, 2020  and 

December 31, 2019 (in thousands): 

December 31, 2020 
Investment securities available-for-sale: 

U.S. Treasury debt 
Corporate bonds 
GNMA mortgage-backed securities - residential 
FNMA mortgage-backed securities - residential 
Corporate CMO and MBS 

Total securities available-for-sale 
Equity securities 
Guarantee asset 
IRLC and FSC, net 
Guarantee liability 

Significant 
Other 

  Observable 

Inputs 
(Level 2) 

 $ 

 $ 
 $ 
 $ 
 $ 
 $ 

 — 
 6,044 
 24,604 
 1,677 
 4,087 
 36,412 
 — 
 — 
 — 
 — 

Significant 
  Unobservable 

Inputs 
(Level 3) 

Reported 
Balance 

 $ 

 $ 
 $ 
 $ 
 $ 
 $ 

 — 
 — 
 — 
 — 
 — 
 — 
 — 
 232 
 9,752 
 (125) 

 $ 

 $ 
 $ 
 $ 
 $ 
 $ 

 254 
 6,044 
 24,604 
 1,677 
 4,087 
 36,666 
 730 
 232 
 9,752 
 (125) 

Quoted 
Prices in 
  Active Markets   
for Identical 
Assets 
(Level 1) 

 254 
 — 
 — 
 — 
 — 
 254 
 730 
 — 
 — 
 — 

  $ 

  $ 
  $ 
  $ 
  $ 
  $ 

F-40 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
 
 
   
  
  
 
 
   
  
  
 
 
   
  
  
 
 
   
  
  
 
December 31, 2019 
Investment securities available-for-sale: 

U.S. Treasury debt 
GNMA mortgage-backed securities - residential 
FNMA mortgage-backed securities - residential 
Corporate CMO and MBS 

Total securities available-for-sale 
Equity securities 
IRLC and FSC, net 

Quoted 
Prices in 
  Active Markets   
for Identical 
Assets 
(Level 1) 

Significant 
Other 

  Observable 

Inputs 
(Level 2) 

Significant 
  Unobservable 
Inputs 
(Level 3) 

Reported 
Balance 

  $ 

254   $ 

—  
—  
—  

254   $ 
713   $ 
—   $ 

  $ 
  $ 
  $ 

 —   $ 

 45,312  
 2,917  
 10,420  
 58,649   $ 
 —   $ 
 —   $ 

 —   $ 
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —   $ 
 —   $ 
 1,184   $ 

 254 
 45,312 
 2,917 
 10,420 
 58,903 
 713 
 1,184 

There were no transfers between levels during 2020. All of the Company’s IRLC and FSC’s were transferred 
from Level 2 to Level 3 as of December 31, 2019 as a result of the review of inputs for these instruments identifying the 
use of pull through rates as unobservable inputs.  

The following presents a reconciliation for Level 3 instruments measured at fair value on a recurring basis (in 

thousands): 

Year Ended December 31, 2020 
Beginning balance 
Acquisitions 
Originations 
Sales 
Gains (losses) in net income, net 
Other settlements 

Ending balance 

Year Ended December 31, 2019 
Beginning balance 
Acquisitions 
Originations 
Losses in net income, net 

Ending balance 

Guarantee Asset 

$ 

$ 

 —  
 —  
 —  
 245  
 55  
 (68)  
 232  

Guarantee Asset 

$ 

$ 

 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  
 —  

IRLC and FSC, Net 
$ 

 1,184  
 44,763  
 (39,985)  
 —  
 3,790  
 —  
 9,752  

$ 

  Guarantee Liability 
 — 
 — 
 — 
 244 
 (119) 
 — 
 125 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

IRLC and FSC, Net        Guarantee Liability 
 — 
 — 
 — 
 — 
 — 

 421  
 13,094  
 (10,009)  
 (2,322)  
 1,184  

$ 

$ 

Mutual funds and U.S. Treasury debt are reported at fair value utilizing Level 1 inputs. The remaining portfolio 
of securities are reported at fair value with Level 2 inputs provided by a pricing service. As of December 31, 2020 and 
December 31, 2019,  the  majority  of  the  securities  had  credit  support  provided  by  the  Federal  Home  Loan  Mortgage 
Corporation, GNMA, and FNMA. Factors used to value the securities by the pricing service include: benchmark yields, 
reported trades, interest spreads, prepayments, and other market research. In addition, ratings and collateral quality are 
considered. 

As of December 31, 2020, equity securities, IRLC, and guarantee assets have been recorded at fair value within 
the Other assets line item and the FSC and guarantee liabilities have been recorded at fair value with the Other liabilities 
line item in the Consolidated Balance Sheets. All changes are recorded in the Other line item in the Consolidated Statement 
of Income. 

F-41 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The  following  presents  quantitative  information  about  Level  3  assets  measured  on  a  recurring  basis  as  of 

December 31, 2020 and 2019 (in thousands): 

Guarantee asset 

IRLC and FSC, net 

Guarantee liability 

  Quantitative Information about Level 3 Fair Value Measurements as of December 31, 2020 

Fair Value 

Valuation  
Technique 

 $ 

 232   

Discounted cash flow  

Significant  
Unobservable Input 
Discount rate 
Prepayment rate 

Range 
(Weighted Average) 
3% (3%) 
25% (25%) 

 9,752   

Best execution model  

Pull through 

 $ 

 (125)  

Discounted cash flow  

Discount rate 
Prepayment rate 

55% - 100% 
(86%) 

3% (3%) 
25% (25%) 

  Quantitative Information about Level 3 Fair Value Measurements as of December 31, 2019 

IRLC and FSC, net 

 $ 

 1,184 

Best execution model  

Pull through 

Fair Value 

Valuation  
Technique 

Significant  
Unobservable Input 

Range 
(Weighted Average) 
75% - 100% 
(88%) 

The following presents assets measured on a nonrecurring basis as of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019 

(in thousands): 

December 31, 2020 
Other real estate owned: 

Commercial properties 

Total impaired loans(1): 

Commercial and Industrial 

Quoted 
Prices in 

  Active Markets 

for Identical 
Assets 
(Level 1) 

Significant 
Other 

Significant 

  Observable 

  Unobservable 

Inputs 
(Level 2) 

Inputs 
(Level 3) 

Reported 
Balance 

  $ 

 —   $ 

 —   $ 

 194   $ 

 194 

  $ 

 —   $ 

 —   $ 

 1,800   $ 

 1,800 

______________________________________ 
(1) An immaterial Cash, Securities and Other loan was fully reserved for using a specific allowance as of December 31, 2020. 

December 31, 2019 
Other real estate owned: 

Commercial properties 

Total impaired loans: 

Commercial and Industrial 

Quoted 
Prices in 

  Active Markets 

for Identical 
Assets 
(Level 1) 

Significant 
Other 

Significant 

  Observable 

  Unobservable 

Inputs 
(Level 2) 

Inputs 
(Level 3) 

Reported 
Balance 

  $ 

 —   $ 

 —   $ 

 658   $ 

 658 

  $ 

 —   $ 

 —   $ 

 3,579   $ 

 3,579 

The sales comparison approach was utilized for estimating the fair value of non-recurring assets. 

As of December 31, 2020, OREO had a carrying amount of $0.2 million, which is the cost basis of $2.1 million 
net of a valuation allowance of $1.9 million. As of December 31, 2019, OREO had a carrying amount of $0.7 million, 
which is the cost basis of $2.4 million net of a valuation allowance of $1.7 million. 

As of December 31, 2020, total impaired loans measured for impairment using the fair value of the collateral for 
collateral  dependent  loans  had  carrying  values  of  $3.4 million  with  valuation  allowances  of  $1.6 million  and  were 

F-42 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
   
  
 
   
  
 
   
  
 
   
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
   
  
 
   
  
 
   
  
 
   
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
classified  as  Level 3.  As  of  December 31, 2019,  impaired  loans  measured  for  impairment  using  the  fair  value  of  the 
collateral for collateral dependent loans had carrying values of $4.4 million with valuation allowances of $0.8 million and 
were classified as Level 3.  

Impaired  loans  accounted  for  specific  reserves  of  $1.6  million  and  $0.8 million  for  the  years  ended 
December 31, 2020 and  2019.  The  Bank charged off an immaterial amount during the  year ended  December 31, 2020 
from the specific reserve. The Bank charged off $0.2 million during the year ended December 31, 2019 from the specific 
reserve. 

The following presents quantitative information about the significant unobservable inputs used in the fair value 
measurement  of  recurring  and  nonrecurring  non-financial  instruments  categorized  within  Level  3  of  the  fair  value 
hierarchy as of December 31, 2020 and 2019 (in thousands): 

  Quantitative Information about Level 3 Fair Value Measurements as of December 31, 2020 

Fair Value 

Valuation  
Technique 

Significant  
Unobservable Input 

Range 
(Weighted Average) 

Other real estate owned: 

Commercial properties 

 $ 

 194   

Sales contract 

Commission, cost to 
sell, closing costs 

5% (5%) 

Total impaired loans(1): 

Commercial and Industrial 

Sales comparison, 
Market approach - 
guideline transaction 
method 

Management discount 
for asset/property type 

  17% - 35% (26%) 

 $ 

 1,800   

______________________________________ 
(1) An immaterial Cash, Securities and Other loan was fully reserved for using a specific allowance as of December 31, 2020. 

Other real estate owned: 

Commercial properties 

Total impaired loans: 

Commercial and Industrial 

  Quantitative Information about Level 3 Fair Value Measurements as of December 31, 2019 

Fair Value 

Valuation  
Technique 

Significant  
Unobservable Input 

Range 
(Weighted Average) 

 $ 

 658   

Appraisal value 

Discount rate 
  Commission and cost to sell  

50% (50%) 
1% - 10% (7%) 

Sales comparison, 
Market approach - 
guideline transaction 
method 

Management discount for 
asset/property type 

0% - 50% (23%) 

 $ 

 3,579   

F-43 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
     
 
     
 
   
  
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
     
 
     
 
   
  
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The following presents carrying amounts and estimated fair values for financial instruments not carried at fair 

value as of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019 (in thousands): 

December 31, 2020 

Assets: 

Cash and cash equivalents 
Loans, net 
Mortgage loans held for sale 
Accrued interest receivable 

Liabilities: 
Deposits 
Borrowings: 

Carrying 
Amount 

Fair Value Measurements Using: 
Level 2 

Level 1 

Level 3 

  $ 

 155,989   $ 

  1,520,294  
 161,843  
 6,618  

 155,989   $ 
 —  
 —  
 —  

 —   $ 
 —  
 161,843  
 6,618  

 — 
  1,512,699 
 — 
 — 

  1,619,910  

 —  

  1,621,648  

 — 

FHLB borrowings – fixed rate 
Federal Reserve borrowings – fixed rate 
Subordinated notes – fixed-to-floating rate 

 15,000  
 134,563  
 24,291  

Accrued interest payable 

  $ 

 453   $ 

 —  
 —  
 —  
 —   $ 

 15,099  
 134,563  
 —  

 453   $ 

 — 
 — 
 25,750 
 — 

December 31, 2019 

Assets: 

Cash and cash equivalents 
Loans, net 
Mortgage loans held for sale 
Accrued interest receivable 

Liabilities: 
Deposits 
Borrowings: 

Carrying 
Amount 

Fair Value Measurements Using: 
Level 2 

Level 1 

Level 3 

  $ 

 78,638   $ 

 990,132  
 48,312  
 3,048  

 78,638   $ 
 —  
 —  
 —  

 —   $ 
 —  
 48,312  
 3,048  

 — 
 974,142 
 — 
 — 

   1,086,784  

 —  

   1,089,261  

 — 

FHLB borrowings – fixed rate 
Subordinated notes – fixed-to-floating rate 

Accrued interest payable 

 10,000  
 6,560  

  $ 

 299   $ 

 —  
 —  
 —   $ 

 10,003  
 —  
 299   $ 

 — 
 6,004 
 — 

The  fair  value  estimates  presented  and  discussed  above  are  based  on  pertinent  information  available  to 
management as of the dates specified. The estimated fair value amounts are based on the exit price notion set forth by 
ASU 2016-01. Although management is not aware of any factors that would significantly affect the estimated fair values, 
such amounts have not been comprehensively revalued for purposes of these consolidated financial statements since the 
balance sheet dates. Therefore, current estimates of fair value may differ significantly from the amounts presented herein. 

The methods and assumptions, not previously presented, used to estimate fair values are described as follows. 

Cash  and  Cash  Equivalents  and  Restricted  Cash:  The  carrying  amounts  of  cash  and  cash  equivalents  and 
restricted cash approximate fair values as maturities are less than 90 days and balances are generally in accounts bearing 
current market interest rates.  

Loans, net: The fair values for all fixed-rate and variable-rate performing loans were estimated using the income 
approach and by discounting the projected cash flows of such loans. Principal and interest cash flows were projected based 
on the contractual terms of the loans, including maturity, contractual amortization and adjustments for prepayments and 
expected losses, where appropriate. A discount rate was developed based on the relative risk of the cash flows, taking into 
account the loan type, maturity and a required return on capital. 

Mortgage Loans Held for Sale: The fair value of mortgage loans held for sale is estimated based upon binding 

contracts and quotes from third party investors resulting in a Level 2 classification.  

F-44 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    
 
    
 
    
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
    
 
    
 
    
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
          
          
          
          
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    
 
    
 
    
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
    
 
    
 
    
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Accrued Interest Receivable and Payable: The carrying amounts of accrued interest approximate fair value due 

to their short-term nature.  

Deposits:  The  fair  values  disclosed  for  demand  deposits  (e.g., interest  and  non-interest  checking,  passbook 
savings, and certain types of money market accounts) are, by definition, equal to the amounts payable on demand at the 
reporting date (i.e., their carrying amounts). The carrying amounts of variable-rate, fixed-term money market accounts and 
certificates of deposit approximate their fair values at the reporting dates. Fair values for fixed-rate certificates of deposit 
are estimated using a discounted cash flow calculation that applies interest rates currently being offered on certificates to 
a schedule of aggregated expected monthly maturities on time deposits.  

Borrowings:  

Fixed Rate Borrowings: Borrowings with fixed rates are valued using inputs such as discounted cash flows and 

current interest rates for similar instruments and borrowers with similar credit ratings. 

Fixed-to-Floating  Rate  Borrowings:  Borrowings  with  fixed-to-floating  rates  are  valued  using  inputs  such  as 
discounted  cash  flows  and  current  interest  rates  for  similar  instruments  and  assume  the  Company  will  redeem  the 
instrument prior to the first interest rate reset date. 

NOTE 18 – ASSETS AND OTHER LIABILITIES CLASSIFIED AS HELD FOR SALE 

During the year ended December 31, 2019, the Company was actively seeking to sell its Los Angeles-based fixed 
income portfolio management team ("LA fixed income team") and certain advisory and sub-advisory arrangements. As 
such, the related assets and liabilities were classified as a disposal group held for sale and were presented separately in the 
Consolidated Balance Sheets for the year ended December 31, 2019. On November 13, 2020, the Company completed the 
sale of these assets. The Company has no assets or liabilities classified as a disposal group held for sale as of December 
31, 2020. 

Intangible assets and other liabilities in disposal groups held for sale are as follows at the dates noted (in 

thousands): 

ASSETS 
Goodwill 
Assets in disposal groups held for sale 

LIABILITIES 
Other liabilities 
Liabilities in disposal groups held for sale 

NOTE 19 - SEGMENT REPORTING 

December 31,  
2020 

December 31,  
2019 

$ 
$ 

$ 
$ 

 —   $ 
 —   $ 

 —   $ 
 —   $ 

 3,553 
 3,553 

 117 
 117 

The Company’s reportable segments consist of Wealth Management and Mortgage. The chief operating decision 
maker ("CODM") is the Chief Executive Officer. The measure of profit or loss used by the CODM to identify and measure 
the Company’s reportable segments is income before income tax.  

The Company completed the sale of its LA fixed income team in the fourth quarter 2020. The LA fixed income 
team and the related assets made up a majority of the previously reported Capital Management Segment. As a result of the 
sale the Company evaluated its reportable segments and determined the remaining assets following the sale in the Capital 
Management segment no longer meet the thresholds of income before income tax to be a reportable segment. The residual 
assets that remained in the Capital Management segment are now included in the Wealth Management segment. 

F-45 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
    
  
   
 
 
 
The  Wealth  Management  segment  consists  of  operations  relative  to  the  Company’s  fully  integrated  wealth 
management  products  and  services.  Services  provided  include  deposit,  loan,  insurance,  and  trust  and  investment 
management advisory products and services. 

The Mortgage segment consists of operations relative to the Company’s residential mortgage service offerings. 
Mortgage products and services are financial in nature for which premiums are recognized, net of expenses, upon the sale 
of mortgage loans to third parties. 

For all periods presented, the Wealth Management segment includes the previously reported key metrics of the 

previously reported Capital Management segment.  

The tables below present the financial information for each segment that is specifically identifiable or based on 

allocations using internal methods for the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019 (in thousands): 

Includes financial information previously reported under the Capital Management segment. 
Includes loss on assets held for sale of $0.6 million and $0.2 million SEC penalty in the previously reported Capital Management segment. 

Year Ended December 31, 2020 
Income Statement 

Total interest income 
Total interest expense 
Provision for loan losses 

Net interest income, after provision for loan losses 

Non-interest income 

Total income 

Depreciation and amortization expense 
All other non-interest expense 
Income before income tax 

Goodwill 
Total assets 
______________________________________ 
(1) 
(2) 

Year Ended December 31, 2019 
Income Statement 

Total interest income 
Total interest expense 
Provision for loan losses 

Net interest income, after provision for loan losses 

Non-interest income 

Total income 

Depreciation and amortization expense 
All other non-interest expense 

Income (loss) before income tax 

Wealth 
Management(1)   

Mortgage 

Consolidated 

   $ 

  $ 

 53,334    $ 

 7,232  
 4,682  
 41,420  
 21,836  
 63,256  
 1,035  
 50,135 (2)   
 12,086   $ 

 —    $ 
 —   
 —   
 —   
 29,344   
 29,344   
 70   
 8,297   
 20,977    $ 

 53,334 
 7,232 
 4,682 
 41,420 
 51,180 
 92,600 
 1,105 
 58,432 
 33,063 

  $ 
  $ 

 24,191   $ 
 1,798,416   $ 

 —    $ 
 175,239    $ 

 24,191 
 1,973,655 

Wealth 
Management(1)   

Mortgage 

Consolidated 

   $ 

  $ 

 45,051   $ 
 12,990  
 662  
 31,399  
 21,902  
 53,301  
 1,453  
 45,696 (2)   
 6,152   $ 

 —    $ 
 —   
 —   
 —   
 10,675   
 10,675   
 218   
 6,417   
 4,040    $ 

 45,051 
 12,990 
 662 
 31,399 
 32,577 
 63,976 
 1,671 
 52,113 
 10,192 

  $ 

 19,686   $ 

 3,553  
 1,204,620   $ 

  $ 

 —    $ 
 —  
 47,062    $ 

 19,686 
 3,553 
 1,251,682 

Goodwill 
Assets held for sale 
Total assets 
_________________________________________________ 
(1) 
(2) 

Includes financial information previously reported under the Capital Management segment. 
Includes goodwill impairment charge of $1.6 million in the previously reported Capital Management segment. 

F-46 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
NOTE 20 – LOW-INCOME HOUSING TAX CREDIT INVESTMENTS 

On December 19, 2019, the Company invested in a low-income housing tax credit ("LIHTC") investment. As of 
December 31, 2020 and 2019, the balance of the investment for LIHTC was $1.1 million and $0.9 million. These balances 
are reflected in the Other assets line item of the Consolidated Balance Sheets. Total unfunded commitments related to the 
investment in the LIHTC total $2.2 million and $2.5 million as of December 31, 2020 and 2019. The Company expects to 
fulfill these commitments during the year ending 2021. 

The Company uses the proportional amortization method to account for this investment. During the year ended 
December 31, 2020, the Company recognized amortization expense of $0.2 million, which was included within the Income 
tax expense line item of the Consolidated Statements of Income. The Company did not recognize any amortization expense 
in the year ended December 31, 2019. 

Additionally, during the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company recognized tax credits and other benefits 
from this investment in the LIHTC of $0.1 million. The Company did not recognize any tax credits or other benefits from 
this investment in the year end December 31, 2019. During the years ending December 31, 2020 and 2019, the Company 
did not incur any impairment losses. 

NOTE 21 – CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF PARENT COMPANY 

The tables below present condensed financial statements pertaining only to FWFI (in thousands). Investments 

in subsidiaries are stated using the equity method of accounting. 

Condensed Balance Sheets 
ASSETS 

Cash and cash equivalents 
Investment in subsidiaries 
Loans, net 
Other assets 
Total assets 
LIABILITIES 

Subordinated notes 
Other liabilities(1) 
Total liabilities 

SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY 

Total shareholders’ equity 

Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity 

December 31,  

2020 

2019 

   $ 

  $ 

  $ 

 14,270    $ 

 157,377  
 2,021  
 4,075  
 177,743   $ 

 9,301 
 122,792 
 2,091 
 597 
 134,781 

 24,291   $ 
 (1,510)  
 22,781  

 6,560 
 543 
 7,103 

 154,962  
 177,743   $ 

 127,678 
 134,781 

  $ 

_________________________________________________ 
(1) As of December 31, 2020, taxes payable was in a receivable position as a result of timing of tax payments. 

Condensed Statements of Income 
Income 

Interest income 
Non-interest income 
    Total income 

Expense 

Interest expense 
Non-interest expense 

Total expense 

Loss before income tax and equity in undistributed income of subsidiaries 
Income tax benefit 
Loss before equity in undistributed income of subsidiaries 
Equity in undistributed income to subsidiaries 
Net income 

F-47 

Year Ended December 31,  
2019 
2020 

  $ 

  $ 

 87   $ 
 (1)  
 86  

 854  
 355  
 1,209  
 (1,123)  
 (85)  
 (1,208)  
 25,742  
 24,534   $ 

 93 
 — 
 93 

 476 
 267 
 743 
 (650) 
 49 
 (601) 
 8,610 
 8,009 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
    
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
    
  
   
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
    
  
   
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
  
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
    
  
   
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
Condensed Statements of Cash Flows 
Cash flows from operating activities 

Net income 

Adjustments: 

Current & deferred income tax (benefit)/expense 
Stock-based compensation 
Undistributed equity in subsidiaries 
Change in other assets 
Change in other liabilities 

Net cash (used in) provided by operating activities 

Cash flows from investing activities 

Investment in subsidiaries 
Loan and note receivable originations and principal collections 

Net cash used in investing activities 

Cash flows from financing activities 
Proceeds from subordinated notes 
Repurchase of common stock 
Settlement of restricted stock 
Recognition of capitalized subordinated notes issuance costs 

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities 

Net change in cash and cash equivalents 
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year 
Cash and cash equivalents, end of year 

Supplemental cash flow information: 
      Interest paid on borrowed funds 
      Segment collapse impact to investment in subsidiary 
      Segment collapse impact to deferred income tax (benefit)/expense 
      Segment collapse impact to other assets 
      Segment collapse impact to other liabilities 

NOTE 22 – OTHER NON-INTEREST EXPENSE 

Year Ended December 31,  
2019 
2020 

  $ 

 24,534   $ 

 8,009 

 (3,003)  
 2,544  
 (25,742)  
 (32)  
 (42)  
 (1,741)  

 (10,453)  
 70  
 (10,383)  

 18,000  
 (377)  
 (261)  
 (269)  
 17,093   

 4,969   
 9,301   
 14,270   $ 

  $ 

  $ 

 854   $ 

 2,454  
 640  
 (3,202)  

  $ 

 108   $ 

 282 
 2,291 
 (8,610) 
 665 
 — 
 2,637 

 (2,152) 
 — 
 (2,152) 

 — 
 (743) 
 (110) 
 — 
 (853) 

 (368) 
 9,669 
 9,301 

476 
 — 
 — 
 — 
 — 

Other  non-interest  expense  as  shown  in  the  Consolidated  Statements  of  Income  is  detailed  in  the  following 
schedule to the extent the components exceed one percent of the aggregate of total interest income and other non-interest 
income (in thousands): 

Other non-interest expense 
Corporate development and related 
Loan and deposit related 
Office supplies and deliveries 
Other 

Total other non-interest expense 

Year Ended December 31,  
2019 
2020 

  $ 

  $ 

 1,517   $ 
 1,453  
 277  
 205  
 3,452   $ 

 1,468 
 729 
 223 
 197 
 2,617 

NOTE 23 - REGULATORY CAPITAL MATTERS 

First  Western  and  the  Bank  are  subject  to  various  regulatory  capital  adequacy  requirements  administered  by 
federal  banking  agencies.  Failure  to  meet  minimum  capital  requirements  can  initiate  certain  mandatory  and  possibly 
additional discretionary actions by regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct material effect on the Company’s 
consolidated financial statements. Under capital adequacy guidelines and, additionally for banks, the regulatory framework 

F-48 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
 
  
 
     
 
   
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
for prompt corrective action, First Western and the Bank must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative 
measures of their assets, liabilities, and certain off-balance sheet items as calculated under regulatory accounting practices.  

First Western and the Bank’s capital amounts and classification are also subject to qualitative judgments by the 
regulators regarding components, risk  weightings and other factors. The final rules implementing Basel Committee on 
Banking Supervision’s capital guidelines for U.S. banks ("Basel III rules") has been fully phased in. The net unrealized 
gain  or  loss  on  available-for-sale  securities  is  not  included  in  computing  regulatory  capital.  During  the  year  ended 
December 31, 2020,  FWFI  made  a  $10.0  million  capital  injection  into  the  Bank.  Management  believes  as  of 
December 31, 2020, First Western and the Bank meet all capital adequacy requirements to which it is subject to. 

Prompt corrective action regulations for First Western and the Bank provide five classifications: well capitalized, 
adequately  capitalized,  undercapitalized,  significantly  undercapitalized,  and  critically  undercapitalized,  although  these 
terms are not used to represent overall financial condition. If adequately capitalized, regulatory approval is required to 
accept brokered deposits. If undercapitalized, capital distributions are limited, as is asset growth and expansion, and capital 
restoration plans are required. 

The standard ratios established by  First Western and the Bank’s primary regulators to measure capital require 
First Western and the Bank to maintain minimum amounts and ratios, set forth in the following table. These ratios are 
common equity Tier 1 capital ("CET 1"), Tier 1 capital and total capital (as defined in the regulations) to risk-weighted 
assets (as defined), and Tier 1 capital (as defined) to average assets (as defined).  

The actual capital ratios of First Western and the Bank, along with the applicable regulatory capital requirements 
as of December 31, 2020, were calculated in accordance with the requirements of Basel III. The final rules of Basel III 
also established a "capital conservation buffer" of 2.5% above new regulatory minimum capital ratios, which are fully 
effective following minimum ratios: (i) a CET 1 ratio of 7.0%; (ii) a Tier 1 capital ratio of 8.5%; and (iii) a total capital 
ratio  of  10.5%.  Banks  are  subject  to  limitations  on  paying  dividends,  engaging  in  share  repurchases,  and  paying 
discretionary bonuses if its capital level falls below the buffer amount. These limitations establish a maximum percentage 
of eligible retained income that can be utilized for such activities. As of December 31, 2020, required ratios including the 
capital conservation buffer were (i) CET 1 of 7.0%; (ii) a Tier 1 capital ratio of 8.5%; and (iii) a total capital ratio of 10.5%. 

As of December 31, 2020, the most recent filings with the FDIC categorized First Western and the Bank as well 
capitalized under the regulatory guidelines. To be categorized as well capitalized, an institution must maintain minimum 
CET  1  risk-based,  Tier 1  risk-based,  total  risk-based,  and  Tier 1  leverage  ratios  as  set  forth  in  the  following  table. 
Management believes there are no conditions or events since December 31, 2020 that have changed the categorization of 
First Western and the Bank as well capitalized. Management believes First Western and the Bank met all capital adequacy 
requirements to which it is subject as of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019. 

F-49 

The  following  presents  the  actual  and  required  capital  amounts  and  ratios  as  of  December 31, 2020  and 

December 31, 2019 (in thousands): 

December 31, 2020 
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets 

Bank 
Consolidated 

CET1 to risk-weighted assets 

Bank 
Consolidated 

Total capital to risk-weighted assets 

Bank 
Consolidated 

Tier 1 capital to average assets 

Bank 
Consolidated 

December 31, 2019 
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets 

Bank 
Consolidated 

CET1 to risk-weighted assets 

Bank 
Consolidated 

Total capital to risk-weighted assets 

Bank 
Consolidated 

Tier 1 capital to average assets 

Bank 
Consolidated 

Actual 

Required for Capital   
Adequacy Purposes(1)   

To be Well Capitalized   
Under Prompt 
Corrective Action 
Regulations 

      Amount 

      Ratio        Amount 

      Ratio        Amount 

      Ratio 

  $  133,963     10.22 %   $   78,660   
N/A  
 9.96  

   131,507  

 6.0 %   $  104,880   
N/A  
N/A  

 8.0 % 
N/A  

   133,963     10.22  
 9.96  
   131,507  

 58,995   
N/A  

 4.5  
N/A  

 85,215   
N/A  

 6.5  
N/A  

   146,853     11.20  
 12.80  
   168,957  

   104,880   
N/A  

 8.0  
N/A  

   131,100   
N/A  

 10.0  
N/A  

   133,963   
  $  131,507  

 7.62  
 7.45 %  $ 

 70,301   
N/A  

 4.0  
N/A %  $ 

 87,877   
N/A  

 5.0  
N/A % 

Actual 

Amount 

   Ratio 

Required for Capital   
Adequacy Purposes(1)  
Amount   

Ratio 

To be Well Capitalized   
Under Prompt 
Corrective Action 
Regulations 

Amount   

Ratio 

  $   99,461   
   105,821  

 10.67 %   $  55,954   
N/A  
 11.31  

 6.0 %   $  74,606   
N/A  
N/A  

 8.0 % 
N/A  

 99,461   
   105,821  

 10.67  
 11.31  

   41,966   
N/A  

 4.5  
N/A  

   60,617   
N/A  

 6.5  
N/A  

   107,509   
   120,429  

 11.53  
 12.87  

   74,606   
N/A  

 8.0  
N/A  

   93,257   
N/A  

 10.0  
N/A  

 99,461   
  $  105,821  

 8.09  
   49,166   
 8.58 %  $  N/A  

 4.0  
   61,458   
N/A %  $  N/A  

 5.0  
N/A % 

______________________________________ 
(1)  Does not include capital conservation buffer. 

NOTE 24 – SUBSEQUENT EVENTS (Unaudited) 

On January 11, 2021 the SBA reopened the PPP, to First Draw PPP Loans and began accepting applications for 
Second  Draw  PPP  Loans  on  January  13,  2021. The  PPP  is  intended  to  provide  loans  to  small  businesses  to  pay  their 
employees, rent, mortgage interest and utilities. The loans may be forgiven conditioned upon the client providing payroll 
documentation evidencing their compliant use of funds and otherwise complying with the terms of the program. The Bank 
is an approved SBA lender and began accepting applications for the reopened program on January 19, 2021. As of February 
28, 2021, we had received 660 applications for PPP loans from borrowers for $91.4 million with an average loan size of 
$0.1 million; of the applications received 410 applications for $68.7 million have been approved and funded by the SBA.  

***** 

F-50 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
Item 9: Changes in and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure 

None. 

Item 9A: Controls and Procedures 

Evaluation of Internal Control over Financial Reporting 

Report on Management’s Assessment of Internal Control Over Financial Reporting 

Management  of  the  Company  is  responsible  for  establishing  and  maintaining  adequate  internal  control  over 
financial reporting (as defined under Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) of the Exchange Act). The Company’s internal control 
system  is  a  process  designed  to  provide  reasonable  assurance  regarding  the  reliability  of  financial  reporting  and  the 
preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance GAAP. Because of its inherent limitations, internal 
control  over  financial  reporting  may  not  prevent  or  detect  misstatements.  Also,  projections  of  any  evaluation  of 
effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions 
or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate. 

As of December 31, 2020, management assessed the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial 
reporting  based  on  the  criteria  for  effective  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  established  in  "Internal  Control-
Integrated Framework," issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations ("COSO") of the Treadway Commission 
in 2013. Based on the assessment, management determined that the Company maintained effective internal control over 
financial reporting as of December 31, 2020. 

This Annual Report on Form 10-K does not include an attestation report of the Company’s independent registered 

public accounting firm due to the rules of the Securities and Exchange Commission for an Emerging Growth Company. 

Disclosure Controls and Procedures 

The  Company’s  management,  including  our  Chairman,  Chief  Executive  Officer  and  President  and  our  Chief 
Financial Officer and Treasurer, have evaluated the effectiveness of our "disclosure controls and procedures" (as defined 
in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Exchange Act of 1934, as of the end of the period covered by this report. Based 
on such evaluation, our Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and President and our Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer 
have concluded that, as of the end of the period covered by the Annual Report on Form 10-K, the Company’s disclosure 
controls and procedures were effective to provide reasonable assurance that the information required to be disclosed by 
the Company in the reports it files or submits under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported 
within  the  time  periods  specified  in  the  rules  and  forms  of  the  SEC  and  is  accumulated  and  communicated  to  the 
Company’s management, including our Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and President and our Chief Financial Officer 
and Treasurer, as appropriate, to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure. 

Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting 

There was no change in our internal control over financial reporting (as such term is defined in Rule 13a-15(f) 
under the Exchange Act) during the quarter ended December 31, 2020, that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely 
to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. The design of any system of controls and 
procedures is based in part upon certain assumptions about the likelihood of future events. There can be no assurance that 
any design will succeed in achieving its stated goals under all potential future conditions, regardless of how remote. 

Item 9B. Other Information 

None. 

93 

 
 
 
Item 10: Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance 

PART III 

The information required by this item is hereby incorporated by reference from our Definitive Proxy Statement 
relating to the 2020 Annual Meeting of Shareholders, or the 2021 Proxy Statement, to be filed with the SEC within 120 
days of the end of the fiscal year ended December 31, 2020. 

Our board of directors has adopted a Code of Business Conduct and Ethics that applies to all of our employees, 
officers and directors, including our Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer and other  executive officers. The 
full text of our Code of Business Conduct and Ethics is posted on the investor relations page of our  website  which is 
located https://myfw.gcs-web.com/investor-relations. We will post any amendments to our Code of Business Conduct and 
Ethics, or waivers of its requirements, on our website. 

Item 11: Executive Compensation 

The information required by this item is hereby incorporated by reference from the 2021 Proxy Statement, to be 

filed with the SEC within 120 days of the end of the fiscal year ended December 31, 2020. 

Item 12: Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Shareholder Matters 

The information required by this item is hereby incorporated by reference from the 2021 Proxy Statement, to be 

filed with the SEC within 120 days of the end of the fiscal year ended December 31, 2020. 

Information relating to securities authorized for issuance under our equity compensation plans is included in Part 
II of this Annual Report on Form 10-K under "Item 5 – Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Shareholder 
Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities." 

Item 13: Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence 

The information required by this item is hereby incorporated by reference from the 2021 Proxy Statement, to be 

filed with the SEC within 120 days of the end of the fiscal year ended December 31, 2020. 

Item 14: Principal Accounting Fees and Services 

The information required by this item is hereby incorporated by reference from the 2021 Proxy Statement, to be filed 

with the SEC within 120 days of the end of the fiscal year ended December 31, 2020. 

94 

 
 
 
 
 
 
PART IV 

Item 15. Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules 

(a) 

(1) Financial Statements 
  See Index to Consolidated Financial Statements on page 92 
(2) Financial Statement Schedules 

All financial statement schedules are omitted because they are either not applicable or not required, or 
because the required information is included in the Consolidated Financial Statements or the Notes 
thereto included in Part II, Item 8. 

(b) 

(3) Exhibits 

The exhibits are filed as part of this report and exhibits incorporated by reference to other documents are 
as follows: 

Exhibit No.       Description 

3.1 

  Amended and Restated Articles of Incorporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the 

Company’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on July 3, 2018, File No. 333-225719) 

3.2 

  Amended and Bylaws (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to the Company’s Form S-1 filed with 

the SEC on July 3, 2018, File No. 333-225719) 

4.1 

  Form of Common Stock Certificate (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Form S-1 

filed with the SEC on June 19, 2018, File No. 333-225719) 

4.2 

4.3 

4.4 

4.5 

  Certain instruments defining the rights of holders of long-term debt securities of the registrant and its 
subsidiaries are omitted pursuant to Item 601(b)(4)(iii) of Regulation S-K. The registrant hereby 
undertakes to furnish to the SEC, upon request, copies of any such instruments. 

  Form of Note Purchase Agreement for 7.25% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes due 2026 
(incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.6 to the Company’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on June 19, 
2018, File No. 333-225719) 

  Form of 5.125% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Note (incorporated by reference as Exhibit A to 
Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on March 17, 2020, File No. 001-38595) 

  Form of 4.25% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Note (incorporated by reference as Exhibit A to 
Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on November 25, 2020, File No. 001-
38595) 

4.6 

  Description of Registrant’s Securities 

10.1† 

  First Western Financial, Inc. 2008 Stock Incentive Plan, as amended (incorporated by reference to 

Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on June 19, 2018, File No. 333-225719) 

10.2† 

  First Western Financial, Inc. 2016 Omnibus Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to 

the Company’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on June 19, 2018, File No. 333-225719) 

10.3† 

  Employment Agreement, dated January 1, 2017, between Scott Wylie and First Western Financial, Inc. 
(incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to the Company’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on June 19, 
2018, File No. 333-225719) 

95 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
10.4† 

  Amendment to Employment Agreement dated January 30, 2020 by and between First Western Financial, 
Inc. and Scott Wylie (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Form 8-K filed with 
the SEC on January 30, 2020, File No. 001-38595) 

10.5† 

  Amended and Restated Employment Agreement, dated March 5, 2018, between Julie Courkamp and 

First Western Financial, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to the Company’s Form S-1 filed 
with the SEC on June 19, 2018, File No. 333-225719) 

10.6† 

  Amended Employment Agreement dated May 2, 2019, by and between First Western Financial, Inc. and 
Julie Courkamp (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Form 8-K filed with the 
SEC on May 8, 2019, File No. 001-38595) 

10.7† 

  Second Amendment to Employment Agreement dated January 30, 2020 by and between First Western 

Financial, Inc. and Julie Courkamp (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s Form 8-
K filed with the SEC on January 30, 2020, File No. 001-38595) 

10.8† 

  Employment Agreement, dated April 8, 2020, by and between First Western Financial, Inc. and John 
Sawyer (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on 
April 10, 2020, File No. 001-38595) 

10.9 

  Business Loan Agreement, dated June 30, 2020 and signed October 28, 2020, by and between First 

Western Financial, Inc., and BMO Harris Bank N.A. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the 
Company’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on November 3, 2020, File No. 001-38595) 

10.10 

  Promissory Note, dated June 30, 2020 and signed October 28, 2020, by and between First Western 

Financial, Inc., and BMO Harris Bank N.A. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s 
Form 8-K filed with the SEC on November 3, 2020, File N. 001-38595) 

10.11 

  Asset Purchase Agreement, dated August 18, 2017, among EMC Holdings, LLC, WHMC, LLC, Alan 

Schrum and First Western Trust Bank (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 to the Company’s Form 
S-1 filed with the SEC on June 19, 2018, File No. 333-225719) 

10.12† 

10.13 

  Form of Indemnification Agreement between First Western Financial, Inc. and its directors and certain 
officers (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.7 to the Company’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on 
June 19, 2018, File No. 333-225719) 

  Form of Subordinated Note Purchase Agreement, dated March 17, 2020, by and among First Western 
Financial, Inc. and several purchasers named therein (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the 
Company’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on March 17, 2020, File No. 001-38595) 

10.14 

  Form of Subordinated Note Purchase Agreement, dated November 25, 2020, by and among First 

Western Financial, Inc. and the several purchasers named therein (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 
10.1 to the Company’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on November 25, 2020, File No. 001-38595) 

21.1* 

  Subsidiaries of First Western Financial, Inc. 

23.1* 

  Consent of Crowe LLP 

24.1* 

  Powers of attorney (included on signature page to the Annual Report on Form 10-K) 

31.1* 

  Certification of Chief Executive Officer pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) of the Exchange Act, as adopted 

pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 

96 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
31.2* 

  Certification of Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) of the Exchange Act as adopted 

pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 

32.1** 

  Certification of Chief Executive Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to 

Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 

32.2** 

  Certification of Chief Financial Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to 

Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 

101.INS* 

Inline XBRL Instance Document 

101.SCH*   

Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document 

101.CAL*   

Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document 

101.DEF* 

Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document 

101.LAB*   

Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document 

101.PRE* 

Inline XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document 

104 

  Cover Page Interactive Data File (formatted as inline XBRL and contained in Exhibit 101) 

*      Filed herewith. 

**    These exhibits are furnished herewith and shall not be deemed "filed" for purposes of Section 18 of the Exchange Act, or otherwise subject to the 
liability of that section, and shall not be deemed to be incorporated by reference into any filing under the Securities Act or the Exchange Act. 

†      Indicates a management contract or compensatory plan. 

Item 16. Form 10-K Summary 

None. 

SIGNATURES 

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, the 

Registrant has duly caused this Report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized. 

           March 12, 2021 
Date 

First Western Financial, Inc. 

By: 

/s/ Scott C. Wylie 
Scott C. Wylie 
Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and President 

97 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
POWER OF ATTORNEY 

KNOW  ALL  PERSONS  BY  THESE  PRESENTS,  that  each  person  whose  signature  appears  below  hereby 
constitutes and appoints Scott C. Wylie and Julie A. Courkamp, with full power to act without the other, his or her true 
and lawful attorney-in-fact and agent, with full and several powers of substitution, for him or her and in his or her name, 
place and stead, in any and all capacities, to sign any and all amendments to this Annual Report on Form 10-K, and to file 
the  same,  with  all  exhibits  thereto  and  other  documents  in  connection  therewith,  with  the  Securities  and  Exchange 
Commission, and hereby grants to such attorneys-in-fact and agents, and each of them, full power and authority to do and 
perform each and every act and thing requisite and necessary to be done, as fully as to all intents and purposes as each of 
the undersigned might or could do in person, hereby ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in-fact and agents, or 
any of them, or their or his substitute or substitutes, may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue hereof. Pursuant to the 
requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, this Report has been signed below by the following 
persons on behalf of the Registrant in the capacities and on the dates indicated. 

Signature 

     Title 

     Date 

/s/ Scott C. Wylie 
Scott C. Wylie 

/s/ Julie A. Courkamp  
Julie A. Courkamp 

/s/ Julie A. Caponi 
Julie A. Caponi 

/s/ David R. Duncan 
David R. Duncan 

/s/ Thomas A. Gart 
Thomas A. Gart 

/s/ Patrick H. Hamill 
Patrick H. Hamill 

/s/ Scott C. Mitchell 
Scott C. Mitchell 

/s/ Luke A. Latimer 
Luke A. Latimer 

/s/ Eric D. Sipf 
Eric D. Sipf 

/s/ Mark L. Smith 
Mark L. Smith 

/s/ Joseph C. Zimlich 
Joseph C. Zimlich 

Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and President 
(principal executive officer) 

  March 12, 2021 

  March 12, 2021 

   March 12, 2021 

   March 12, 2021 

   March 12, 2021 

   March 12, 2021 

   March 12, 2021 

   March 12, 2021 

   March 12, 2021 

   March 12, 2021 

   March 12, 2021 

Director, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer 
(principal financial and accounting officer) 

   Director 

   Director 

   Director 

   Director 

   Director 

   Director 

  Director 

   Director 

   Director 

98 

 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
1900 16th Street, Suite 1200
Denver, Colorado 80202

www.myfw.com